Bobcat 753 Service Manual Full Download

Posted on
Bobcat 753 owners manual download

Bobcat 753 Service Manual Pdf Free

Bobcat 753 Service Manual - Ebook download as PDF File (.pdf), Text File (.txt). 87 ohms FUEL SENDER Full 30 ohms Empty 270 ohms RPM SENSOR. A high quality PDF service manual for a Bobcat 753 11001+. The repair manual download will show you every nut and bolt on your vehicle and will direct you on every mechanical procedure imaginable. Download game psp emulator pc. Bobcat 753 11001+ PDF Skid-Steer Service/Shop Manual Download. In February of 2001, Download Complete Service Repair Manual for Bobcat S175. The Bobcat 753 skid-steer loader features a Kubota four-cylinder diesel. View and Download Bobcat 853 service manual online. 853 Compact Loader pdf manual download. Also for: 853h. This Bobcat 753 Skid-Steer Loader Service Manual includes pictures and easy to follow directions on what tools are needed and how the repair is performed. Just imagine how much you can save by doing simple repairs yourself.

Service manual includes repair and service information, descriptions of repair and maintenance procedures, detailed circuits, fitting instructions, technical specifications, special instructions, maintenance manuals, assembly instructions for Bobcat Skid Steer Loader 753. This service manual is a detailed source of important information for.

Bobcat 753 Service Manual Pdf

.... -
....
_-----------------­
(Q6-8)9C:f:OU9
ONYH-110S1:139NI 30~'3W
MAINTENANCE SAFETY
Instructions are necessary before operating or servicing machine. Read and understand the Operation & Maintenance Manual, Handbook and signs (decals) on machine. Follow warnings and instructions in the manuals when making repairs, adjustmenfs or servicing. Check for correct function after adjustmenfs, repairs or service. Untrained operators and failure to fonow instructions can cause injury or death. W-2003-Q199
A
Safety Alert Symbol: This symbol with a warning statement, means: 'Warning, be alert! Your safety is ..--__________in_v_o_lv---,ed!' Carefully read the message that follows. .--_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _---,
CORRECT '! II /1 /~/
CORRECT
B-10731
A
Never service the Bobcat® Skid Steer Loader without instructions.
8-12365
A
Use the correct procedureto liftor lower operator cab.
G
WRONG
8-11799
8-15231
A welding Have good ventilation when or grinding painted parts.
A
dust mask when grinding A Wear painted parts. Toxic dust and gas can be produced.
Avoid exhaust fume leaks which A can kill without warning. Exhaust system must be tightly sealed.
Disconnecting or 100senin9. any hydraulic tubeline, hose, fitting, component or a part failure can cause lift arms to drop. Do not go under lift arms when raised unless supported by an approved Uftarm support deVice. Replace if damaged.
8-7469
A
Cleaning and maintenance are required daily.
8-15280
A A
Never work on loader with lift arms up unless lift arms are held by an approved lift arm support device. Replace if damaged. Never modify equipment or add attachments not approved by Bobcat Company.
WRONG
8-6590
A
A A
Stop, cool and clean engine of flammable materials before checking fluids. Never service or adjust loader with the engine running unless instructed to do so in the manual. Avoid contact with leaking hydraulic fluid or diesel fuel under pressure. It can penetrate the skin or eyes. Never fill fuel tank with engine running, while smoking or when near open flame.
A
8-6589
A A
A
Keep body, jewelry and clothing away from moving parts, electrical contacts, hot parts and exhaust. Wear eye protection to guard from battery acid, compressed springs, fluids under pressure and flying debris when engines are running or tools are used. Use eye protection approved for type of welding. Keep rear door closed except for service. Close and latch door before operating the loader.
A Lead-acid batteries produce flammable and explosive gases. Keep arcs, sparks, flames and A lighted tobacco away from batteries. A Batteries contain acid which burns eyes or skin on contact. Wear protective clothing. If acid contacts body, flush well with water. For eye contact flush well and get Immediate medical attention.
Maintenance procedures which are given in the Operation & Maintenance Manual can be performed by the owner/operator without any specific technical training. Maintenance procedures which are not in the
Operation & Maintenance Manual must be performed ONLY BY QUALIFIED BOBCAT SERVICE PERSONNEL. Always use genuine Bobcat replacement parts. The Service Safety Training Course is available from your Bobcat dealer.
MSW01-0600
FOREWORD
This manual is for the Bobcat loader mechanic. It provides necessary servicing and adjustment procedures for the Bobcat loader and its component parts and systems. Refer to the Operation & Maintenance Manual for operating instructions, starting procedure, daily checks, etc. A general inspection of the following items must be made after the loader has had service or repair: 1. Check that the ROPS/FOPS (Including sidescreens) is in good condition and is not modified.
9. Enclosure door latches must open and close freely.
2. Check that ROPS mounting hardware is tightened and is Melroe approved.
1o. Bob-Tach wedges and linkages must function correctly and be in good condition.
3. The seat belt must be correctly installed, functional and in good condition.
11. Safety treads must in good condition.
4. The seat bar and pedal interlocks must be correctly adjusted, clean and lubricated.
12. Check for correct function of indicator lamps (Optional on some models).
5. Machine signs must be legible ~.iiiiii!~:1_~i;[email protected]~J.~ and in the correct location. .------.-. -•
-.:~-~•. -:_-.::._._ •••.
I
, ___ , I
•.. -.-'-' .-,-- ....-.
13. Check hydraulic fluid level, engine oil level and fuel supply.
6. Steering levers and foot pedals must return to neutral.
14. Inspect for fuel, oil or hydraulic fluid leaks.
7. Check for correct function of the work lights and travel lights.
15. Lubricate the loader.
8. The parking brake function correctly.
16. Check the condition of the battery and cables.
Revised Dec_ 92
must
®
••
17. Inspect the air cleaner for damage or leaks. Check the
condition of the element.
18. Check the electrical charging system.
19. Check tires for wear and pressure.
20. Inspect for loose or broken parts or connections.
21 . Operate the loader and check all functions.
.1H>1H)))»~.H>>UU,lJJ)~ ~)Umnmum,
':;
22. Check for any field modification not completed.
Recommend to the owner that all necessary corrections be made before the machine is returned to service.
Revised Dec. 92
••
t
CONTENTS
SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . i
SERIAL NUMBER LOCATIONS ................... ii
DELIVERY REPORT ........................ iii
BOBCAT LOADER IDENTIFICATION ................. iii
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE .................. 1-1
~~DR~ULlC SySTEM ...................... 2-1
DR STATIC SYSTEM ..................... 3-1
D~IVE SySTEM ......................... 4-1
M IN FRAME .......................... 5-1
~LECTRICAL SYSTEM ...................... 6-1
NGINE SERVICE ........................ 7-1
SPECIFICATIONS ........................ 8-1
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE
HYDRAULIC SYSTEM
HYDROSTATIC SYSTEM
DRIVE SYSTEM
MAIN FRAME
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
ENGINE SERVICE
SPECIFICATION
750 Series Loader Service Manual
Both new and rebuilt starters
are available from Melroe.
Available at your local Bobcat Dealer.
SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS
..... or .... 1II8ChIne. Reed Operation • MeInt_nce . . . . .1.·HMdIIeok end
~,........ ~ In the .... when making repaIn~ adjustments or servicing .
1nJII!v_ or death·
. . . . . . . . .'ts. ....... ,... to foIaw InetrUcdons cartceuee
W-2IOOI-1288
The following publications provide information on the safe use of the loader and attachments: 1. The Delivery Report is used to assure that complete instructions have been given to the new. owner and that the machine is in safe operating condition. 2. The Operation & Maintenance Manual delivered with the loader gives operating information as well as routine maintenance and service procedures. It is a part of the loader and must stay with the machine when it is sold. 3. The loader has machine signs (decals) which instruct on the safe care and operation. The signs and their locations are shown in the Operation & Maintenance Manual. Replacement signs are available from Bobcat loader dealers. 4. The FIEI Manual delivered with the loader gives general safety information. 5. The Service Manual and Parts Manual are available from Bobcat loader dealers for use by mechanics to do shop type service and repair work.
IMPORTANT
This notice identifies procedures which must be followed to avoid damage to the machine.
A !~is symbol is used for important safety messages. When you see this symbol, follow the safety message to avoid personal . . Injury.
• • • • • •
• • •
Wear tight fitting clothing and any other required safety apparel when operating or servicing the loader. Wear safety glasses when maintaining or servicing the loader. Exhaust gases can kill, vent engine exhaust outdoors. Know where fire extinguishers and first aid kits are located and how to use them. Do not run the Bobcat loader where exhaust, arcs, sparks or hot components can contact flammable material, explosive dust or gases. Check fuel and hydraulic tubes, hoses and fittings for damage and leakage. Never use open flame or bare skin to check for leaks. Tighten or replace any parts that show leakage. Always clean fluid spills. DO NOT use gasoline or diesel fuel for cleaning parts. Use commercial nonflammable solvents. Clean the loader before doing any welding. Cover rubber hoses, battery and all other flammable parts. Keep a fire extinguisher near the loader when welding. Have good ventilation when welding or grinding painted parts. Wear a dust mask when grinding painted parts. Toxic dust and gas can be produced. Stop the engine and let it cool before adding fuel. No smoking.
• Use the procedure in this manual for connecting battery. • Use the procedure in this manual for cleaning the spark arrestor muffler after each 100 hours of operation. 750 Series Loader Service Manual
SERIAL NUMBER LOCATIONS Always use the serial number of the loader when requesting service information or when ordering parts. Early or later models (identification made by serial number) may use different parts, or it may be necessary to use a different procedure in doing a specific service operation. LOADER SERIAL NUMBER
The loader serial number plate is located on the inside of the left upright, above the grill [AI. Explanation of loader Serial Number:
xxxxx
xxxx
TI...--T __
Production Sequence (Series) Model, Engine Version
ENGINE SERIAL NUMBER LOCATION
The serial number is near the fuel injection pump on the engine block 00.
DELIVERY REPORT The Delivery Report must be filled out by the dealer and signed by the owner or operator when the Bobcat loader is delivered. An explanation of the form must be given to the owner. Make sure it is filled out completely ~.
ii
750 Series Loader Service Manual
V.
BOBCAT LOADER IDENTIFICATION
---------~nr~~~~~!iWl~
LlGHTSFRONT·
STEERNG~______----~~~;Y~~J LEVER -
REAR AUXILIARY QUICK COUPLERS (OPT.) TILT
/'
BUCKETt
BUCKET STEPS OPERATOR CAB
~t~~.~~~~~~V(ROPS & FOPS)­
LIFT ARM LIFT CYLINDER REAR
REAR
'''D~
8-12555 8-12556
* TIRES - Flotation tires are shown. The Bobcat loader is base-equipped with standard tires. t BUCKET - Several different buckets and other attachments are available for the Bobcat loader. - ROPS, FOPS - Roll-Over Protective Structure, Falling Object Protective Structure, per SAE J1 040 and SAE J1043. The Bobcat loader is base-equipped with standard operator cab as shown. Revised Dec. 92
iii
750 Series Loader Service Manual
Melroe has engine oil
blended to our specifications
which meet or exceed the highest
demands of your engine.
Available at your local Bobcat Dealer.
MELROE__r
_if?
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE Page Number
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE
AIR CLEANER
Replacement of the Filter Element ................ 1-7
ALTERNATOR BELT
Adjusting the Alternator Belt .................. 1-15
DIAGNOSTIC TOOL
Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-26
DRIVE BELT
Adjustment ..... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-21
Drive Belt Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-22
ENGINE COOLING SYSTEM
Cleaning the Cooling System .................. 1-13
Coolant -Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-13
Removing Coolant from the Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-14
ENGINE LUBRICATION SYSTEM
Checking Engine Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-11
Replacement of Oil and Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-11
FAN GEARBOX
Checking Grease Level .................... . 1-20
FINAL DRIVE TRANSMISSION (CHAINCASE)
Checking and Adding Oil ................... . 1-20
FUEL SYSTEM
Filling the Fuel Tank ..................... . Fuel Filter .......................... . Fuel Specifications ...................... . Removing Air from the Fuel System .............. .
1-9
1-9
1-9
1-10
HYDRAULIC/HYDROSTATIC SYSTEM
Checking and Adding Fluid ................... 1-17
Hydraulic/Hydrostatic Filter Replacement. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-17
Hydraulic Reservoir Breater Cap ................ 1-17
LIFT ARM SUPPORT DEVICE
To Disengage Lift Arm Support Device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-4
To Engage lift Arm Support Device. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-4
LIFTING AND BLOCKING THE LOADER
Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2
LIFTING THE LOADER
Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-3
LUBRICATION OF THE LOADER
Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-23
MONITOR SERVICE CODES
Chart ............................ 1-27
OPERATOR CAB
Description ......................... . Lowering the Operator Cab .................. . Raising the Operator Cab ................... . Lowering the Operator Cab (W/Hand Controls) .......... . Raising the Operator Cab (W/Hand Controls) .......... .
1-5
1-5
1-5
1-5b
1-5a
750 Series Loader Service Manual
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (Cont'd)
Page Number
REMOTE START SWITCH
Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-25
SEAT BAR SYSTEM
Description .......................... 1-6
Seat Bar Inspection ...................... 1-6
Seat Bar Maintenance ..................... 1-6
SENDER AND SENSORS
Service Checks ........................ 1-26
SERVICE CODES
Chart ............................ 1-28
SERVICE SCHEDULE
Chart ............................ 1-1
SPARK ARRESTOR MUFFLER
Cleaning Procedure ...................... 1-18
TIRE MAINTENANCE
Tire Inflation ......................... 1-19
Tire Rotation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-19
Wheel Nuts .......................... 1-19
TRANSPORTING THE LOADER
Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-3
TROUBLESHOOTING THE B.O.S.S. & L.C.D. DISPLAY
Chart ............................ 1-30
. USING AN BOOSTER BATTERY (JUMP STARTING)
Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-16
750 Series Loader Service Manual
SERVICE SCHEDULE Maintenance work must be done at regular intervals. Failure to do so will result in excessive wear and early failures. The service schedule is a guide for correct maintenance of the Bobcat loader.
A
WARNING
Instructions are necessary before operating or servicing machine. Read Operation & Maintenance Manual, Handbook and signs (decals) on machine. Follow warnings and instructions in the manuals when making repairs, adjustments or servicing. Check for correct function after adjustments, repairs or service. Failure to follow instructions can cause injury or death. W-2003-1289
Pedal Interlocks Safety Signs & Safety
Check fluid level & add as needed. Check for damage & leaks. Repair & as needed. Check oil level.
*• Also Check wheel nut torque every 8 hours for the first 24 hours. replace hydraulic/hydrostatic filter element when the transmission warning light comes 'ON' • • Or Every 12 Months.
*Inspect the new belt after first 50 hours. Revised Dec. 92
-1-1-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
1 PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE
A
A WARNING
Instructions are necessary before operating or servicing machine. Read Operation & Maintenance Manual, Handbook and signs (decals) on machine. Follow warnings and instructions in the manuals when making repairs, adjustments or servicing. Check for correct function after adjustments, repairs or service. Failure to follow instructions can cause injury or death.
W-2003-0797
LIFTING AND BLOCKING THE LOADER Procedure Always park the loader on a level surface.
A WARNING
Put jackstands under the front axles and rear corners of the frame before running the engine for service. Failure to use jackstands can allow the machine to fall or move and cause injury or death.
W-2017-()286
Put floor jack under the rear of the loader [B].
Lift the rear of the loader and install jackstands [B].
CD-09027
Put the floor jack under the front of the loader [C]. Lift the front of the loader and put jackstands under the axle tubes [C].
NOTE: Make sure the jackstands do not touch the tires.
-1-2­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
TRANSPORTING THE LOADER Procedure
A WARNING
Adequately designed ramps of sufficient strength are needed to support the weight of the machine when loading onto a transport vehicle. Wood ramps can break and cause personal injury.
W-20SIHl494
MC-01241
A loader with an empty bucket or no attachment must be loaded backward onto the transport vehicle [A].
B
.
.
Use the following procedure to fasten the Bobcat loader to the transport vehicle to prevent the loader from moving during sudden stops or when going up or down slopes [B]: 1. Lower the bucket or attachment to the floor. Stop the engine. 2. Engage the parking brake. 3. Install chains at the front and rear of the loader.
LIFTING THE LOADER Procedure
A WARNING
. AVOID INJURY OR DEATH • Before lifting. check fasteners on four point lift. • Never allow riders in the cab or bystanders within 15 feet (5 meters) while lifting the machine. W-21SIHI694
The loader can be lifted with the four point lift which is available as a kit from your Bobcat loader dealer. Install the lift eyes in the kit as shown in Fig. [C]. MC-01434
Revised Mar. 91
-1-3­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
LIFT ARM SUPPORT DEVICE To Engage Lift Arm Support Device
A WARNING
Never work on a machine with the lift arms up unless the lift arms are secured by an approved lift arm support device. Failure to use an approved lift arm support device can allow the lift arms or attachment to fall and cause injury or death. W-2059-0598
Maintenance and service work can be done with the lift arms lowered. If the lift arms are raised, use the following procedure: Put jackstands under the rear comers of the loader. Disconnect the spring from the lift arm support device retaining pin, hold onto the support device and remove the retaining pin [A].
Lower the lift arm support device on top of the lift cylinder. Hook the free end of the spring to the lift arm support device so there will be no interference with the support device installation. With the operator in the seat, seat belt fastened and seat bar lowered, start the engine. Raise the lift arms, until the lift arm support device drops onto the lift cylinder rod [8]. Lower the lift arms slowly until the support device is held between the lift arm and the lift cylinder. Stop the engine. Raise the seat bar and unfasten the seat belt. Install pin into the rear of the lift arm support device below the cylinder rod.
To Disengage Lift Arm Support Device Remove the pin from the lift arm support device. Connect the spring from the lift arm support device to the retainer plate on the lift arms [C]. With the operator in the seat, seat belt fastened and seat bar lowered, start the engine. Raise the lift arms a small amount and the spring will lift the support device off the lift cylinder rod. Lower the lift arms. Stop the engine. Lift the support device into the storage position and install the retaining pin and connect the spring [A].
Revised Jan. 92
-1-4-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
OPERATOR CAB Description The Bobcat loader has an operator cab (ROPS and FOPS) as standard equipment to protect the operator from rollover and falling objects. Replace the operator cab if it has been damaged.
A WARNING
Never modi~ operator cab by welding, grinding, drilling holes or adding attachments unless instructed to do so by Melroe Company. Changes to the cab can cause loss of operator protection from rollover and falling objects, and result in injury or death. W-2069-1285
Raising the Operator Cab Stop the loader on a level surface. Lower the lift arms, if the lift arms must be up while raising the operator cab, install the lift arm support device (Page 1-4).
A WARNING
Before the cab or the lift arms are raised for service, jackstands must be put under the rear corners of the frame. Failure to use jackstands can allow the machine to tip backward causing injury or death.
W-2014-0895
Loosen the nut (both sides) at the front comer of the operator cab [A]. Remove the nut and plate (both sides) [B].
Lift on the grab handle and bottom of the operator cab slowly until the cab latching mechanism engages and the cab is all the way up [C].
Lowering the Operator Cab Pull down on the bottom of the operator cab until it is stopped by the latching mechanism. Release the latching mechanism and pull the cab all the way down [0]. Install the nut and plate (both sides) [B]. Tighten the nuts to 40-50 ft.-Ibs. (54-68 Nm) torque.
Revised Jan. 92
-1-5­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
OPERATOR CAB (Cont'd) Raising the Operator Cab (WlHand Controls) Stop the loader on a level surface. Lower the lift arms. Shut engine off. If the lift arms must be up while raising the operator cab, install the lift arm support device (Page 1-4).
A WARNING
Before the cab or the lift arms are raised for service, jackstands must be put under the rear corners of the frame. Failure to use jackstands can allow the machine to tip backward causing injury or death. W-2014-089S
Disconnect the control linkage jOint from the bottom hole (work position) and move to the TOP hole on the control handle (both sides) [A]. Both control handles must be in the vertical position so there will be no cab interference with the steering levers when the operator cab is raised or lowered [B].
A WARNING
AVOID INJURY OR DEATH Accidental movement of the loader, the lift arms or the attachment can occur if the lift or tilt control handles are not positioned correctly before lifting or lowering the cab. Move control linkage to top hole in handles as shown, so cab does not hit handles when being lifted or lowered.
W-2157-GS94
Loosen the nut (both sides) at the front comer of the operator cab [C]. Remove the nut and plate (both sides) [0].
Revised Jan. 92
-1-5a­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
OPERATOR CAB (Cont'd)
A
Lift on the grab handle and bottom of the loader cab slowly until the cab latching mechanism engages and the cab is all the way up [A].
8-12687
Lowering the Operator Cab (WlHand Controls)
Pull down on the bottom of the operator cab until it stops at the latching mechanism. Release the latching mechanism and pull the cab all the way down [B].
Install the plate and nut (both sides).
Tighten the nuts to 40-50 ft.-Ibs. (54-68 Nm) torque [C].
Move the control linkage from the top hole to the BOTTOM hole (work position) on the control handle (both sides) [0].
Added Sept. 91
-1-5b­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
SEAT BAR SYSTEM
A
Description The seat bar system has a pivoting seat bar with arm rests and has spring loaded interlocks for the lift and tilt control pedals. The operator controls the use of the seat bar. The seat bar in the down position helps to keep the operator in the seat, also the interlocks require the operator to lower the seat bar in order to operate the foot pedal controls. When the seat bar is up, the lift and tilt pedals are locked when retumed to the neutral position.
':::-:--':-- Clean & Lubricate
A WARNING
AVOID INJURY OR DEATH The seat bar system must lock the lift and tilt control I?edals in neutral when the seat bar is up. Service the system if pedals do not lock correctly.
W-2105-1285
Seat Bar Inspection Sit in the seat and fasten the seal belt. Engage the parking brake. Pull the seat bar all the way down. Start the engine. Operate each foot pedal to check both the lift and tilt functions. Raise the lift arms until the bucket is about 2 feet (600 mm) off the ground. Raise the seat bar. Try to move each foot pedal. Pedals must be firmly locked in neutral position. There must be no motion of the lift arms or tilt (bucket) when the pedals are pushed. Pull the seat bar down, lower the lift arms and place the bucket flat on the ground. Stop the engine. Raise the seat bar and operate the foot pedals to be sure that the pedals are firmly locked in the neutral position. Un-buckle the seat belt.
Seat Bar Maintenance See the Service Schedule (Page 1-1) for the correct service interval. Clean any debris or dirt from the moving parts [A] & [B]. Inspect the linkage bolts and nuts for tightness. Use a general purpose grease to lubricate the seat bar pivot pOints on each side of the cab [A]. If the seat bar system does not function correctly, check for free movement of each linkage part. Check for excessive wear. Adjust pedal control linkage. Replace parts that are worn or damaged. Use only genuine Melroe replacement parts.
Revised Sept. 93
-1-6-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
AIR CLEANER
A
Replacement of the Filter Element It is important to change the air filter element only when the service code (on the instrument panel) shows the symbol as shown in figure [A].
7
IIIII
:2j) r;Q .~~~
86.8881.s8
+5QG •._. .--c eel
01
I
I
8-12914
Service the air cleaner as follows: Remove the dust cover wing nut [B].
Remove the dust cover [Cl
Remove the wing nut holding the large air filter element
[0].
-1-7­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
AIR CLEANER (Cont'd) Remove the large filter element [A]. NOTE: Make sure all sealing surfaces are free of dirt and debris. Install the new filter element and tighten the wing nut. Install the dust cover and tighten the wing nut. Check the air intake hose for damage. Check the air cleaner housing for damage. Check to make sure all connections are tight.
Only replace the inner filter element under the following conditions [B]:
1. Every third time the outer filter is replaced.
2. When the service code shows the symbol (Page 1-7, Figure [A]), only after the outer filter element has been changed and the engine speed is at full RPM.
-1-8-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
FUEL SYSTEM Fuel Specifications Use only clean, high quality fuel. Use Grade No. 2 fuel above 40°F (4°C). Use Grade No.1 fuel at temperatures below 40°F (4°C).
Filling the Fuel Tank
A WARNING
Stop and cool the engine before adding fuel. NO SMOKING! Failure to obey warnings can cause an explosion or fire.
B
W-2063-0887
WRONG
Remove the fuel fill cap [A].
Use a clean, approved safety container to add fuel of the correct specifications. Add fuel only in an area that has free movement of air and no open flames or sparks. NO SMOKING! [8]. Install and tighten the fuel fill cap [A].
Fuel Filter
A WARNING
Always clean up spilled fuel or oil. Keep heat, flames, sparks or lighted tobacco away from fuel and oil. Failure to use care around combustibles can cause explosion or fire which can result in injury or death. W-21 03-1285
See the Service Schedule (Page 1-1) for the service interval when to remove the water from the fuel filter. Loosen the drain at the bottom of the filter element to drain the water from the filter [C]. See the Service Schedule (Page 1-1) for the service interval when to replace the fuel filter.
Use a filter wrench to remove the filter element (Item 1)
[0]. Revised Mar. 91
-1-9­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
FUEL SYSTEM (Cont'd) Clean the area around the filter housing. Put oil on the
seal of the new filter element. Install the fuel filter.
Remove the air from the fuel system (See Below).
Removing Air from the Fuel System
After replacing the fuel filter element or when the fuel tank
has run out of fuel, the air must be removed from the fuel
system to start the engine.
Open the vent on the fuel filter housing [A).
Operate the hand pump (priming bulb) until fuel flows from the vent with no air bubbles [8). Close the vent on the fuel filter housing [A].
Open the vent on the fuel injection pump [C]. Operate the hand pump (priming bulb) until the pump feels solid [B]. Tighten the vent plug [C]. Start the engine. It may be necessary to open the vent plug (at the injection pump) briefly until the engine runs smoothly.
A WARNING
Always clean up spilled fuel or oil. Keep heat, flames, sparks or lighted tobacco away from fuel and oil. Failure to use care around combustibles can cause explosion or fire which can result in injury or death. W-2103-1285
-1-10-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
ENGINE LUBRICATION SYSTEM
Checking Engine Oil Check the oil level every day. Before starting the engine for the work shift. Open the rear door. Remove the dipstick [A). Keep the oil level between the marks on the dipstick. Use a good quality motor oil that meets API Service Classification of CC, CD or CE (See Oil Chart below). RECOMMENDED SAE VISCOSITY NUMBER (LLIBRICATION OILS FOR ENGINE CRANKCASE)
.. SAE 40 or 2OW-50
..
SAE1OW_
= ..
I SAE l5W-40
I
A
K
I
I
I
I
'
I
SAE5W_
I
..
I
.
I SAE30W II.
ISAE-­
..
..)
SAE10W
' F-30 -20
-10
0
+10
+20 +30
+40 +50 +60
+70 +10 +to +100 .110 .120 +130+140
TEMPERAruRE RANGE ANllCiPATED BEFORE
NEXT OIL CHANGE
(DIESEL: USE API CLASSIFICAllON CC, CD OR CE)
Replacement of Oil and Filter See the Service Schedule (Page 1-1) for the service interval for replacing the engine oil and filter. 1. Run the engine until it is at operating temperature.
Stop the engine.
2. Open the rear door. Remove the drain plug [B).
Drain the oil into a container.
3. Remove the oil filter [C]. 4. Clean the filter housing surface. Put clean oil on the
new oil filter gasket. Install the filter and hand tighten
only.
5. Install and tighten the drain plug [B].
Revised Jan. 92
-1-11­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
ENGINE LUBRICATION SYSTEM (Cont'd) 6. Remove the filler cap from the valve cover [A].
7. Put 7.5 qts (7,1 L) of oil in the engine (See Oil Chart, Page 1-11) [B]. 8. Start the engine and let it run for several minutes. Stop the engine. Check for leaks and check the oil level. Add oil as needed if it is not at the top mark on the dipstick.
A WARNING
Always clean up spilled fuel or oil. Keep heat, flames, sparks or lighted tobacco away from fuel and oil. Failure to use care around combustibles can cause explosion or fire which can result in injury or death. W-2103-1285
Revised Apr. 91
-1-12-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
ENGINE COOLING SYSTEM Cleaning the Cooling System
Check the cooling system every day to prevent over-heating, loss of performance or engine damage.
A WARNING
Wear safety glasses to prevent eye injury when any of the following conditions exist: • When fluids are under pressure. • Flying debris or loose material is present. • Engine is running. • Tools are being used. W-2019-1285
Raise the rear grill. Use air pressure or water pressure to clean the top of the oil cooler [A1.
Raise the oil cooler and clean the top of the radiator [8). Check the cooling system for leaks.
Coolant Level
Open the rear door. Check the coolant level in the coolant recovery tank on the right side of the engine [C). The coolant recovery tank must be 1/3 full. Add pre-mixed coolant, 50% water and 50% ethylene glycol to the recovery tank if the coolant level is low.
-1-13­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
ENGINE COOLING SYSTEM (Cont'd) Removing Coolant from the Cooling System
A WARNING
Do not remove radiator cap when the engine Is hot. You can be seriously burned. W-207G-1285
1. Open the rear door. Open the rear grill. 2. Remove the radiator cap [A]. 3. Connect a hose to the engine block drain valve (Item
1) [8]. Open the drain valve and drain the coolant
into a container.
4. After all the coolant is removed, close the drain
valve.
NOTE: Protect the cooling system by adding pre-mixed 50% ethylene glycol and 50% water to the system. This mixture will protect the cooling system to -34°F (-36°C). 5. Mix the coolant in separate container (See
Specifications, Section 8 for correct capacity).
6. Fill the radiator with the pre-mixed coolant. Install
the radiator cap.
7. Fill the coolant recovery tank 1/3 full.
8. Run the engine until it is at operating temperature.
Stop the engine. Check the coolant level in the
recovery tank when cool. Add coolant to the
recovery tank as needed.
-1-14-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
ALTERNATOR BELT
Adjusting the Alternator Belt
To adjust the belt tension for the alternator, use the
following procedure:
Stop the engine.
Raise the operator cab (Page 1-5).
Loosen the alternator mounting bolt (Item 1) [A] & [B].
Loosen the adjusting bolt (Item 2) [A] & [B].
Move the alternator until the belt has 5/16' (8,0 mm)
movement at the middle of the belt span with 15 Ibs. (66
N) of force.
Tighten the adjustment bolt and mounting bolt.
Lower the operator cab. Close the rear door.
Revjsed Sept. 93
-1-15-­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
USING A BOOSTER BATrERY (JUMP STARTING) Procedure
A WARNING
Batteries contain acid which burns eyes and skin on contact. Wear goggles, protective clothing and rubber gloves to keep acid off body. In case of acid contact, wash immediately with water. In case of eye contact get prompt medical attention and wash eye with clean, cool water for at least 15 minutes. If electrolyte is taken internally drink large quantities of water or milk! DO NOT induce vomiting. Get prompt medical attention. W-2065-1296
If it is necessary to use a booster battery to start the engine, BE CAREFUL! There must be one person in the operator's seat and one person to connect and disconnect the battery cables. The ignition switch must be in the 'OFF position. The booster battery to be used must be 12 volt. Connect the end of the first cable (Item 1) to the positive (+) terminal of the booster battery. Connect the other end of the same cable (Item 2) to the starter [A]. Connect the end of the second cable (Item 3) to the negative (-) terminal of the booster battery. Connect the other end of the same cable (Item 4) to the engine [A]. Keep cables away from moving r,arts. Start the engine (Also See 'Pre-Heat Condition' in the Operation & Maintenance Manual). After the engine has started, remove the ground (-) cable (Item 4) first [A]. Remove the cable from the starter. Close the rear door.
A WARNING
Keep arcs, sparks, flames and li~hted tobacco away from tJatteries. When lumping from booster battery make final connection (negative) at engine frame. Do not jump start or charge a frozen or damaged battery. Warm battery to 60°F. (16°C.) before connecting to a charger. Unplug charger before connecting or disconnecting cables to battery. Never lean over battery while boosting, testing or charging. Battery gas can explode and cause serious injury.
W-2066-1296
-1-16-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
HYDRAULIC/HYDROSTATIC SYSTEM Checking and Adding Fluid Use only recommended fluid in the hydraulic system (See Specifications, Section 8 for the correct fluid).
To check the reservoir, use the following procedure:
With the loader on a level surface. Lower the lift arms and
tilt the Bob-Tach fully back. Stop the engine.
Remove the dipstick (Item 1) [Al
The fluid level must be between the marks on the dipstick.
If fluid is needed, remove the fill cap [A].
Add the fluid as needed to bring the level to the top mark on the dipstick [B]. Install the fill cap.
Hydraulic/Hydrostatic Filter Replacement See the Service Schedule (Page 1-1) for the correct service interval. Open the rear door. Use a filter wrench and remove the filter element [C]. Clean the surface of the filter housing where the element seal contacts the housing. Put clean oil on the rubber seal of the filter element. Install and hand tighten the filter element.
Hydraulic Reservoir Breather Cap See Service Schedule (Page 1-1) for the correct service interval. Remove the breather cap and replace it with a new cap [0]. Make sure the baffle washer and rubber gasket (I nset) are installed in the hydraulic reservoir [0].
Revised Mar. 91
-1-17­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
SPARK ARRESTOR MUFFLER Cleaning Procedure See the Service Schedule (Page 1-1) for the service interval for cleaning the spark arrestor muffler. Do not operate the loader with a defective exhaust system.
IMPORTANT
This loader is factory equipped with a U.S.D.A. Forestry Service approved spark arrestor muffler. It is necessary to do maintenance on this spark arrestor muffler to keep it in working condition. The spark arrestor muffler must be serviced by dumping the spark chamber every 100 hours of operation.
A WARNING
If this machine is operated on flammable forest, brush or grass covered land, it must be equipped with a spark arrestor attached to the exhaust system and maintained in working order. Failure to do so will be in violation of California State Law, Section 4442 PRC.
When an engine is running in an enclosed area, fresh air must be added to avoid concentration of exhaust fumes. If the engine is stationary, vent the exhaust outside. Exhaust fumes contain odorless, invisible gases which can kill without warning.
Make reference to local laws and regulations for spark arrestor requirements.
W-205Q-1285
1-2022-0595
Stop engine and allow the muffler to cool before cleaning the spark chamber. Wear safety goggles. Failure to obey can cause serious injury.
Stop the engine. Open the rear door and rear grill.
W-2011-1285
Remove the plug at the bottom of the muffler [A].
Never use machine In atmosphere with explosive dust or gases or where exhaust can contact flammable material. Failure to obey warnings can cause injury or death.
A WARNING
W-2068-1285
When the engine is runnin' during service, the steering levers must be In neutral and the parking brake engaged. Failure to do so can cause injury or death.
W-2006-0284
Start the engine and run for about 10 seconds while a second person, wearing safety glasses, holds a piece of wood over the outlet of the muffler. Stop the engine. Install and tighten the plug. Lower the rear grill and close the rear door.
-1-18­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
TIRE MAINTENANCE Wheel Nuts See the Service Schedule (Page 1-1) for the service interval to check the wheel nuts. The correct torque is 105-115 ft.-Ibs. (142-156 Nm) [A].
B
Tire Rotation Check the tires regularly for wear, damage and pressure (See Specifications, Section 8 for the correct tire pressure). Rear tires usually wear faster than front tires. To keep tire wear even, move the front tires to the rear and the rear tires to the front [8]. It is important to keep the same size tires on each side of the loader. If different sizes are used, each tire will be turning at a different speed and cause excessive wear. The tread bars of all the tires must face the same direction.
8-09976
Recommended tire pre'ssure must be maintained to avoid excessive tire wear and loss of stability and handling capability. Tire Mounting .Tires are to be repaired only by an authorized person using the proper procedures and safety equipment. Tires and rims must always be checked for correct size before mounting. Check rim and tire bead for damage. The rim flange must be cleaned and free of rust. The tire bead and rim flange must be lubricated with a rubber lubricant before mounting the tire, avoid excessive pressure which can rupture the tire and cause serious injury or death. During inflation of the tire, check the tire pressure frequently to avoid over-inflation.
A WARNING
Do not inflate tires above specified pressure. Failure to use correct tire mounting procedure can cause an explosion which can result in injury or death. W-2078-1285
-1-19-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
FINAL DRIVE TRANSMISSION (CHAINCASE) Checking and Adding Oil The chaincase uses the same type of oil as the hydrauliclhydrostatic system (See Specifications, Section 8 for the correct oil). To check the chaincase oil level, use the following procedure: Drive the loader on a level surface. Stop the engine. Remove the plug (Item 1) from the front of the chaincase housing [A]. If oil can be reached with the tip of the finger through the hole the oil level is correct. If the level is low, add oil through the check plug hole until the oil flows from the hole. Install and tighten the plug.
To drain the oil from the chaincase, remove the cover which is installed over the drain plug [B].
Remove the drain plug (Item 1) at the rear of the chaincase and drain the oil into a container [C].
FAN GEARBOX Checking Grease Level See the Service Schedule (Page 1-1) for the correct service interval. Raise the operator cab (Page 1-5). Remove the plug (Item 1) to check the lubricant level [OJ. If the level is low, add 90W gear lube through the check plug hole until the lubricant flows from the hole. Install and tighten the plug.
Revised June 91
-1-20­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
DRIVE BELT
Adjustment The tool listed will be needed to do the following
procedure:
MEL-1405 - Bar
MEL-1406 - Spring Scale
See the Service Schedule (Page 1-1) for the service
interval.
To adjust the drive belt between the engine flywheel and
hydrostatic pump pulley, use the following procedure:
Stop the engine. Open the rear door.
Disconnect the negative (-) cable from the battery.
Remove the belt shield holddown clips [A].
Remove the belt shield [B].
The pulley tensioner is located between the flywheel and pump·pulley. Loosen the bolt at the pulley tensioner [C].
Use tool to move the tension pulley down [0]. See Page 1-22 for correct procedure to adjust the drive belt. Tighten the bolt at the pulley tension bracket [C].
Revised Aug. 92
-1-21-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
DRIVE BELT (Cont'd) Use the tools to check the belt tension. 1. Install the tool on the drive belt. The pin (Item 1) must be pulled tight against the engine drive pulley [A]. 2. Make a mark (Item 2) on the cast flange just below the tool handle [A]. 3. Use a spring scale and install on the tool handle. The line of pull (Item 3) on the spring scale must follow the arrowed line [A]. NEW BELT: A new belt is one with a 1/2 hour or less of operating time. With 151bs. (67 N) of force the tool should move 1.25' (32 mm) (the width of the tool handle). NOTE: When a NEW belt is installed, run the engine for approximately 5 minutes. Then the belt tension must be checked and re-adjusted as needed, to 15 Ibs. (67 N) spring scale force. USED BELT: With 12 Ibs. (53 N) of force, the tool should move 1.25' (32 mm) (the width of the tool handle), if not, re-adjust pulley tensioner.
Drive Belt Replacement Stop the engine. Open the rear door. Raise the operator cab (Page 1-5). Disconnect the negative (-) cable from the battery. Remove the belt shield holddown clips. Remove the belt shield [B]. Remove the fan drive belt. The pulley tensioner is located between the flywheel and pump pulley. Loosen and remove the bolt from the pulley tensioner [C]. Remove the pulley tensioner assembly. Remove the drive belt from the pump pulley and flywheel. Remove the drive belt from the loader [0]. Install the new drive belt. Install the pulley tensioner assembly. Install the fan drive belt. Adjust the drive belt (See the above procedure). Connect the negative (-) cable to the battery.
Revised Aug. 92
-1-22-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
LUBRICATION OF THE LOADER
Procedure Lubricate the loader as specified in the Service Schedule (Page 1-1) for the best performance of the loader. Always use a good quality lithium based multi-purpose grease when you lubricate the loader. Apply the lubricant
until extra grease shows.
Lubricate the following locations on the loader:
1. Rod End Lift Cylinder (both sides) [A].
2. Base End Lift Cylinder (both sides) [B].
3. Lift Arm Pivot Pin (both sides) [C].
4. Base End lilt Cylinder [0].
-1-23-
750 S.ies Loader Seriice Manual
LUBRICATION OF THE LOADER (Cont'd) 5. Rod End Tilt Cylinder [A].
6. Bob-Tach Pivot Pin (both sides) [B]. 7. Bob-Tach Wedge (both sides) [B].
8. 250 HOURS: Steering Lever Shaft (2) [C].
-1-24-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
REMOTE START SWITCH Procedure
The tool listed will be needed to do the following procedure: MEL-1398 - Remote Start Switch The short wire harness assembly is required when the operator cab is in the raised position for service and the serviceman needs to start the engine. The operator cab wire harness connectors must be separated from the engine wiring harness connector in the cab. Connect the remote start switch to these connectors [A]. This remote start switch is required when the serviceman is adjusting the steering linkage, checking the hydraulic/hydrostatic system.
-1-25­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
DIAGNOSTIC TOOL Procedure The tool listed will be needed to do the following procedure: MEL-1400 - Diagnostic Tool Stop the engine. Lift and block the loader (Page 1-2). Remove the dust cap from the diagnostic connector plug. Connect the diagnostic tool plug into the loader connector;
SIN 11078 & Below [A]
SIN 11079 & Above [C]
Use the diagnostic tool as instructed by the instructions on the tool and owners manual to make service checks of the system operating unit and other components;
SIN 11078 & Below [8]
SIN 11079 & Above [0]
SENDER AND SENSOR Service Checks Use the following information when checking the senders and sensor with a volt/ohmmeter. Component TEMPERATURE SENDER 70 degree F. (21 degree C.) ....... 970 ohms 80 degree F. (27 degree C.) ...... 1013 ohms ENGINE OIL PRESSURE SENDER o PSI 3 ohms Max.
6 PSI (41 kPa) ............ 7 ohms Min.
50 PSI (345 kPa) ............ 45 ohms
70 PSI (483 kPa) ............ 59 ohms
TRANSMISSION CHARGE PRESSURE SENDER o PSI 0-5 ohms
100 PSI (690 kPa) ............ 58 ohms
130 PSI (896 kPa) ............ 75 ohms
150 PSI (1034 kPa) ........... 87 ohms
FUEL SENDER Full 30 ohms Empty 270 ohms RPM SENSOR Continuity Resistance of 250-550 ohms. Set clearance as follows from the flywheel: Without Plastic Tip-O.05' (1,27 mm)
*With Plastic Tip-Plastic Tip to Touch Flywheel
Continuity Resistance of 3000-3500 ohms. Set clearance as follows from the flywheel:
Without Plastic Tip-O.1 0' (2,54 mm)
With Plastic Tip-O.05' (1,27 mm)
*The plastic tip is used as a gauge to set the RPM SENSOR, the plastic tip is designed to come off after the engine is started.
Revised Jan. 92
-1-26-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
MONITOR SERVICE CODES
One of the following Alphabetic Codes may appear on your monitor.
battery
Engine COOlant Level
Engine Oil Pressure Engine Speed Air Filter Hydrostatic Fluid Temperature
One of the following Numeric Codes win appear following one of the above Alphabetic Codes. Example:
t:•• :0 0:' 0:0 D:'/7/ t=. t=o D=. o=oot_o (--'J Shut Down
Wiring Not Connected Wiring Shorted
Sensor No Signal Sensor Out of Range
SC01~198
Reviser' Mar. 91
-1-27­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
MONITOR SERVICE CODES
A WARNING
The following list references the defect codes that are
transmitted to the instrument panel display which can occur. Some service procedures for correcting the problems can be found in this manual and other procedures must be performed ONLY BY QUALIFIED BOBCAT SERVICE PERSONNEL.
Instructions are necessary before operating or servicing machine. Read and understand the Operation & Maintenance Manual, Handbook and signs (decals) on machine. Follow warnings and instructions in the manuals when making repairs, adjustments or servicing. Check for correct function after adjustments, repairs or service. Failure to follow instructions can cause injury or death.
W-2003-1298
~--~--~---~
-----
-
-
-~-----
SERVICE CODES ---
-
~--
-
DISPLAY READS
SUBJECT
-
-----~--
-- - -
---
-
--- -
ECL1
SHUTDOWN, No Coolant
Engine Coolant Temp.
EC-1.1 EC-2.1
SHUTDOWN, Engine Temperature WARNING, Engine Temperature
Co
'_0
'-0 0=0
Co oJ
160 0:0
0=0.0=0
G :
Engine Oil Pressure
'-0 ,-. rEo o~ 0<'0 [ ] .
Co ':;0 iidJ Dc.o.tldJ
Co .:0 0:0 0:0 ~o '_0 0:' D=O 0cO. =0
Air Filter
,-. '-0
rEo
0=0 o~
.:_ .:0 0:0 D:OcDc;;.O
[]
a
Battery
':0 0:0 0:0 0:' 0:0 !8l
1_' DcG D=O 0=0.0=0
Fuel Level
Co _;.__:0 -i '-0 ''0 0=0 [ ] 1:0 (0.0;::0
Revised Mar. 91
EC3 EC4
Wiring Not Connected Wiring Shorted
EC5 EC7
High Sensor Voltage Sensor Out Of Range
EP 1 EP2 EP3
SHUTDOWN, Pressure WARNING, Pressure Wiring Not Connected
EP4
Wiring Shorted High Sensor Voltage Sensor Out Of Range
SHUTDOWN, Engine Speed Too High
EP5 EP7 ES 1
Engine Speed
---
--
CONDITION
Engine Coolant Level_
':0 Co _:0 D:O 0:0 [] '_0 '_a '_0 OeQ' L=O
--
E8-2.1
WARNING, Engine Speed Slightly High Sensor No Signal
ES-6 ES-7 AF2
Sensor Out Of Range
WARNING, Restriction Too High
AF6 b-2.1
Sensor No Signal
WARNING, Bad Battery
b-2.2
WARNING, Battery Voltage Low
FUEL2
WARNING, Low Level
FUEL3 FUEL4 FUEL5
Wiring Not Connected Wiring Shorted High Sensor Voltage
FUEL7
Sensor Out Of Range
-1-28-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
­
SERVICE CODES SUBJECT Hydrostatic Charge Filter Condition ,'1 .-a D'a oOa
0'0 ';:1 ';:0 OdJ o:OoOdJ
CONDl'nON
DISPLAY READS
.8
Hydrostatic Fluid
HF1 2
WARNING, High Restriction
HF1-6
Sensor No Signal
HP 1
SHUTDOWN, Pressure
HP2 HP3 HP4
WARNING, Pressure Wiring Not Connected Wiring Shorted
HP5 HP7
High Sensor Voltage Sensor Out Of Range
Hydrostatic Fluid
HC 1
SHUTDOWN, Temperature
Temperature 1=' 1'0 n=a
HC2
WARNING, Temperature
HC3
Wiring Not Connected
HC4 HC5
Wiring Shorted High Sensor Voltage
HC6
Sensor No Signal
HC7
Sensor Out Of Range
Pressure 1:1 1:1 0:0 o:;:'a 0:0 1=1 1=0 0=0 0=0.0=0
0=0 p:o 1:_ 1:0 0:0 0;':0.0;;;0
Revised Mar. 91
[3]
[]
-1-29­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
TILT CYLINDER Checking the Tilt Cylinder .................. 2-5 Removaf and Instanation ................... 2-5 Rod End Seal. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5 TROUBLESHOOTING Chart ........................... 2-5
TIGHTEN ALL HARDWARE PER SIZE TO GRADE 5 TORQUE (SEE STANDARD TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS FOR BOLTS, SECTION 8) UNLESS OTHERWISE SPECIFIED. Revised Jan. 94
750 Series Loader
Service Manua'
TROUBLESHOOTING THE BOSS® & LCD DISPLAY
BOSS
LCD Display
1. Temperature related 12 volt supply and shutdown codes BOSS failure. *2. when no heating occurs.
Check stored defects with the BOSS tool. If defect list has EC1, HC1, EC2.1, HC2. EP3, EP7, HP7, B2.2, low fuel, Fuel 7 and last occurrence hr. readings are within a hundredth, the BOSS is defective and must be replaced. Using a voltmeter, check the alternator output.
* NOTE: You may have some or all of the codes listed. You will have high temps, high press, low voltage and low fuel.
3.
Intermittent code of Sensor No Signal or ES6 while engine No RPM's. running.
1. ES6 will occur if the loader is stalled or shutdown during run cycle. The code is generated due to the lack of RPM and the existence of residual pressure in the system.
Display is dead - No Lack of 5.0 volts Icons, Bar Graphs, regulated power. Hourmeter.
1. Check pin 'A' for 5.0 volts. If 5.0 volts is present replace the display. 2. If no power exists at pin 'A', install BOSS back-up to confirm the BOSS system. 3. If the problem still exists, check the harness for continuity.
LCD DISPLAY CONNECTOR ABCDE
I 1 1! J 8,
~
iI
~
~
Q.
I Negative Com .•5 to 1.5 Volts
i i ..
I
12Volt-BackLight
1 Gr=ou . . ..n...._ d __
I Positive Com. 3.5 to 4 Volts
5.0 Volts Regulated Power Power Display Operation
During an active Low voltage (5.0) WARNING display, triggered reset. reset occurs and the hourmeter becomes all zero's. Garbled missing etc.
message, The display is not fault segments, tolerant. Also can be an indication of poor internal connections.
1. 2.
1. Turn the ignition switch 'OFF' and re-start. A fault is an invalid message that the display tries to display. Generally a fault occurs if communications of two messages are combined on the display.
After glow sequence or after a WARNING goes away, the Icon remains 'ON'.
1. Turn the key 'OFP' and re-start.
No Bar Graphs, No Bad display or BOSS Hours. is not communicating.
1. 2. 3. *4.
* NOTE: The display has caused the problem by locking the communication lines and stopping communications from the BOSS.
Added Apr. 92 _ .
Turn the ignition switch 'OFF'. Re-starting will return hourmeter reading. If re-starting will not return hourmeter reading, check pins 'B' & 'C' as stated in Step 5 below.
-1-30-
5. 6. 7.
Plug in the BOSS tool and start the engine.
If data is being received by the BOSS tool, the
BOSS unit is not the cause of the problem.
If no data is received at the BOSS too.
disconnect the LCD display.
If messages are now received at the tool, the
display is the problem. If problem still exists go to
Step 5.
Check pins 'B' & 'C' for Signal.
If there is no signal, install BOSS back-up unit.
If the problem still exists, check the harness for
continUity.
750 Series Loader Service Manual
HYDRAULIC SYSTEM Page Number CONTROL PEDALS
Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-16
Removal and Installation ................... 2-16
DA~~~~;raX~TX~a)?Ji~~
HYDRAULIC SYSTEM
................... 2-18
HAND CONTROLS
Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-19
Removal and Installation ................... 2-20
HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (753)
Checking the Main Relief Valve ................ 2-7
Main Relief Valve Removal and Installation ........... 2-8
Removal and Installation ................... 2-9
HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE {753H) Adjusting the Dual Pressure Main Rehef Valve LOW Setting) . . . . . Adjusting the Dual Pressure Main Relief Valve High Setting) ... Checking the Dual Pressure Main Relief Valve Low Setting) . . . . . Checking the Dual Pressure Main Relief Valve High Setting) ...
2-8D 2-8E 2-8A 2-8B
HYDRAULIC FILTER HOUSING
Removal and Installation ................... 2-13
HYDRAULIC FLUID RESERVOIR
Removal and Installation .................. , 2-15
HYDRAULIC PUMP
Checking the Output of the Pump ............... 2-10
RemovaT and Installation ................... 2-11
Checking the Output of the 'H I FLOW' pump .......... 2-10A
HYDRAULIC SYSTEM INFORMATION
Flare Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . O-ring Face Seal Connections ........... '..... , Straig.ht Thread O-ring Fitting ................ TubeTines and Hoses ....................
2-2 2-2 2-2 2-2
LIFT CYLINDERS
Checking the Lift Cylinder(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3
Removaf and Instanation ................... 2-3
PEDAL INTERLOCK LINKAGE
Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-17
Removal and Installation ................... 2-17
SELECT VALVE Check the Main Relief Valve in the 'High Horsepower' Select Valve .......................... 2-8F TILT CYLINDER
Checking the lilt Cylinder .................. 2-5
RemovaT and Installation ................... 2-5
Rod End Seal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5
TROUBLESHOOTING
Chart ........................... 2-5
TIGHTEN ALL HARDWARE PER SIZE TO GRADE 5 TORQUE (SEE
STANDARD TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS FOR BOLTS, SECTION 8) UNLESS OTHERWISE SPECIFIED. Revised Jan. 94
750 Series Loader Service Manual
Both new and rebuilt engines are available from Melroe
Available at your local Bobcat Dealer.
MELNOrctWJ>ANr
_'2
JJ(bobcot
HYDRAULIC I HYDROSTATIC SYSTEM OPERATION To Be Used With
HYDRAULIC I HYDROSTATIC FLOW CHART For Model
753 Chart #6720316 (Printed May 1990)
= = = = = = = = = = CHART LEGEND = = = = = = = = = = • FLUID RESERVOIR: Cap.: . . . . . . . . . . . 14 Qts. (13,2 L) • • • •
BREATHER FILL CAP SCREEN,. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 Mesh DIVERTER VALVE (OPTIONAL) a. Diverter Valve Diagram Solenoid Not Energized (Front Auxiliaries) b. Diverter Valve Diagram - Solenoid Energized (Rear Auxiliaries) c. Electrical Solenoid d. Filter • REAR AUXILIARY QUICK COUPLERS (OPTIONAL) • FRONT AUXILIARY QUICK COUPLERS . , IN-LINE FILTER • HYDROSTATIC MOTOR • LIFT CYLINDERS • MAIN RELIEF VALVE: 2550-2600 PSI (17582-17927 kPa) @ Front Quick Couplers • HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE • LOAD CHECK VALVES (3) . , PORT RELIEF VALVE, ... 3500 PSI (24132 kPa)
(I BUCKET POSITION VALVE (OPTIONAL) •
I• • • •

FLOW ADJUSTMENT VALVE CHARGE PRESSURE SENDER HYDRAULIC/HYDROSTATIC FILTER: #4 Synthetic Media TEMPERATURE SENSOR DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE SWITCH: (Normally Closed) 34-44 PSI (234-303 kPa) FILTER BY-PASS VALVE: 45-55 PSI (311-379 kPa)
• OIL COOLER
. , HYDRAULIC PUMP, Gear Type
13.0 GPM (49,2 L/miJ1.) @ 2480 RPM @ 1150 PSI (7929 kPa) • HYDROSTATIC PUMPS • REPLENISHING VALVES CHARGE IN-LET RELIEF, 155-165 PSI (1069-1138 kPa) @ 13.0 GPM (49,2 L/min.) @ 2480 RPM W/120 0 F. (49 0 C.) Fluid
Ie
• ANTI-CAVITATION VALVE . , ELECTRICAL AUXILIARY SOLENOIDS • PORT RELIEF VALVE,. . . . 2500 PSI (17238 kPa) I) OIL COOLER BY-PASS,. . . . 400 PSI (2758 kPa) • TILT CYLINDER . , CHECK VALVE • UN-LOADING SPOOL • PRESSURE RELIEF VALVE . , FLOW CONTROL SPOOL 6720316 6-90) Revised (3-91)
(Sheet 2 Of 2)
Printed in U.S.A.
FLUID FLOW EXPLANATION The fluid flows by gravity from the reservoir. to the hydraulic pump • . The hydraulic pump. is a 'gear type t pump and is driven by a shaft through the hydrostatic pumps • . The fluid from the hydraulic pump. goes to the hydraulic control valve • . The hydraulic control valve. has an adjustable relief valve • . When all spools of the control valve. are in the neutral position t the fluid goes through the control valve. and
CI .
to the oil cooler If one of the spools is activated t the fluid goes out the respective port and to either the base end t or rod end of the cylinder(s) • • . As the fluid goes into one end of the cylinder(s) • • the fluid from the other side of the cylinder flows back into the control valve. ' ALSO SEE BUCKET POSITIONING SYSTEM OPERATION (OPTIONAL). When the cylinder(s) • • reaches the end of the stroke, the fluid attains the setting of the main relief valve. , it will open and let the fluid by-pass the hydraulic circuit (internally) and go back to the oil cooler
CI which becomes ,tcharge supply fluid' for the hydrostatic
pumps • . When the spool goes back to neutral position, then there is fluid available for the other sections of the control valve • . Two sections of the control valve. can be used at the same time if the main relief valve. is not open.
CI
The fluid flows from the oil cooler through the #4 synthetic media filter. to ~the hydrostatic pumps. This fluid is called 'charge supply fluid'. In the hydrostatic pumps. the fluid is against the charge relief valve' and four replenishing valves • . The hydrostatic pumps. do not need the full volume of fluid flow so there is extra fluid. This extra fluid goes to the charge relief valve' . The replenishing valves. open and let fluid into the pumps. for replenishing, lubrication and cooling. With the replenishing valves. open this flow of fluid becomes 'drive loop fluid'. When the steering levers are in neutral, the pumps. and the motors. are not working, but do have charge pressure fluid. When the steering levers are moved, the swashplates in the pumps . , are angled and the fluid is forced out of the pressure
~ide of the pumps . , and
to the motors • . This flow of fluid is called 'drive pressure,t, Drive pressure is much higher than charge pressure causing the replenishing valves. to close, aI/owing the flow of the fluid to go to the motors • . There are two hydrostatic pumps. and two hydrostatic motors • . One pump and one motor work together as a pair to drive on one side of the loader. The other pump and motor work as a pair to drive the opposite side of the loader. The hydrostatic motors. are a 'roller-gerolern type. The case drain fluid from the right motor. goes to the hydrostatic pump • . Case drain fluid from the left motor. joins
return fluid from the auxiliary section of the control valve. and goes to the reservoir • . The filter. has a by-pass valve. to allow fluid flow when the fluid will not go through the filter element (plugged). The oil cooler by-pass .will open when the lift arms are lowered quickly with a heavy load in the bucket. This happens because a large amount of fluid is pushed out of the lift arm cylinders. through the control valve. and into the oil cooler • . The by-pass valve. will also open when the fluid is cold and is too thick for fluid flow to go through the oil cooler. and filter • . BUCKET POSITIONING SYSTEM OPERATION (OPTIONAL)
The lift section and tilt section of the control valve. work together to position the bucket as the lift arms, of the loader, are being raised. When the lift arms are being raised, the hydraulic pump' fluid flow is directed to the base end of the lift cylinders • . The fluid from the rod end of the li'ft cylinders. returns to the bucket position valve' and is directed to the center of the flow-control spool
I) . The flow-control spool I) and adjustable
metering orifice. directs this flow. A percentage of the fluid is directed over the adjustable metering orifice. to level the bucket. The rest of the fluid is directed through the orifice in the flow-control spool
I) and on to the return port of the control valve. (lift section).
The fluid flow from the flow-control spool
I) and adjustable metering orifice. are against
the un-loading spool • . The un-loading spool. moves to allow extension of the tilt cylinder. as the lift cylinders. raise the lift arms. The pressure relief valve
fa is to relief fluid from the base end of the tilt cylinder. if the
bucket is fully rolled out and the lift cylinders. are still extending. DIVERTER VALVE SYSTEM OPERATION (OPTIONAL) NOT ENERGIZED
The fluid under pressure from the hydraulic pump' goes to the pilot line to the diverter valve block e
. This fluid is called 'pilot pressure' fluid. When the electrical solenoid ec
is NOT ENERG IZED, the pilot pressure fluid will have no function. When the electrical solenoid. valve e
I
at the control valve. is energized
th~
fluid will flow into the diverter
tlp1' port, and through to the '01' port (front quick coupler •
). Return fluid
comes from the '02' port (front quick coupler. ), and returns through the 'P2' port and back to the control valve • . When the electrical solenoid. is energized in the opposite direction, the fluid flow will change to the opposite direction.
ENERGIZED When the electrical solenoid 8c is ENERGIZED, the pilot pressure fluid will put the check valves for '01 & 02' ports on their seats and open the check valves for 'F1 & F2' ports. With the electrical solenoid. , at the control valve. , energized at the same time the fluid will flow into the diverter valve 8
'p1' port, and through to the 'F1' port (rear
auxiliary quick couplers. ). Return fluid comes from the 'F2 port (rear auxiliary quick couplers. ), and returns through the 'p2' port and back to the control valve • . When the electrical solenoid. is energized in the oposite direction (with electrical solenoid 8c still energized), the fluid flow will change to the opposite diection.
~bobcat
HYDRAULIC I HYDROSTATIC FLOW CHART For Model
753
Chart #6720316 (Printed May 1990)
NOTE Chart shows oil flow in Forward Drive Position and with Hydraulic Cylinders Partially Extended. For Hydraulic/ Hydrostatic System Operation, refer to Sheet 2 of this publication.
NOTE Chart shows fluid flo Position and with the E Valve in operation.
NON ENERGIZED
d
°
0
1 ILOT ~
I'
@
([D
o~
ENERGIZED
6)-.
r5 fD irJif t et 0
fD
6720316 (5-901
(Sheet 1 of 2)
Printed in
U.~
c::::J
RED - - - - - - BLUE - - - - - GREEN - - - - ORANGE - - - LT. ORANGE -
High Pressure Low Pressure Case Drain & Reservoir Charge Pressure Bucket Positioning Fluid
, in the Lifting Icket Postioning

~
()
•t
MCl118 I.
~

®
bobcat
HYDRAULIC I HYDROSTATIC SYSTEM OPERATIO,N To Be Used With
HYDRAULIC I HYDR.OSTATIC FLOW CHART For Model
753 (SIN 19227 & Above) Chart #6722406 (Printed November 1993)
='~
CHART LEGEND
o FLUID RESERVOIR:
(I BUCKET POSITION VALVE (OPTIONAL)
Cap.: . . . . . . . . . . . 14 Qts. (T3',2 L)
61)
• BREATHER . , FILL CAP SCREEN, ........ 60 Mesh • DIVERTER VALVE (OPTIONAL) a. Dive'rter Valve Diagram-Solenoid Not Energized (Front Auxiliaries) b. Diverter Valve Diagram - Solenoid Energized (Rear Auxiliaries) c. Electrical Solenoid d. Filter (I REAR AUXILIARY QUICK COUPLERS (OPTIONAL)
., •
tt
• • • • •
FRONT AUXILIARY QUICK COUPLERS CASE DRAIN FILTER . Sintered BronLe HYDROSTATIC MOTOR LIFT CYLINDERS MAIN RELIEF VALVE: 2550-2600 PSI (17582-17927 kPa) @ Front Quick Couplers

HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE
I) LOAD CHECK VALVES {2}
e PORT RELIEF VALVE,. . . .(24132 3500 PSI kPa)
~''=~=

I) ED>
I> .,
e
8) '
.,
FLOW ADJUSTMENT VALVE CHARGE PRESSURE SENDER HYDRAULIC/HYDROSTATIC FILTER: #4 Synthetic Media TEMPERATURE SENSOR DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE SWITCH: (Normally Closed) 34-44 PSI (234-303 kPa) FILTER BY-PASS VALVE: 45-55 PSI (311-379 kPa) OIL COOLER HYDRAULIC PUMP, Gear Type 13.0 GPM (49,2 Llmin.) @ 2480 RPM @ 1150 PSI (7929 kPa) HYDROSTATIC PUMPS HIGH PRESSURE RELIEF/REPLENISHIIlG VALVES ... 5000PSI (34475 kPa) CHARGE IN-LET RELIEF, 155-165 PSI (1069-1138 kPa) @ 13.0 GPM (49,2 Llmin.) @ 2480 RPM W/120 0 F. (49 0 C.) Fluid REPLENISHING VALVES
e ANTI-CAVITATION VALVE
• ELECTRICAL AUXILIARY SOLENOIDS • PORT RELIEF VALVE,. . . . 2500 PSI (17238 kPa) TILT CYLINDER CHECK VALVE UN-LOADING SPOOL • PRESSURE RELIEF VALVE (8 FLOW CONTROL SPOOL
CD CD
e
6722406 (11-93)
(Sheet 2 Of 2)
FLUID FLOW EXPLANATION The fluid flows by gravity from the reservoir. to the hydraulic pump' . The hydraulic pump' is a 'gear type' pump and is driven by a shaft through the hydrostatic pumps' . The fluid from the hydraulic pump' goes to the hydraulic control valve. .
<
~
r The hydraulic control valve. has an adjustable relief valve • . When all spools of the control valve. are in the neutral position, the fluid goes through the control valve. and to the oil cooler • . If one of the spools is activated, the fluid goes out the respective port and to either the base end, or rod end of the cylinder(s) As the fluid goes into one end of the cylinder(s) the fluid from the other side of the cylinder flows back
CO •.
CO •
into the control valve • . ALSO SEE BUCKET POSITIONING SYSTEM OPERATION (OPTIONAL).
CO •
When the cylinder(s) reaches the end of the stroke, the fluid attains the setting of the main relief valve. , it will open and let the fluid by-pass the hydraulic circuit (internally) and go back to the oil cooler. which becomes 'charge supply fluid' for the hydrostatic pumps' . When the spool goes back to neutral position, then there is fluid available for the other sections of the control va,lve • . Two sections of the control valve. can be used at the same time if the main relief valve. is not open. ~
The fluid flows from the oil cooler. through the #4 synthetic media filter. to the hydrostatic pumps'. This fluid is called 'charge supply fluid'. In the hydrostatic pumps' the fluid is against the charge relief valve' and four replenishing valves • . The hydrostatic pumps' do not need the full volume of fluid flow so there is extra fluid. This extra fluid goes to the charge relief valve' . The replenishing valves. open and let fluid into the pumps' for replenishing, lubrication and cooling. With the replenishing valves. open this flow of fluid becomes 'drive loop fluid'. When the steering levers are in neutral, the pumps' and the motors' are not working, but do have charge pressure fluid. When the steering levers are moved, the swash plates in the pumps' are angled and the fluid is forced out of the pressure side of the pumps' and to the motors' . This flow of fluid is called 'drive pressure'. Drive pressure is much higher than charge pressure causing the replenishing valves. to close, allowing the flow of the fluid to go to the motors . , . There are two hydrostatic pumps' and two hydrostatic motors' . One pump and one motor work together as a pair to drive on one side of the loader. The other pump and motor work as a pair to drive the opposite side of the loader. The hydrostatic motors' are a
II
roller-geroler' type. The case drain fluid from the right
motor' goes to the hydrostatic pump' . Case drain fluid from the left motor' joins
< 1
1 return fluid from the auxiliary section of the control valve. and goes to the reservoir • . The filter. has a by-pass valve' to allow fluid flow when the fluid will not go through the filter element (plugged). BUCKET POSITIONING SYSTEM OPERATION (OPTIONAL)
The lift section and tilt section of the control valve. work together to position the bucket as the lift arms, of the loader, are being raised. When the lift arms are being raised, the hydraulic pump. fluid flow is directed to the base end of the lift cylinders • . The fluid from the rod end of the lift cylinders. returns to the bucket position valve' and is directed to the center of the flow-control spool
(8 . The flow-control spool (8
and adjustable
metering orifice. directs this flow. A percentage of the fluid is directed over the adjustable metering orifice. to level the bucket. The rest of the fluid is directed through the orifice in the flow-control spool
(8
and on to the return port of the control valve. (lift section).
The fluid flow from the flow-control spool
(8
and adjustable metering orifice. are against
the un-loading spool • . The un-loading spool. moves to allow extension of the tilt cylinder. as the lift cylinders. raise the lift arms. The pressure relief valve. is to relief fluid from the base end of the tilt cylinder. if the bucket is fully rolled out and the lift cylinders. are still extending. DIVERTER VALVE SYSTEM OPERATION (OPTIONAL) NOT ENERGIZED
The fluid under pressure from the hydraulic pump. goes to the pilot line to the diverter valve block
e.
This fluid is called 'pilot pressure' fluid. When the electrical solenoid
ec
is NOT ENERGIZED, the pilot pressure fluid will have no function. When the electrical solenoid., at the control valve. is energized the fluid will flow into the diverter valve
e
'p1' port, and through to the '01' port (front quick coupler . ) . Return fluid
comes from the '02' port (front quick coupler. ), and returns through the 'p2' port and back to the control valve • . When the electrical solenoid. is energized in the opposite direction, the fluid flow will change to the opposite direction.
ENERGIZED
When the electrical solenoid
ec is ENEAG IZED, the pilot pressure fluid will put the check
valves for 'D1 & D2' ports on their seats and open the check valves for 'F1 & F2' ports. With the electrical solenoid
I) , at the control valve. , energized at the same time the
fluid will flow into the diverter valve
e
'p1' port, and through to the 'F1' port (rear
auxiliary quick couplers. ). Return fluid comes from the 'F2 port (rear auxiliary quick couplers. ), and returns through the 'p2' port and back to the control valve • . When the electrical solenoid ~till I-~~ergized),
I) is energized in the oposite direction (with electrical solenoid
the fluid flow will change to the opposite diection.
ec
~bobcat
HYDRAULIC I HYDROSTATIC FLOW CHART For Model
753 (SIN 19227 & Above) Chart #6722406 (Printed November 1993)
NOTE Chart shows fluid flow in Forward Drive Position and with Hydraulic Cylinders Partially Extended. For Hydraulic / Hydrostatic System Operation, refer to Sheet 2 of this publication .
¥o
NOTE Chart shows fluid flow in the Lifting Position and with the Bucket Postioning Valve in operation.
~
8
/
0
~
a
_oc
t
DRAIN
0
PILOT
I
ffi
I
I
'----­
I
T
[ I' I
b RAIN
~
PILOT
I ~I -------
I'-....edO.--r
I' (F I)
e~ --=:::J• 111 IT - ­
PILOTe : : : : :.
(F
~
ENERGIZED
ED..... / e
e · l'
6722406 111-93)
(Sheet 1 of 2)
il:
~
~fIt1 'fI
'l fD
Printed in U.S.A .
c=J
RED - - - - - - BLUE - - - - - GREEN - - - - ORANGE - - - LT. ORANGE ·
High Pressure Low Pressure Case Drain & Reservoir Charge Pressure Bucket Positioning Fluid
~o ~e
. e
~e
CD

MC-1751
~bobcat
HYDRAULIC I HYDROSTATIC SYSTEM OPERATION To Be Used With
HYDRAULIC I HYDROSTATIC FLOW CHART For Model
753H Chart #6722833 (Printed November 1993)
CHARTLEGEND
o FLUiD RESERVOIR: Cap.: . . . . . . . . . . .
14 Qts. (13,2 L)
• BREATHER • FILL CAP • SCREEN,. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 Mesh • SELECT VALVE a.' Select Valve 'Hi Flow' detent or momentary mode. b. Select Valve -lIIale Secondary and Rear Auxiliary Couplers Pressurized. c. Select Valve- Female Secondary ;;:tnd Rear Auxiliary Couplers Pressurized. • REAR AUXILIARY QUICK COUPLERS (OPTIONAL) • FRONT AUXILIARY QUICK COUPLERS • CASE DRAIN FILTER . Sintered Bronze (90 Micron) . , HYDROSTATIC MOTOR • LIFT CYLINDERS • DUAL PRESSURE MAIN RELIEF VALVE: Low setting - 2300 PSI (159'00 kPa) @ Front Quick Couplers High setting 3300 PSI (22700 kPa) @ Front Quick .couplers HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE LOAD CHECK VALVES (2) . , PORT RELIEF VALVE, ... 3500 PSI (24100 kPa) . , ANTI-CAVITATION VALVE • ELECTRICAL AUXIUARY SOLENOIDS . , PORT RELIEF VALVE (Optional): 2500 PSI (17238 kPa) TILT CYLINDER CHECK VALVE
CD CD
CD CD
• UN-LOADING SPOOL
• PRESSURE RELIEF VALVE
• FLOW CONTROL SPOOL
fa BUCKET POSITION VALVE (OPTIONAL)
6722833 (11-93)
• FLOW ADJUSTMEN1· VALVE • CHARGE PRESSURE SENDER • HYDRAULIC/HYDROSTATIC FILTER: #3 Synthetic Media • TEMPERATURE SENSOR fa) DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE SWITCH: (Normally Closed) 36·44 PSI (250-300 kPa) 8) FILTER BY-PASS VALVE: 45-55 PSI (315-375 kPa) • OIL COOLER • HYDRAULIC PUMP, Gear Type 13.0 GPM (49,2 Llmin.) @ 2480 RPM @ 1150 PSI (7929 kPa) . , HYDROSTATIC PUMPS HIGH PRESSURE RELIEF/REPLENISHING VALVES ... 5600 PSt (34475 kPa) . , CHARGE IN-LET RELIEF (iJormal Flow), 155-165 PSI (1069-1138 kPa) @ 13.0 GPM (~9,2 L/min.) @ 2480 RPM W/120 0 F. (49 0 C.) Fluid . , CASE DRAIN QUICK COUPLER I) S~CONDARY FRONT AUXILIARY QUICK COUPLER • HI FLOW HYDRAULIC PUMP, Gear Type 8.7 GPM (32,9 I/Min.) @ 2480 RPM 1150 PSI (7930 kPa) . , HI FLOW MAIN RELIEF VALVE, 3250-3300 PSI (22400 - 23100 kPa) @ Secondary Front Quick Couplers 8> ORIFICE • SOLENOID VALVE (Two Coil) • CHECK VALVE • PILOT-to-OPEN CHECK VALVE • SOLENOID VALVE INTERNAL ORIFICE . , REPLENISHING VALVES
CD
CD
(Sheet 2 Of 2)
Printed in U.S.A.
~~~~~~~=FLUID
FLOW
EXPLANATION=~=~
The fluid flows by gravity from the reservoir. to the hydraulic pump' . The hydraulic pump' is a 'gear type' pump and is driven by a shaft through the hydrostatic pumps • . The fluid from the hydraulic pump' goes to the hydraulic control valve • . The hydraulic control valve. has an adjustable relief valve • . When all spools of the control valve. are in the neutral position, the fluid goes through the control valve. and to the oil cooler., . If one of the spools is activated, the fluid goes out the respective
CO ., .
port and to either the base end, or rod end of the cylinder(s) As the fluid goes into one end of the cylinder(s) the fluid from the other side of the cylinder flows back
CO .,
into the control valve • . ALSO SEE BUCKET POSITIONING SYSTEM OPERATION (OPTIONAL).
When the cylinder(s)
CO ., reaches the end of the stroke, the fluid attains the low pressure
setting of the dual pressure main relief valve. , it will open and let the fluid by-pass the hydraulic circuit (internally) and go back to the oil cooler., which becomes 'charge supply fluid' for the hydrostatic pumps • . When the spool goes back to neutral position, fluid is then available for the other sections of the control valve • . Two sections of the control valve. can be used at the same time if the dual pressure main relief valve. is not open.
CO
The fluid flows from the oil cooler., through the #3 synthetic media filter to the hydrostatic pumps. This fluid is called 'charge supply fluid'. In the hydrostatic pumps. the fluid is against the charge relief valve' and four replenishing valves • . The hydrostatic pumps. do not need the full volume of fluid flow so there is extra fluid. This extra fluid goes to the charge relief valve' . The replenishing valves. open and let fluid into the pumps. for replenishing, lubrication and cooling. With the replenishing valves. open this flow of fluid becomes 'drive loop fluid'. When the steering levers are in neutral, the pumps. and the motors. are not working, but do have charge pressure fluid. When the steering levers are moved, the swashplates in the pumps. are angled and the fluid is forced out of the pressure side of the pumps. and to the motors • . This flow of fluid is called 'drive pressure'. Drive pressure is much higher than charge pressure causing the replenishing valves. to close, allowing the flow of the fluid to go to the motors • . There are two hydrostatic pumps. and two hydrostatic motors • . One pump and one motor work together as a pair to drive on one side of the loader. The other pump and motor work as a pair to drive the opposite side of the loader. The hydrostatic motors. are a 'roller-geroler' type. The case drain fluid from the right motor. goes to the hydrostatic pump • . Case drain fluid from the left motor. joins
return fluid from the auxiliary section of the control valve The filter. has a by-pass valve
CD and goes to the reservoir 0 .
8> to allow fluid flow when the fluid will not go through
the filter element (plugged). BUCKET POSITIONING SYSTEM OPERATION {OPTIONAL}
The lift section and tilt section of the control valve
CD work together to position the bucket
as the lift arms, of the loader, are being raised. When the lift arms are being raised, the hydraulic pump. fluid flow is directed to the base end of the lift cylinders from the rod end of the lift cylinders
CD returns
CD . The fluid
to the bucket position valve. and is
directed to the center of the flow-control spool • . The flow-control spool. and adjustable
I) directs this flow. A percentage of the fluid is directed over the adjustable metering orifice I) to level the bucket. The rest of the fluid is directed through the orifice metering orifice
in the flow-control spool. and on to the return port of the control valve
CD (lift section).
The fluid flow from the flow-control spool. and adjustable metering orifice
I) are against
the un-loading spool • . The un-loading spool. moves to allow extension of the tilt cylinder
0)
as the lift cylinders
CD raise
the lift arms.
The pressure relief valve. is to relief fluid from the base end of the tilt cylinder bucket is fully rolled out and the lift cylinders
CD are
0)
if the
still extending.
HI FLOW OPERATION
The 'High Horsepower' 753 loaders have an additional 'High Flow' gear pump. driven by the engine crankshaft. The flow from this extra pump can be directed through the select valve. to join with the 'normal' auxiliary flow exiting the main hydraulic control valve
CD ,
~
to produce addtional flow for an auxiliary attachment. This flow can also be used for cylinder

control from the secondary front auxiliary couplers' and the rear auxiliary couplers • .

Flow from the high flow pump. is allowed to return to the suction side of the 'normal
4
flow' gear pump system when not in use. Whenever this flow is put to use, a solenoid
4
valve
4
pump. is protected at all times by a relief valve • . When the high flow mode is selected,
4
4 E ~
E E 6
I)
is energized to block the flow from its path to the suction side. The high flow
flow will pass through the check valve. , which prevents any reverse flow when operating in the 'normal' flow mode.
When the high flow pump pressure exceeds 1200 PSI for any reason, the dual pressure relief valve. in the main control valve. will be piloted to its high pressure setting. Flow from the high flow pump. can also be directed to the secondary front auxiliary couplers' or the optional rear auxiliary couplers' . These functions are connected in parallel, so if the loader is equipped with both, only the function that is in use can be attached to the associated quick couplers (Example - When the rear stabilizer (rear auxiliary) function is used, the side shift (secondary front auxiliary) function should be disabled). Flow of these functions is bi-directional and is controlled by a solenoid valve either of these coils is energized, the solenoid valve
I) that
I) with two coils. Whenever blocks the oil from its path
to the suction side is also energized. Flow to the secondary front auxiliary couplers' or the optional rear auxiliary couplers' passes through a pilot-to-open check valve (lock valve) • . These check valves prevent drift of any attachment. Just ahead of the pilot-to-open check valve is an orifice' that drains any leakage (from the two coil solenoid valve
I) } to the suction side
(tank port) to prevent constant creep of the secondary front auxiliary attachment (Example - side shift).
~bobcat
HYDRAULIC I HYDROSTATIC FLOW CHART For Model
753H (SIN 511011001 & Above) Chart #6722833 (Printed November 1993)
NOTE
Chart shows fluid flow in the Lifting
Position and with the Bucket Postioning
Valve in operation.
NOTE Chart shows fluid flow in Forward Drive
Position and with Hydraulic Cylinders
Partially Extended. For Hydraulic /
Hydrostatic System Operation, refer to
Sheet 2 of this publication.
5b. Rear and Second Front Auxiliary
(Male Couplers Pressurized)
o~
e
I
e~ 'A'
I
t
e
'B':~
fD
l G,
5c. Rear and Second Front Auxiliary (Female Couplers Pressurized)
0:. 'A
#
t
U -
Left Rear Male 'B' !,!5!
O~
Bf'
Right Rear Female 'A'
CD 6 72 2833 19-93)
(Sheet 1 of 2)
Printed in U.S.A.
-
c:::::J
RED - - - - - - BLUE - - - - - GREEN - - - - ORANGE - - - LT. ORANGE -
High Pressure Low Pressure Case Drain & Reservoir Charge Pressure Bucket Positioning Fluid
O-'.I.j~
~
I
~
Gi)-. cr' ( ' H
0
/Cb
I
.~ . .It~ rl 6m ~~ Second Front Female 'A'
(,
~G
.c~· Second Front Male 'B'
- m .11
'
MC -1 805
2 HYDRAULIC SYSTEM
A WARNING
TROUBLESHOOTING The following troubleshooting chart is provided for assistance in locating and correcting problems which are most common. Many of the recommended procedures must be done by authorized Bobcat Service Personnel only.
Check for correct function after adjustments, repairs or service. Failure to make correct repairs or adjustments can cause injury or death. W-2004-1285
CAUSE
PROBLEM The hydraulic system will not operate.
1,2,3,5,8
Light comes 'ON' when hydraulics are activated.
1,3
Slow hydraulic system action.
1,3,4,5,6,8
Hydraulic action is not smooth.
1,4,5,6,7
Lift arms go up slowly at full engine RPM.
1,3,4,5,6,7,8,9
The lift arms or Bob-Tach will move the pedal in neutral position.
4
The lift arms come down with the pedal in the neutral position.
4,9,10,11
KEY TO CORRECT THE CAUSE
1. The fluid level is not correct. 2. The pedal linkage is disconnected. 3. The hydraulic pump has damage. 4. The pedal linkage is not adjusted correctly. 5. Relief valve is not at the correct pressure. 6. Suction leak on the inlet side of the hydraulic pump. 7. Fluid is cold. Wrong viscosity fluid (See Section 8). 8. Using the loader for more than its rated capacity. 9. Internal leak in the lift cylinder{s). 10. External leak from the lift cylinder(s). 11. Damaged lift spool.
-2-1-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
HYDRAULIC SYSTEM INFORMATION
A
Mark a Line on Nut
Flats of Both Nuts
IMPORTANT
When repairing hydrostatic and hydraulic systems, clean the work area before disassembly and keep all parts clean. Always use caps and plugs on hoses, tubelines and ports to keep dirt out. Dirt can quickly damage the system.
Tighten to Correct Amount from Chart
1-2003-0888 A-{)1897
Flare Connections
B
Tube Size Rotate No. Wrench Size Outside Dia. Thread Size of Hex Flats 5/8' 5/16' 1/2' - 20 2-1/2
Use the following procedures to tighten the flare fitting: Tighten the nut until it makes contact with the seat. Make a mark across the 'flats' of both the male and female parts of the connection [A].
Use the chart to find the correct tightness needed [8]. If the fitting leaks after tightening, disconnect it and inspect the seat area for damage.
11/16'
3/8'
9/16' - 18
2
7/8'
1/2'
3/4' -16
2
1'
5/8'
7/8' -14
1-1/2 - 2
1-1/4'
3/4'
1-1/16' -12
1
1-318'
1'
1-5/16' -12
3/4-1
2'
1-1/4'
1-5/8' -12
314-1
2-1/4'
1-1/2'
1-7/8' -12
1/2 - 314
O-ring Face Seal Connection
C
When the fitting is tightened, you can 'feel' when the fitting is tightto eliminate leakage caused by under or over torqued fittings. Use vaseline petroleum jelly to hold the O-ring in position until the fittings are assembled [C].
o Straight Thread O-Ring Fitting
o
Lubricate the O-ring before installing the fitting. Loosen the jam nut and install the fitting. Tighten the jam nut until the washer is tight against the surface [0].
Tubelines and Hoses Replace any tubelines that are bent or flattened. They will restrict flow, which will slow hydraulic action and cause heat. Replace hoses which show signs of wear, damage or weather cracked rubber. Always use two wrenches when loosening and tightening hose or tubeline fittings.
A-{)1852
-2-2­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
LIFT CYLINOER(S)
Checking the Lift Cylinder(s)
Lower the lift arms. Stop the engine. Move the lift pedal
to release the hydraulic pressure. Raise the seat bar.
A WARNING
Diesel fuel or hydraulic fluid under pressure can penetrate skin or eyes, causing serious injury or death. Fluid leaks under pressure may not be visible. Use a piece of cardboard or wood to find leaks. Do not use your bare hand. Wear safety goggles. If fluid enters skin or eyes, get immediate medical attention from a phYSician familiar with this injury.
B
W-2072-0496
Check only one cylinder at a time. Disconnectthe tubeline which goes to the rod end of the lift cylinder [A].
Lift the tube line up for clearance. Disconnect the hose from the base end of the cylinder [8].
Install a plug in the hose and tighten [C]. Connect the tubeline to the port at the rod end of the cylinder. Engage the parking brake. Lower the seat bar. Start the engine and push the top (toe) of the lift pedal. It there is any leakage from the open port, remove the lift cylinder for repair. Repeat the procedure to check the other lift cylinder.
Removal and Installation Stop the engine. Move the lift pedal to release the hydraulic pressure. Raise the seat bar. Raise the operator cab (Page 1-5). CD-08702
Disconnect the tubeline at the rod end of the cylinder [A]. Disconnect the hose at the base end of the cylinder [8].
Remove the retainer bolt and nut [0]. Installation: Tighten the retainer bolt and nut to 18-20 ft.-1bs. (24-27 Nm) torque.
-2-3­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
LIFT CYLINOER(S) (Cont'd) Remove the rod end pin [A).
Remove the retainer bolt and nut from the base end pivot pin [B). Installation: Tighten the retainer bolt and nut to 18-20 ft.-Ibs. (24-27 Nm) torque.
Remove the base end pin [C).
Slide the lift cylinder forward and remove it from the loader [0].
A WARNING
Always clean up spilled fuel or oil. Keep heat, flames, sparks or lighted tobacco away from fuel and oil. Failure to use care around combustibles can cause explosion or fire which can result in injury or death.
W-21 03-1285
SEE THE COMPONENT REPAIR MANUAL FOR HYDRAULIC CYLINDERS FOR DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY PROCEDURE.
-2-4­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
TILT CYLINDER Checking the Tilt Cylinder Remove the attachment. Roll the Bob-Tach fully back. Stop the engine. Move the tilt pedal to release the hydraulic pressure. Raise the seat bar.
A WARNING
Hydraulic fluid escaping under pressure can have sufficient force to enter a person's body by penetrating the skin. This can cause serious injury and possibly death if proper medical treatment by a physician familiar with this injury is not received immediately. W-2145-0290
Disconnect the hose which goes to the base end of the tilt cylinder [A]. Put a plug in the hose and tighten. Engage the parking brake. Lower the seat bar. Start the engine and push the bottom (heel) of the tilt pedal. If there is leakage from the open port, remove the tilt cylinder for repair.
Removal and Installation Remove the attachment. Roll the Bob-Tach fully forward
[8]. Stop the engine. Move the tilt pedal to release the hydraulic pressure. Raise the seat bar. Disconnect both hydraulic hoses [A].
Remove the retainer bolt from the rod end pivot pin [C]. Installation: Tighten the retainer bolt to 18-20 ft.--Ibs. (24-27 Nm) torque.
Remove the grease fitting from the rod end pivot pin. Remove the rod end pivot pin [D].
CD-Q871 0
-2-5­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
TILT CYLINDER (Cont'd)
Remove the retainer bolt and nut from the base end pivot
pin [A]. Installation: lighten the retainer bolt and nut to 18-20 ft.-Ibs. (24-27 Nm) torque.
A WARNING
Always clean up spilled fuel or oil. Keep heat, flames, sparks or lighted tobacco away from fuel and 011. Failure to use care around combustibles can cause explosion or fire which can result in injury or death. W-2103-1285
Remove the base end pivot pin [B]. Remove the tilt cylinder from the loader.
SEE THE COMPONENT REPAIR MANUAL FOR HYDRAULIC CYLINDERS FOR DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY PROCEDURE.
Rod End Seal Remove the old seal (both sides) from the rod end of the tilt cylinder. Install the new seals with the lip facing in [C].
Use two pieces of shim stock, install the rod end of the tilt cylinder into the Bob-Tach so there is no damage to the seals [0].
-2-6­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE Checking the Main Relief Valve The tools listed will be needed to do the following procedure: MEL-1238 - Hydraulic Tester MEL-10006 - Hydraulic Test Kit Turn the key switch to the 'OFP' position, as the engine stops running, turn the key switch all the way to the left to release the hydraulic pressure at the front auxiliary quick couplers. Lift and block the loader (Page 1-2). Connect the hydraulic tester to the auxiliary quick couplers [A].
B
IMPORTANT
The hydraulic tester must be in the fully open position before you start the engine. 1-2024-0284
A WARNING
8-13443
Put jackstands under the front axles and rear corners of the frame before running the engine for service. Failure to use jackstands can allow the machine to fall or move and cause injury or death.
W-2017-o286
Start the engine and run at low idle RPM. Push the mode switch (Item 1) twice (on the instrument panel) to engage the front auxiliary hydraulics 'detenf', the light (Item 3) will come 'ON' [8].
Left
Steering
Lever
Push the button (Item 1) for fluid pressure to the quick couplers [C].
Right
Steering
Lever
MC-01115
Watch the flow meter on the hydraulic tester to make sure the flow is correct. Increase the engine speed to full RPM.
A WARNING
There should be 13 GPM (49 Umin.) free flow. Turn the restrictor control, on the tester, until the main relief valve opens. The correct pressure for the main relief is 2550-2600 PSI (17582-17927 kPa).
When the engine is running during service, the steering levers must be in neutral and the parkinSii ~rake engaged. Failure to do so can cause Injury or death.
Push the button (Item 1) to disengage the 'detent' position to the front quick couplers [C].
W-2006-0284
If the relief pressure is not correct, stop the engine. Replace or adjust the main relief valve (Page 2-8).
Revised Dec. 92
-2-7­
750 Series Loader Service Manuat
HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (Cont'd) Main Relief Valve Removal and Installation Raise the operator cab (Page 1-5).
IMPORTANT
When repairing hydrostatic and hydraulic systems, clean the work area before disassembly and keep all parts clean. Always use caps and plugs on hoses, tubelines and ports to keep dirt out. Dirt can quickly damage the system. 1-2003-0888
Clean the area around the control valve. Loosen the main relief valve [A].
Installation: Tighten the main relief valve to 35-40 ft.-Ibs. (47-54 Nm) torque. Remove the main relief valve [8].
Remove the o-rings and back-up washers [C].
C
Clean the main relief valve in clean solvent. Use air pressure to dry the valve. Install new o-rings and back-up washers. Install the main relief valve and tighten [A]. Check the pressure again (Page 2-7). If the pressure is not correct, adjust the main relief valve. Remove the end cap (Item 1) [C]. Turn the adjusting screw in or out until the pressure is correct.
NOTE: If the correct pressure can not be reached, replace the main relief valve. Check the pressure setting of the new relief valve.
8-06764
-2-8-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (753H) (Cont'd) Checking the Dual Pressure Main Relief Valve (Low Setting) The tools listed will be needed to do the following procedure: MEL-1238 - Hydraulic Tester MEL-10006 - Hydraulic Test Kit Turn the key switch to the 'OFP' position. Before the engine stops running, turn the key switch all the way to the leffto release the hydraulic pressure at the front auxiliary qUick couplers. Lift and block the loader (Page 1-2). Connect the hydraulic tester to the auxiliary quick couplers [A].
NOTE: Flow will be out from the female coupler on the loader.
IMPORTANT The hydraulic tester must be in the fully open position before you start the engine. 1-2024-0284
A WARNING Put jackstands under the front axles and rear corners of the frame before running the engine for service. Failure to use jackstands can allow the machine to fall or move and cause injury or death.
W-2017-o286
When the engine is running during service, the steering levers must be in neutral and the parkin~ ~rake engaged. Failure to do so can cause injury or death.
W-2006-0284
Start the engine and run at low idle RPM. Push the mode switch (Item 1) twice (on the instrument panel) to engage the front auxiliary hydraulics 'detenr, both lights (Item 2 & 3) will come 'ON [8].
NOTE: Hlgl1 horse~ower switch should be in the 'OFF' position. Push the button (Item 1) for fluid pressure to the quick couplers [C]. Watch the flow meter on the hydraulic tester to make sure the flow is correct. Increase the engine speed to full RPM. There should be approximately 13 GPM (49 Umin.) free flow. Turn the restnctor control, on the tester, until the main relief valve opens. The correct pressure for the main relief is 2550-2600 PSI (17582-17927 kPa). Push the button (Item 1) to disengage the 'detent'
position to the front quick couplers [CJ.
If the relief pressure is not correct~stop the engine. Adjust or replace the main relief valve (t'age 2-8).
Added Jan. 94
-2-8A­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (753H) (Cont'd) Checking the Dual Pressure Main Relief Valve (High
Setting)
The tools listed will be needed to do the following procedure: MEL-1238 - Hydraulic Tester MEL-10006 - Hydraulic Test Kit Turn the key switch to the 'OFP position. Before the engine stops running, turn the key switch all the way to the left to release the hydraulic pressure at the front auxiliary quick couplers. Lift and block the loader (Page 1-2). Raise the operator cab (Page 1-5). Connect the remote start switch (Page 1-24). Connect the hydraulic tester to the auxiliary quick couplers [AJ.
IMPORTANT The hydraulic tester must be in the fully open position before you start the engine. 1-2024-0284
c
A WARNING
Connect Hose From Fitting To Relief Valve~i:=;a!!~
Put jackstands under the front axles and rear corners c,' the frame before running the engine for service. Failure to use jackstands can allow the machine to fall or move and cause injury or death.
~
W-2017-Q286
When the engine is running during service, the steering levers must be in neutral and the parkinfil brake engaged. Failure to do so can cause Injury or death.
I
Dual Pressure Relief Valve
W-2006-0284
MC-01947
Remove the plug from the center of the auxiliary section on the main control valve (Item 1) [8] & [C]. Install a straight fitting (15K-6) (Item 2) into the open port of the auxiliary section [8]. Temporarily cap the open port. Disconnect the pilot hose (Item 1) from the dual pressure relief valve [0]. Plug the pilot hose and cap the relief valve temporarily. Obtain a 3/8' (9,5 mm) 1.0. hose with a 3300 PSI (22754 kPa) or above rating locally. The hose should be a minimum length of 29' (737 mm) with .5625-18UNF-28 37° flare female swivel hose ends.
Added Jan. 94
-2-88­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (753H) (Cont'd) Connect one end of the hose (Item 1) [A] on the dual pressure relief valve. Connect the other end of the hose (Item 2) [A] on the straight fitting which was installed in the main control valve. See figure [C] Page 2-8B also.
Start the engine and run at low idle RPM. Push the mode switch (Item 1) twice (on the instrument panel) to engage the front auxiliary hydraulics 'detenr, the lights (Item 2 & 3) will come 'ON' [8].
NOTE: The High Horsepower switch should be in the 'OFF' position. Push the button (Item 1) for fluid pressure to the quick couplers [C]. Watch the flow meter on the hydraulic tester to be sure the flow is correct. Increase the engine speed to full RPM. There should be approximately 13 GPM (49 Umjn.) free flow. Turn the restrictorcontrol on the tester, until the main relief valve opens. The correct pressure for the main relief is 3300 PSI (2254 kPa). Push the button (Item 1) to disengage the 'detenr position to the front quick couplers [C]. If the relief pressure is not correct, stop the engine. Replace or adjust the main relief valve (Page 2-80 or 2-8E).
Added Jan. 94
-2-8C­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (753H) (Cont'd)
A
Adjusting the Dual Pressure Main Relief Valve (Low
SeHing)
,~
NOTE: Adjust the low pressure setting before adjusting the high pressure setting. Correct pressure for the low setting is 2550-2600 PSI (17582-17927 kPa). See Page 2-8A for the correct procedure to check the setting.
I I
, 0/ ,/
/
fJ
To adjust the low pressure setting on the main relief valve, (Item 1) disconnect the pilot hose (Item 2) from the adapter fitting (Item 3) [A]. Remove the adapter fitting (Item 3) [A].
6-14091
B
Remove the high pressure adjustment housing (Item 1) from the main relief valve [6].
MC-01654
C
Use a 1/4' allen wrench (Item 1) to turn the adjusting screw (Item 2) in to increase or out to decrease pressure
[C]. One turn is equal to approximately 490 PSI (3379 kPa). Reinstall the high pressure adjustment housing and adapter. Reconnect the pilot hose. Start the engine and increase the engine speed to full RPM. Check the correct pressure setting. Repeat the procedure until the pressure setting is approximately 2550-2600 PSI (17582-17927 kPa). When the correct pressure setting is reached, the next step is to set the high pressure adjustment on the main relief valve. (See Page 2-8E for correct procedure). Stop the engine.
Added Jan. 94
MC-01654
-2-80­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (753H) (Cont'd)
A
Adjusting the Dual Pressure Main Relief Valve (High Setting) NOTE: A~just the low pressure setting before adjusting the high pressure setting. Correct pressure for the high setting is 3250-3300 PSI (22409-22754 kPa). See Page 2-88 for the correct procedure to check the setting. To adjust the high pressure setting on the main relief valve, (Item 1) disconnect the pilot hose (Item 2) from the adapter fitting (Item 3) [A].
/'
Remove the adapter fitting (Item 3) [A].
/' /'
/' /'
~-O-6-14091
B
Use a 1/4' allen wrench (Item 1) to press the push pin (Item 2) in until it bottoms out against the shoulder stop (Item 3) [B]. Turn the adjusting guide (Item 4) in to increase pressure
or out to decrease pressure [B].
One tum is equal to approximately 390 PSI (2689 kPa).
Reinstall the adapter fitting.
See Pages 2-88 and 2-8C for the proper procedure to
check the high pressure setting.
Reconfirm the correct adjustment.
MC-01654
Addttd Jan. 94
-2-8E-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
SELECT VALVE (753H) Checking the Main Relief Valve in High Horsepower
Select Valve
The tools listed will be needed to do the following procedure: MEL-1238 - Hydraulic Tester MEL-1Ooo6 - Hydraulic Test Kit Lift and block the loader (Page 1-2). Connect the hydraulic tester to the secondary auxiliary quick couplers (right side) (Item 1) [A].
IMPORTANT The hydraulic tester must be in the fully open p~sition before you start the engine. 1-2024-0284
A WARNING Put jackstands under the front axles and rear corners of the frame before running the engine for service. Failure to use jackstands can allow the machine to fall or move and cause injury or death.
W-2017-o286
When the engine is running during service, the steering levers must be in neutral and the parkins;l brake engaged. Failure to do so can cause Injury or death.
W-2006-0284
Start the engine and run at low idle RPM. Push the mode switch (Item 1) once (on the instrument panel) to engage the front auxiliary hydraulics momentary, the light (Item 2) will come 'ON' [8]. Push the rocker switch (Item 1) for fluid pressure to the secondary quick couplers [C]. Watch the flow meter on the hydraulic tester to make sure the flow is correct. Increase the engine speed to full RPM.
D
The free flow should be approximately 8.7 GPM (32,9 Umin.). Turn the restrictor control, on the tester, untit the main relief valve opens. The correct pressure for the main relief is approximately 3250-3300 PSI (22409-22754 kPa). Release the rocker switch (Item 1) to disengage the flow to the secondary quick couplers [C]. If the relief pressure is not correct, stop the engine. Adjust or replace the main relief valve in the select valve (Item 1) [0] located in the right rear. Remove the cap from the relief valve (Item 2) and turn the adjusting screw in or out until the correct pressure is reached [0].
Added Jan. 94
MC-01977
-2-8F­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (Cont'd) Removal and Installation
IMPORTANT
When repairing hydrostatic and hydraulic systems, clean the work area before disassembly and keep all parts clean. Always use caps and plugs on hoses, tubelines and ports to keep dirt out. Dirt can quickly damage the system. 1-2003-0888
Stop the engine. Move the hydraulic controls to release
the hydraulic pressure. Raise the seat bar.
Lift and block the loader (Page 1-2).
Raise the operator cab (Page 1-5).
Clean the area around the control valve.
Assembly: Note the location of the hoses and tubelines
before removal.
Disconnect the wiring harness from the two solenoids on
the control valve [A].
Disconnect the hose (Item 1) which goes to the hydraulic
reservoir [B].
When this hose is disconnected it will drain the fluid from the reservoir. Install a plug in the hose or drain the fluid into a container.
Disconnect the tilt and lift foot pedal linkages from the valve spools [C].
Disconnect all the hoses and tubelines from the control
valve.
Remove the two mounting bolts.
Installation: Tighten the mounting bolts to 15-16 ft.-Ibs.
(21-23 Nm) torque.
Remove the control valve.
A WARNING
Always clean up spilled fuel or oil. Keep heat, flames, sparks or lighted tobacco away from fuel and oil. Failure to use care around combustibles can cause explosion or fire which can result in injury or death. W-2103-1285
SEE THE COMPONENT REPAIR MANUAL FOR THE
HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY PROCEDURE.
Revised s.pt. 93
-2-9­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
HYDRAULIC PUMP
Checking the Output of the Pump The tools listed will be needed to do the following procedure: MEL- - Remote Start Switch MEL-1238 - Hydraulic Tester MEL-l0006 - Hydraulic Test Kit
NOTE: Remove all air from the hydraulic system before beginning the test. Air in the system can give an inaccurate test. *Relief pressure must be per specification before the test is done. NOTE: Early model pumfs were rotate 180° with pressure (outlet side to the rear. Connections to the tester are the same from either pump mounting. Sample tester connection shown [C]. Lift and block the loader (Page 1-2). Raise the operator cab (Page 1-5). Connectthe remote start switch (Page 1-24). Disconnect the OUTLET tubeline from the pump [A]. Connect the INLET hose (Item 1) from the tester to the OUTLET of the pump. Connect the OUTLET hose (Item 2) from the tester to the tubeline which was disconnected from the pump [8].
A WARNING
Put jackstands under the front axles and rear corners of the frame before running the engine for service. Failure to use jackstands can allow the machine to fall or move and cause injury or death.
W-2017-Q286
Start the engine and run at low idle RPM. Make sure the tester is connected correctly. If no flow is indicated on the tester, the hoses are connected wrong. With the hoses connected correctly, increase the engine speed to full RPM*.
c
EXAMPLE: TESTER Reservoir
CONNECTION
Warm the fluid to 140°F. (60°C.) by turning the restrictor control (Item 1) [C] on the tester to about 1000 PSI (6895 kPa). DO NOr exceed system relief pressure. 9pen the restrictor control and record the free flow (GPM) at full RPM. Push the mode switch (on the remote start switch) to engage the front auxiliary hydraulics, the light will come 'ON'. Push the button (on the right steering rever) forfluid flow to the quick coupler (fluid pressure will go over main relief). Record the highest pressure (PSI) and flow (GPM). The high pressure flow must be at least 80% of free flow. 0/0= HIGH PRESSURE FLOW (GPM) X 100 FREE FLOW (GPM) A low percentage may indicate a failed pump.
*Refer to specifications (Section 8) for system relief pressure ana full RPM.
Revised Sept. 93
BH-Q0196
-2-10-
750 Series Loader
Service Manual
HYDRAULIC PUMP (753 H) (Cont'd)
A
Checking the Output of the High Flow Pump
Reservoir
EXAMPLE: TESTE CONNECTION
The tools listed will be needed to do the following
procedure:
MEL-1238 - H~ldraulic Tester
MEL-1 0006 - Rydraulic Test Kit
NOTE: Remove all the air from the hydraulic system
befor, begil1ning the test. Air in the system can give an Inaccurate test. *Relief pressure must be per specification
before the test is done.
H~Flow
Sample tester connections shown [A].
Lift and block the loader (Page 1-2).
Hydraulic Select Valve
Raise the operator cab (Page 1-5).
Connect the remote start switch (Page 1-24).
Disconnect the OUTLET tubeline from the pump.
Connect the INLET hose (Item 1) from the tester to the
OUTLET of the pump. Connect tl'le OUTLET hose (Item 2) from the tester to the tubeline which was disconnected from the pump [8].
BH-00196
A WARNING Put jackstands under the front axles and rear corners of the frame before running the engine for service. Failure to use jackstands can allow the machine to fall or move and cause injury or death. W-2017-D286
IMPORTANT The hydraulic tester must be in the fully open position before you start the engine. 1-2024-0284
Start the engine and run at low idle RPM. Make sure the tester is connected correctly. If no flow is indicated on the tester, the hoses are connected wrong. With the hoses connected correctly, increase the engine speed to full RPM*. Warm the fluid to 140°F (60°C) by turning the restrictor control (Item 1) [A] on the tester to about rooo PSI (6895 kPa). DO NOT exceed system relief pressure. 9'pen the restrictor control and record the free flow (GPM) at full RPM. Turn the restrictor control knob (Item 1) rAl slowlY to relief and record the high pressure flow (BPM)' DO NOT exceed 3250-330U PSI (22409-22754 KPa) when turning the restrictor knob. Excessive pressure Will cause permanent damqg~ to the hydraulic pump. The high pressure flow (GPM) must be at least 80% of free flow (GPM). % HIGH PRESSURE FLOW (GPM) X 100 FREE FLOW (GPM) A low percentage may indicate a failed pump. *Refer to specifications (Section 8) for system relief pressure at full RPM.
Added Jan. 94
-2-10A­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
HYDRAULIC PUMP (Cont'd) Removal and Installation
IMPORTANT
When repairing hydrostatic and hydraulic systems, clean the work area before disassembly and keep all parts clean. Always use caps and plugs on hoses, tubelines and ports to keep dirt out. Dirt can quickly damage the system. 1-2003-0888
Raise the operator cab (Page 1-15).
Disconnect the suxtion hose [A].
NOTE: Drain the hydraulic fluid into a container.
Disconnect the outlet tubeline [8].
Revised Sept. 93
-2-11­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
HYDRAULIC PUMP (Cont'd) Remove the two mounting bolts [Al
Remove the hydraulic pump from the hydrostatic pump [B].
Disconnect the small hose from the outlet fitting (if equipped with optional rear auxiliaries) [C]. Remove the hydraulic pump from the loader. Remove the coupler (Item 1) from the hydraulic pump shaft [0]. Remove the large o-ring (Item 2) [Dl Installation: Always use a new O-ring when installing the hydraulic pump.
A WARNING
Always clean up spilled fuel or oil. Keep heat, flames, sparks or lighted tobacco away from fuel and oil. Failure to use care around combustibles can cause explosion or fire which can result in injury or death.
W-2103-1285
SEE THE COMPONENT REPAIR MANUAL FOR THE HYDRAULIC PUMP DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY PROCEDURE.
Revised Sept. 93
-2-12­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
HYDRAULIC FIL'rER HOUSING Removal and Installation
IMPORTANT
When repairing hydrostatic and hydraulic systems, clean the work area before disassembly and keep all parts clean, Always use caps and plugs on hoses, tubelines and ports to keep dirt out, Dirt can quickly damage the system. 1-2003-0888
Disconnect the wires from the sender [A1.
Disconnect the wiring harness connector [8].
Remove the tubeline [C1.
o
Remove the two mounting bolts [01. Installation: Tighten the mounting bolts to 25 ft.-Ibs. (34 Nm) torque.
Revised Sept. 93
-2-13­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
HYDRAULIC FILTER HOUSING (Cont'd) Disconnect the hose [A].
Disconnect the wire (Item 1) from the sender [8].
A WARNING
Always clean up spilled fuel or oil. Keep heat, flames, sparks or lighted tobacco away from fuel and oil. Failure to use care around combustibles can cause explosion or fire which can result in injury or death. W-21 03-1285
Revised Sept. 93
-2-14-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
HYDRAULIC FLUID RESERVOIR Removal and Installation Raise the operator cab (Page 1-5). Disconnect the hose which goes from the control valve to the hydraulic reservoir [A].
When this hose is disconnected it will drain the fluid from
the reservoir. Drain the fluid into a container.
Loosen the hose clamps on the inlet hose to the hydraulic pump [8]. Remove the hose.
Remove the bolt and plate from the mounting strap [C]. Installation: Tighten the bolt to 16-20 ft.-Ibs. (22-27 Nm) torque.
Remove the hydraulic reservoir from the loader [0].
Revised Sept. 93
-2-15­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
CONTROL PEDALS
Removal and Installation
Remove the bolt and nut from the pedal linkage [A].
Installation: Tighten the bolt and nut to 21-25 ft.-Ibs.
(28-34 Nm) torque.
Check the rubber bushing in the pedal for wear and
replace as needed.
Remove the two mounting bolts [8].
Remove the pedal assembly from the loader.
Adjustment After installing the pedal, adjust the pedal so that there is clearance under the rear of the pedal [C). The valve spool must travel full stroke without the pedal hitting the floor panel.
A WARNING
AVOID INJURY OR DEATH Adjust locking tabs on pedal control linkage so that lift and tilt control pedals are locked in neutral when the seat bar is up. W-2104-1285
Revised Sept. 93
-2-16-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
PEDAL INTERLOCK LINKAGE Removal and Installation Remove the lock nuts (Item 1) from the interlock shield [A]. Installation: Tighten the lock nuts to 25-28 ft.-Ibs. (34-38 Nm) torque.
NOTE: Be sure the decal (Item 2) is in good condition and in the location shown [A]. Remove the interlock shield from the interlock.
Loosen the lock nut (Item 1) from the interlock bolts [B]. Remove the spring from under the interlock block. Installation: Tighten the interlock nut to 84-96 in.-Ibs. (9,5-10,8 Nm) torque. Remove the interlock. Remove the plastic washers between the interlock and the fender. Remove the bolts.
Installation: During installation be sure to keep the interlock pressed against the loader frame so the plastic washers on each side of the interlock (top and bottom) do not fall out. It may be necessary to hold the plastic washers with an O-ring pick or small screwdriver. Adjustment Check the pedal interlock linkage so it is free and locks both pedals. Check that the tab on the linkage goes into the slot on the interlocks and holds the pedal in neutral position [C]. If not, loosen the bolts and adjust the tab for correct engagement [C]. Tighten the bolts to 25 ft.-Ibs. (34 Nm) torque.
A WARNING
AVOID INJURY OR DEATH Adjust locking tabs on pedal control linkage so that lift and tilt control pedals are locked in neutral when the seat bar is up. W-21 04-1285
Revised Sept. 93
-2-17-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
DIVERTER VALVE (OPT.) Removal and Installation
Open the rear door.
Disconnect the wiring harness connector (Item 1) [A].
Disconnect the hoses (Item 2 thru 5) [A].
Disconnect the hose (Item 1) [8].
Disconnect the tubelines (Item 2) [8].
Remove the bulkhead fittings (Item 3) [8].
Pull the diverter valve away for clearance and disconnect
the top tubelines (Item 4) [8].
Remove the diverter valve from the loader.
A WARNING
Always clean up spilled fuel or oil. Keep heat, flames, sparks or lighted tobacco away from fuel and oil. Failure to use care around combustibles can cause explosion or fire which can result in injury or death. W-2103-1285
Revised Sept. 93
-2-18-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
HANO CONTROLS
Adjustment Raise the operator cab (Page 1-5a). Adjust the tilt and lift control handles for following functions: a. Make sure there is 16.0-16.5' (406-419 mm) between the two control handles (as measured from the center of the handle) and that they are setting at approximately 15 degree angle (Item A) [A] or [8].
b. Make sure the control valve spools reach their full stroke both directions.
c. Make sure the left control handle goes into 'detent' position for float position. d. Be sure the tilt and lift controls return to neutral when released (except for 'detenf' position).
Adjust the cable mounting nuts [C] or the control cable mounting brackets to adjust the handles [0].
See Page 2-17 to adjust the pedal lock linkage.
Revised Sept. 93
-2-19­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
HAND CONTROLS (Cont'd) Removal and Installation Raise the operator cab (Page 1-5a). Disconnect the ball joint (Item 1) from the control handle (both sides) [A].
Loosen the control cable mounting nuts (both sides) [A].
Installation: If the ball jOint end is removed, turn the ball joint onto the cable end no less than 5-6 turns [Bl
Remove the front paneVsteering lever assembly (Page 3-3) [C]. Installation: Make sure the grommets on the linkage bars are installed correctly and that the tilt and lift linkage bars will not bind due to interference between the panel and linkage bars.
NOTE: SIN 13487 & Below; For disassembly of the control handle and switches, See Page 3-7. SIN 13488 & Above; The control handlelswitches cannot be disassembled and must be replaced as an assembly.
Remove the bolt and nut (Item 1) from the mounting bracket (both sides) [0]. Remove the carriage bolts (Item 2), nuts and foot rest (both sides) [0].
Revised Sept. 93
-2-20-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
HAND CONTROLS (Cont'd)
Disconnect the lift linkage bar from the crossbar [A].
Installation: Put the lift linkage bar UNDER the crossbar.
Remove the lift control cablellinkage assembly from the loader [B].
Disconnect the tilt linkage (Item 1) from the control valve
[C].
TILT LINKAGE
Remove the tilt control cable/linkage assembly from the loader [0].
Revised Sept. 93
-2-21­
.
750 Series Loader Service Manual
HAND CONTROLS (Cont'd)
A
Remove the acorn nuts (Item 1) from the u-bolt [A].
TILT LINKAGE
CD-10887
TILT LINKAGE
Remove the nuts and u-bolt (Item 1) [B]. Installation: Make sure to install the u-bolt over the notch on the tilt control cable.
Remove the acorn nuts (Item 1) [C].
Remove the nuts and u-bolts (Item 1) [0].
D
LIFT LINKAGE
Installation: Make sure to install the u-bolt over the notch on the lift control cable.
Revised Sept. 93
-2-22-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
HAND CONTROLS (Cont'd)
A
Disconnect the control cable clevis from the bellcrank [A].
TILT LINKAGE
Installation: Install the clevis in the second hole from the top on the bellcrank for the tilt linkage.
B
Disconnect the control cable clevis from the bellcrank [8]. Installation: Install the clevis in the top hole on the bellcrank for the lift linkage.
NOTE: If the clevis is removed from the control cable, tum the clevis onto the end of the cable no less than 5-6 tums.
Loosen the bolt and nut on the tilt linkage bar [C]. Installation: DO NOT overtighten the nut because this will distort the swivel bearing and could cause interlerence in operation of the controls.
Disconnect the tilt linkage from the middle hole on the bellcrank [0].
Revised Sept. 93
-2-23­
750 Series Loader Service Manua'
HANO CONTROLS (Cont'd)
LIFT LINKAGE
Loosen the bolt and nut on the lift linkage bar [A]. Installation: DO NOT over-tighten the nut because this will distort the swivel bearing and could cause interference in operation of the controls.
Disconnect the lift linkage from the bottom hole on the bellcrank [B].
Remove the nut from the bellcrank pivot bolt [C].
Remove the bellcranklpivot bolt from the mounting bracket [0]. Remove the O-ring from the pivot bolt [0].
Revised Sept. 93
-2-24­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
HAND CONTROLS (Cont'd) Remove the pivot bolt, washer and O-ring from the bellcrank [A].
Remove the bolts and nuts from the swivel bearing [8].
Remove the swivel bearing from the linkage bar.
Check all parts for wear or damage. Replace the parts
only with genuine Melroe parts.
Revised Sept. 93
-2-25­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
HAND CONTROLS (Cont'd)
LIFT LINKAGE
Loosen the bolt and nut on the lift linkage bar [A]. Installation: DO NOT over-tighten the nut because this will distort the swivel bearing and could cause interference in operation of the controls.
Disconnect the lift linkage from the bottom hole on the bellcrank [8].
Remove the nut from the bellcrank pivot bolt [C].
Remove the bellcranklpivot bolt from the mounting bracket [0]. Remove the O-ring from the pivot bolt [0].
Revised Sept. 93
-2-26­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
HAND CONTROLS (Cont'd) Remove the pivot bolt, washer and O-ring form the bellcrank [A].
Remove the bolts and nuts from the swivel bearing [8].
Remove the swivel bearing from the linkage bar.
Check all parts for wear or being damaged. Replace the
parts only with genuine Melroe parts.
Revised Sept. 93
-2-27-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
HYDROSTATIC SYSTEM Page Number DRIVE BELT TENSIONER PULLEY
Assembly .......................... 3-29
Checking Pulley End Play ................... 3-33
Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-27
HYDRAULIC SYSTEM
FRONT PANEL
Removal and Installation .................. . . . 3-5
HYDROSTATIC MOTOR
Removal and Installation .................... 3-21
HYDROSTATIC PUMP
Removal and Installation .................... 3-23
HYDROSTATIC SYSTEM INFORMATION
Replenishing Valve Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4
OIL COOLER
Removal and Installation .................... 3-26
STEERING LEVERS
Disassembly and Assembly .................. 3-7
STEERING LEVER CONTROL HANDLE
Disassembly and Assembly .................. 3-9
STEERING LINKAGE SIN's 508611001-90879
511011001 & Above
511350001 & Above
511475001-75023
511525001 & Above
512711001-11125,11131 & 11139
Centering Plate ........................ Pintle Arm Repair ....................... Pintle Arm & Lobe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal and Installation .................... Steering Linkage Adjustment ..................
3-13 3-15 3-14 3-12 3-10
STEERING LINKAGE SIN's 512711126-11130,11132-11138 & 11140 & Above 508690870 & Above 511475024 & Above Removal and Installation .................... 3-19
Steering Linkage Adjustment .................. 3-16
Steering Neutral Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-18
TROUBLESHOOTING
Chart ............................ 3-3
TIGHTEN ALL HARDWARE PER SIZE TO GRADE 5 TORQUE (SEE STANDARD TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS FOR BOLTS, SECTION 8) UNLESS OTHERWISE SPECIFIED.
Revised October 95
-3-1­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
-3-2-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
HYDROSTATIC SYSTEM
A WARNING
TROUBLESHOOTING The following troubleshooting chart is provided for assistance in locating and correcting problems which are most common. Many of the recommended procedures must be done by authorized Bobcat Service Personnel only.
Check for correct function after adjustments, repairs or service. Failure to make correct repairs or adjustments can cause injury or death.
W-2004-1285
CAUSE
PROBLEM No drive on one side, in one direction.
1,2
No drive on one side in both directions.
2,3,4,5
The loader does not move in a straight line.
2,3,5,6,7
The hydrostatic system is overheating.
8,9, 10, 11
Service code HP 2 appears (Warnings, low charge pressure).
8, 11,12,13,14
KEY TO CORRECT THE CAUSE 1. The hydrostatic pump replenishing valves not seating. 2. The steering linkage needs adjustment. 3. The hydrostatic pumps have damage. 4. The final drive chain is broken. 5. The hydrostatic motor has damage. 6. The tires do not have the correct tire pressure. 7. The tires are not the same size. 8. The hydrostatic fluid is not at the correct level. 9. The oil cooler has a restriction. 10. The temperature sending switch is not operating correctly. 11. The loader is not being operated at the correct RPM. 12. The sender is defective. 13. Pump is defective or worn hydrostatics. 14. Hydraulic filter is plugged.
Revised Oct. 95
-34-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
HYDROSTATIC SYSTEM INFORMATION
IMPORTANT
When repairing hydrostatic and hydraulic systems, clean the work area before disassembly and keep all parts clean. Always use caps and plugs on hoses, tubelines and ports to keep dirt out. Dirt can quickly damage the system. 1-2003-0888
A
CHARGE OIL
~l~'
~~ '-------II ....
FUNCTION 1
Valve Moves for Charge Oil Replacement
Replenishing Valve Function The functions of the replenishing valves are: 1. To give replacement fluid to the low pressure side of the hydrostatic circuit. Replacement fluid is needed because of normal internal leakage and the controlled flow to the oil cooler for cooling. Function
1 [A]. 2. To keep high pressure fluid out of the low pressure side of the hydrostatic circuitry; Function 2 [A].
Valve Stays on Seat to Hold High Pressure for Drive
FUNCTION 2 8-02804
Revised Oct. 95
750 Series Loader Service Manual
FRONT PANEL Removal and Installation
A WARNING
Put jackstands under the front axles and rear corners of the frame before running the engine for service. Failure to use jackstands can allow the machine to fall or move and cause injury or death.
W-2017-o286
Raise the lift arms. (See Page 1-1.)
Raise the operator cab. (See Page 1-1.)
Remove the mounting bolts (Item 1) [AJ from the throttle.
Disconnect the linkage from the throttle lever and remove
the lever.
Remove the bolts from the rubber boot retainer plate for the parking brake boot [B].
Remove the bolt from the steering shock (both sides) [C].
Disconnect the steering shock from the steering linkage (both sides) [0]. Remove the steering shock (both sides).
Revised Oct. 95
750 Series Loader Service Manual
FRONT PANEL (Cont'd) Remove the bolt and nut from the steering linkage (both sides) [A].
Installation: Install a NEW lock nut and tighten the bolt and nut to 23 ft.-Ibs. (31 Nm) torque.
Disconnect the wiring harness from the steering lever (both sides) [8].
Remove aU the bolts from the front panel [C].
Remove the front panel/steering lever assembly from the loader [0].
Revised Oct. 95
750 Series Loader Service Manual
STEERING LEVERS
Disassembly and Assembly Remove the front panel/steering lever assembly from the loader. (See Page 3-5.) Remove the four nuts from the steering lever clamp (both sides) [Al Remove the top half of the clamp.
Remove the steering shaft pivot bolt (both sides) [8].
Remove the steering shaft assembly [el
Disassemble the right and left steering shaft from the cross shaft assembly. Install the new nylon bushings, as needed when assembling the steering shaft [0).
Revised Oct. 95
-3-7­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
STEERING LEVERS (Cont'd) Disassembly and Assembly (Cont'd) Remove the steering lever from the front panel [A].
Remove the bolts from the steering lever rubber boot for the stop [8].
Remove the steering lever stop [C].
Revised Oct. 95
750 Series Loader Service Manual
STEERING LEVER CONTROL HANDLE
EARLY MODELS
A
Disassembly and Assembly Remove all the screws and nuts from the control handle [A].
EARLY MODELS
Remove one side of the control handle [B].
c
Disconnect the wires and remove the other half of the handle with the switch plate.
SIN 11078 & Below
Assembly: When connecting the electrical wires to the right switch, See Figure [C] or [0] for correct installation.
.
~r~!
NOTE: SIN 13488 & Above; ·rhe control handle/switches cannot be disassembled and must be replaced as an assembly. ORANGE
@fi~1I'/J G~
ORANGE/BLUE YELLOW
57D
8-10648
o //'..,. /
I
I
II'
I
YELLow~//:;n ,) I 57 /. /) R
ORANGE
/ 12
ORANGEIBLUE
; :
G
YELLOW/WHITE
57 R 8-10648
Revised Oct. 95
-3-9­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
STEERING LINKAGE SIN's: 508611001-90879 511011001 & Above 511350001 & Above 511475001-75023 511525001 & Above 512711001-11125,11131 & 11139 Steering Linkage Adjustment
A WARNING
Put jackstands under the front axles and rear corners of the frame before running the engine for service. Failure to use jackstands can allow the machine to fall or move and cause injury or death.
W-2017-G286
Raise the lift arms. (See Page 1-1.)
Lift and block the loader. (See Page 1-1.)
Raise the operator cab. (See Page 1-1.)
Connect the remote start switch (MEL-1398). (See Page
1-1.)
Remove the fan drive belt.
Loosen the nuts and bolts on the steering linkage [A].
Move both steering levers backward. lighten the nuts
and bolts on the linkage [A].
Move one steering lever backward [8].
Put a 3/8' (10 mm) spacer between the cam (Item 1) [C]
and the bar (Item 2) [C].
Move the steering lever forward and install a 1' (25 mm)
spacer (Item 3) [C] between the centering spring plate and the mounting bracket on the hydrostatic pump. Loosen the linkage bolts [A].
Move the steering lever forward (adjust one lever at a
time) against the stop [8].
Move the hydrostatic pump pintle arm forward to full stroke. lighten the nuts and bolts to 23 ft.-Ibs. (31 Nm) torque [A]. Repeat the procedure for the other steering lever.
Check the lever movement to make sure that the pintle
arm and the steering lever are both at full stroke at the
same time. This will allow for maximum forward speed.
Remove the spacer [C].
Install the fan drive belt.
Revised Oct. 95
-3-10-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
STEERING LINKAGE (Cont'd) SIN's: 508611001-90879 511011001 & Above 511350001 & Above 511475001-75023 511525001 & Above 512711001-11125,11131 & 11139 Steering Linkage Adjustment (Cont'd)
Remove the fan drive belt. Loosen the nuts and bolts at the steering linkage to release any tension on the torsion bushings [AJ. lighten the nuts and bolts to 23 ft.~bs. (31 Nm) torque. Start the engine and check for neutral (no tires turning). Stop the engine. If the linkage need adjusting, do the following: Loosen the pintle bar bolts (both sides) [8] & [C]. Start the engine and run at high idle speed. Move the left steering lever until the tires do not turn (neutral). Push the pintle bar against the pintle arm lobes. lighten the front bolt first and then the rear pintle bar bolt to 28 ft.~bs. (38 Nm) torque [8).
Move the right steering lever until the tires do not turn (neutral). Push the pintle bar against both lobes of the pintle lever. lighten the bolts to 28 ft.~bs. (38 Nm) torque [C]. Move both steering levers backward and forward and let the transmission return to neutral. If the transmission does not return to neutral, repeat the above procedure again. Stop the engine. Re-install the fan drive belt.
Revjsed Oct. 95
-3-11­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
STEERING LINKAGE (Cont'd) ~'s: 508611001-90879 511011001 & Above 511350001 & Above 511475001-75023 511525001 & Above 512711001-11125,11131 & 11139 Removal and Installation NOTE: The steering linkage centering plate and pintle arms can be removed with the hydrostatic pump installed or removed from the loader. Disconnect the steering linkage if the procedure is done in the loader [A].
Remove the lock nut from the centering spring bolt [B].
Installation: Tighten the centering spring bolts and a NEW lock nut to 25-28 ft.-Ibs. (34-38 Nm) torque.
Remove the centering spring bolt, spring and bushing.
Slide the centering plate/pintle bar assembly from the dowels and remove from the hydrostatic pumps [0].
Revised Oct. 95
-3-12-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
STEERING LINKAGE (Cont'd)
SIN's: 508611001-90879 511011001 & Above 511350001 & Above 511475001-75023 511525001 & Above 512711001-11125,11131 & 11139 Centering Plate Remove the two screws from the plastic guide [A].
Remove the plastic guide [8]. Replace the guides as needed.
Loosen the two pintle bar bolts [C].
Remove the bolts and washers. Remove the pintle bar and washers (on top of the bar) from the centering plate
[0]. Replace the parts as needed. NOTE: Tighten the pintle bar bolts to the correct torque when the steering linkage adjustment is done.
Revised Oct. 9S
-3-13­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
STEERING LINKAGE (Cont'd) SIN's: 508611001-90879 511011001 & Above 511350001 & Above 511475001-75023 511525001 & Above 512711001-11125,11131 & 11139 Loosen the bolt on the pintle arm [A].
Installation: Tighten the bolt to 40-50 ft.-Ibs. (54-68 Nm) torque.
Remove the bolt from the pintle arm [B].
Remove the pintle arm from the hydrostatic pump shaft
[C].
NOTE: Make sure the steering linkage is parallel with the pintle arm so there is no binding of the rubber bushing [D].
Revised Oct. 95
-3-14-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
STEERING LINKAGE (Cont'd) SIN's: 508611001-90879 511011001 & Above 511350001 & Above 511475001-75023 511525001 & Above 512711001-11125,11131 & 11139 Pintle Arm Repair Remove the nut from the pintle arm and steering linkage [A].
Remove the steering linkage from the pintle arm [8]. Replace the rubber bushing as needed.
NOTE: Tighten the steering linkage bolt and lock nut to the correct torque when the steering linkage adjustment is done.
Loosen the bolt at the pintle arm lobe [Cl
Assembly: Tighten the bolt to 25-28 ft.-Ibs. (34-38 Nm) torque.
Remove the bolt and lobe [0]. Replace the parts as needed. After all parts are assembled, the steering lever travel and the neutral adjustment procedures must be done. (See Page 3-10 & 3-11.)
Revjsed Oct. 95
-3-15­
750 Series Loader Service Manua'
STEERING LINKAGE (Cont'd)
SIN's: 512711126 -11130,11132 -11138 & 11140 &
Above
508600870 & Above
511475024 & Above
Steering Linkage Adjustment
A WARNING
Put jackstands under the front axles and rear corners of the frame before running the engine for service. Failure to use jackstands can allow the machine to fall or move and cause injury or death.
W-2017-G286
Raise the lift arms. (See Page 1-1.) Lift and block the loader. (See Page 1-1.) Raise the operator cab. (See Page 1-1.) Connect the remote start switch (MEL-1398). (See Page 1-1.) Remove the fan drive belt. Pre-load tension in the torsion bushings must be removed before adjusting the steering linkage. Loosen the nut (Item 1) [A] 3 to 4 turns, then loosen the bolt (Item 2) [A]. The bolt (Item 2) [A] is threaded into the linkage bar (Item 3) [A]. The bolt (Item 2) [A] must be loosened enough to allow the torsion bushing to tu m freely between the steering belicrank and the linkage bar. Tighten .the bolt and the nut. Tighten the boltto 11-13 ft.-Ibs. (15-17 Nm) torque, then tighten the nut to 21-25 ft.-Ibs. (28-33 Nm) torque. Loosen the nut (Item 1) [B] 3 to 4 turns, then loosen the bolt (Item 2) [B]. The bolt (Item 2) [B] is threaded into the linkage bar (Item 3) [B]. The bolt (Item 2) [B] must be loosened enough to allow the torsion bushing to tum freely between the pintle arm and the linkage bar. Tighten the bolt and the nut. Tighten the boltto 11-13 ft.-Ibs. (15-17 Nm) torque, then tighten the nut to 21-25 ft.-Ibs. (28-33 Nm) torque. Move the right hand steering lever to the rear and install a 3/8 inch (10 mm) thick spacer (Item 1) [C] between the pintle arm cam (Item 2) [C] and the centering block (Item
3) [C]. Move the right hand steering lever forward and install a 15/16 inch (24 mm) thick spacer (Item 1) [0] between the centering plate (Item 2) [0] and the mounting plate (Item 3) [0]. This will allow the pintle arms to move freely while adjusting the steering linkage for full forward travel speed. Remove the 3/8' (10 mm) thick spacer (Item 1) [C].
Revised Oct. 95
-3-16­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
STEERING LINKAGE (Cont'd) SIN's: 512711126 -11130,11132 -11138 & 11140 & Above 508690870 & Above 511475024 & Above Steering Linkage Adjustment (Cont'd) Before adjusting the linkage, check that the pintle arm mounting bolt (Item 1) [A] is tight, 25-28 ft.-Ibs. (34-38 Nm) torque and that there is no play between the pintle arm (Item 2) [A] and the square pump shaft (Item 3) [A]. Also check that the cam mounting bolts (Item 4) [A] are tight, 45-50 ft.-Ibs. (62-68 Nm) torque.
Loosen the two (2) bolts and nuts on each steering linkage bar [8].
Move the left hand steering lever to the full forward position (until the lever hits the stop), then pull forward on the left hand rear linkage bar until the pintle arm is rotated to the front as far as possible [C]. Use aclamping plier and clamp the two (2) linkage bars together [C]. Tighten the nuts and bolts to 25-28 ft.-Ibs. (34-38 Nm) torque. Check the lever movement to make sure that the pintle arm and the steering lever are both at full stroke at the same time. This will allow for maximum forward speed. Repeat the procedure for the right hand side linkage. After both sides of the linkage have been adjusted, the feel of both levers at full stroke should be the same. Readjust the linkage if necessary. Remove the spacer (Item 1) [0].
Revised Oct. 95
-3-17­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
STEERING LINKAGE (Cont'd)
SIN's: 512711126 -11130, 11132 -11138 & 11140 &
Above 508690870 & Above 511475024 & Above Steering Neutral Adjustment Remove the fan drive belt. Loosen the nut (Item 1) [A] a couple of turns, then loosen the bolt (Item 2) [A]. The bolt (Item 2) [A] is threaded into the linkage bars (Item 3 & 4) [A]. The bolt (Item 2) [A] must be loose enough to allow the torsion bushing to tum freely between the pintle arm and the linkage bar. Loosen the four (4) bolts (Item 1) [B] holding the two (2) centering blocks. Move the right hand centering block to the right as far as possible.
NOTE: Bolt holes (Item 2) [B] are slotted for pintle arm centering adjustment. Adjust the left hand centering block first. Start the engine and run at high RPM. Move the left hand steering lever until the tires do not turn (neutral position). Move the left hand centering block to the left until it contacts both pintle cams and the steering lever is still in the neutral position [C]. Tighten the bolts to 25-28 ft.-Ibs. (34-38 Nm) torque.
NOTE: If the centering blocks are worn, they can be removed and rotated 180 degrees and reinstalled. If the cams are worn, they can be loosened and rotated 90 degrees and reinstalled. Adjust the right hand centering block. Move the right hand steering lever until the tires do not tum (neutral position). Move the right hand centering block to the left until it contacts both pintle cams and the steering lever is still in the neutral position [0]. Tighten the bolts to 25-28 ft.-Ibs. (34-38 Nm) torque. Test both levers by moving them backward and forward and letting them return to neutral by the return spring force. If the levers do not return to neutral and the tires do not come to a complete stop, repeat the adjustment procedure again. Stop the engine. Tighten the two (2) bolts (Item 2) [A] to 11-13 ft.-Ibs. (15-17 Nm) torque, then tighten the two (2) nuts (Item 1) [A] to 21-25 ft.-Ibs. (28-33 Nm) torque.
Install the fan drive belt. Revised Oct. 95
-3-18-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
STEERING LINKAGE (Cont'd) SIN's: 512711126 -11130,11132 -11138 & 11140 & Above 508690870 & Above 511475024 & Above Removal and Installation Remove the nut (Item 1) [A] from the end of the centering spring shoulder bolt (Item 2) [A]. Remove the shoulder bolt/spring assembly.
Installation: Tighten the centering spring shoulder bolt and a NEW lock nut to 25-28 ft.-Ibs. (34-38 Nm) torque.
Slide the plate (Item 1) [B] to the right and remove it from the two guide pins (Item 2) [B]. NOTE: The two (2) guide bushings (Item 3) [B] will be loose and can fall out of the plate (Item 1) [B] as soon as it is removed from the guide pins (Item 2) [B].
The centering plate/centering spring assembly consists of the following parts; shoulder bolt (Item 1). shoulder bushings (Item 2). spring (Item 3), lock nut (Item 4), centering plate (Item 5) and guide bushings (Item 6) [C).
If the surface of any of the four (4) pintle cams (Item 1) [0] is worn, loosen the bolt (Item 2) [0] and rotate the cams 1/4 turn. Tighten the bolts to 45-50 ft.-Ibs. (62-68 Nm) torque.
Revised Oct. 95
-3-19­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
STEERING LINKAGE (Cont'd)
SIN's: 512711126 -11130,11132 -11138 & 11140 &
Above 508600870 & Above 511475024 & Above Removal and Installation (Cont'd) Remove the nut (Item 1) [A] from the torsion bushing/linkage bar. The bolt is threaded into the linkage bar. Remove the bolt from undemeath the pintle arm.
Installation: Tighten the bolt to 11-13 ft.-Ibs. (21-25 Nm) torque. then tighten the nut to 21-25 ft.-Ibs. (28-33 Nm) torque.
Remove the linkage bar (Item 1) [8] and remove the torsion bushing (Item 2) [8].
Remove the nuts (Item 1) [C] from both shock absorber ball joint ends. Remove the shock absorbers.
Installation: Tighten the nuts to 25-28 ft.-Ibs. (34-38 Nm) torque. Remove the nuts (Item 2) [C] from the linkage bar mounting bolt. The bolts (Item 3) [C] are threaded into the linkage bars. Remove the bolts (Item 3) [C]. The torsion bushings can now be removed from the steering bell cranks.
Installation: Tighten the bolts to 11-13 ft.-Ibs. (21-25 Nm) torque, then tighten the nuts to 21-25 ft.-Ibs. (28-33 Nm) torque. The linkage and the centering plate must be readjusted for neutral after the components have been reassembled. See Page 3-16 for the neutral adjustment procedure.
Revised Oct. 95
-3-20-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
HYDROSTATIC MOTOR Removal and Installation
IMPORTANT
When repairing hydrostatic and hydraulic systems, clean the work area before disassembly and keep all parts clean. Always use caps and plugs on hoses, tubelines and ports to keep dirt out. Dirt can quickly damage the system. 1-2003-0888
Raise the lift arms. (See Page 1-1).
Lift and block the loader. (See Page 1-1).
Raise the operator cab. (See Page 1-1).
Remove a wheel/tire assembly.
Remove the bolts from the motor cover [A].
Remove the motor cover [8].
Mark the hoses for correct installation. Disconnect the high pressure hose [C].
Disconnect the other high pressure hose [0].
Revjsed Oct. 95
-3-21­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
HYDROSTATIC MOTOR (Cont'd)
A
Removal and Installation (Cont'd)
Remove the mounting bolts from the hydrostatic motor
[A].
Installation: lighten the bolts to 90-100 ft.-Ibs. (122-136 Nm) torque [B].
Remove the hydrostatic motor from the motor carrier [C].

Installation: Always use new large 0-ring (Item 1) [0] and face seals (Item 2) [0] before installing the motor.
A WARNING
Always clean up spilled fuel or oil. Keep heat, flames, sparks or lighted tobacco away from fuel and oil. Failure to use care around combustibles can cause explosion or fire which can result in injury or death. W-21 03-1285
SEE THE HYDROSTATIC MOTORS COMPONENT REPAIR MANUAL FOR DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY PROCEDURE. Revised Oct. 95
-3-22­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
HYDROSTATIC PUMP Removal and Installation NOTE: The engine and hydrostatic pump must be removed from the loader as an assembly. (See Page 7-1). Remove the belt shield. Loosen the bolt at the drive bolt tensioner pulley [A].
Remove the drive belt [8].
Installation: For correct tension of the drive belt. (See Page 1-1 for the correct procedure).
Remove the tension pulley assembly [C].
Remove the pulley from the bracket and check the parts for wear [0]. Replace the parts as needed. SIN 16852 & Above: See Page 3-25 for disassembly and assembly of the Drive Belt Tensioner Pulley.
Revised Oct. 95
-3-23­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
HYDROSTATIC PUMP (Cont'd) Removal and Installation (Cont'd)
IMPORTANT
When repairing hydrostatic and hydraulic systems, clean the work area before disassembly and keep all parts clean. Always use caps and plugs on hoses, tubelines and ports to keep dirt out. Dirt can quickly damage the system. 1-2003-0888
Hold the hydrostatic pump pulley and loosen the nut [A].
Remove the nut and washer.
Installation: Tighten the nut to 175-200 ft.-Ibs.
(237-271 Nm) torque.
Install a puller and remove the pulley from the pump shaft
[B]. Remove the puller.
Installation: Make sure the key (Item 1) [e] is installed in the shaft.
Remove the hydraulic pump mounting bolts [0]. Remove the hydraulic pump.
Revised Oct. 95
-3-24­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
HYDROSTATIC PUMP (Cont'd) Removal and Installation (Cont'd) Remove the bolts and nuts from the hydrostatic mounting flange [A] & [B]. Installation: lighten the mounting bolts and nuts to 65-70 ft.-Ibs. (88-95 Nm) torque.
Remove the bolt and washer(s) [C].
Installation: Add or remove washers to align the pump drive belt [0]. lighten the bolt to 65-70 ft.~bs. (88-95 Nm) torque.
A WARNING
Always clean up spilled fuel or oil. Keep heat, flames, sparks or lighted tobacco away from fuel and oil. Failure to use care around combustibles can cause explosion or fire which can result in injury or death. W-21 03-1285
SEE THE HYDROSTATIC MOTORS COMPONENT
REPAIR
MANUAL
FOR
ASSEMBLY PROCEDURE.
Revised Oct. 95
DISASSEMBLY
AND
-3-25­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
OIL COOLER Removal and Installation
IMPORTANT
When repairing hydrostatic and hydraulic systems, clean the work area before disassembly and keep all parts clean. Always use caps and plugs on hoses, tubelines and ports to keep dirt out. Dirt can quickly damage the system. 1-2003-0888
Open the rear door.
Raise the rear grill.
Disconnect the hose at the right side of the oil cooler [A].
Disconnect the hose from the left side of the oil cooler [8].
Lift and remove the oil cooler from the loader [C].
Revised Oct. 95
-3-26-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
DRIVE BELT TENSIONER PULLEY
A
Disassembly
NOTE: Be careful, the pulley hub is full of oil.
Remove the cap [A].
Remove the bolt and washer [B].
Install a long bolt into the shaft [C].
Remove the idler pulley and bearing from the shaft using a press [D].
Added Oct. 95
-3-27­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
DRIVE BELT TENSIONER PULLEY (Cont'd) Disassembly (Cont'd)
Install a bearing puller behind the seal and wear sleeve
[A].
PHOTO CLARITY ONLY: If the bearing puller is installed behind the bearing, seal and wear sleeve, the wear sleeve will also be removed [B].
Remove the bearing, seal and wear sleeve using the press [C].
Added Oct. 95
-3-28-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
DRIVE BELT TENSIONER PULLEY (Cont'd)
A
Assembly NOTE: The bearings, cups and spacers are a matched set and must be replaced as a unit. If the spacer is replaced, compress the new spacer and install into the pulley [A].
CO-12641
Use a driver tool (1-5/16' diameter) and push the spacer into the matched groove [B].
Install the bearing cup using the driver tool (both sides)
[C]. NOTE: The seal side of the pulley hub has the larger 1.0. diameter.
Install the taper roller bearing to the pulley (seal side) [0].
Added Oct. 95
-3-29­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
DRIVE BELT TENSIONER PULLEY (Cont'd)
Assembly (Cont'd)
Put sealant (PIN 6633538) around the diameter of the
shaft where the wear sleeve is installed on the shaft [A].
Put grease (PIN 6599719) on the seal lips (Item 1) [B]. Make sure the grease is between the outside and inside lips and all the way around the seal.
MC-01648
Press the seal into the pulley hub larger diameter using a press [C].
NOTE: The wear sleeve and the seal must be replaced as a unit. DO NOT damage the seal lips with the sharp edge of the wear sleeve. Install the wear sleeve into the seal.
Use a spacer tube which goes over the shaft and pushes on the inside diameter of the taper bearing, install the pulley. seal and wear sleeve onto the shaft [0].
Added Oct. 9S
-3-30­
750 Series Loader ServicE; Manual
DRIVE BELT TENSIONER PULLEY (Cont'd)
A
Assembly (Cont'd)
Install the small bearing spacer [A].
Install the taper roller bearing pushing on the I.D. 01 the bearing [B].
Put LOCTITE (PIN 6540410) on the bolt threads [C].
o
Install the bolt and washer into the shaft [D].
CD-12651
Added Oct. 95
-3-31­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
DRIVE BELT TENSIONER PULLEY (Cont'd)
Assembly (Cont'd)
Tighten the bolt to 25-28 ft.-Ibs. (43-38 Nm) torque [A].
B
Use only 15W/50 synthetic oil (Example: Mobil One) for the bearings. Use the cap and add oil until it is at the 0.50' (12,7 mm) mark on the scale, which should be 0.75 oz. (20 C.C.) of oil [B].
Measure Oil Level in the Center of the Cap
0.50' (12,7)
_t_
T
MC--01648
Add the oil slowly, at one location of the bearing which will allow the trapped air to escape from the other side [C].
NOTE: Oil capacity is very critical, do not add any more and/or any less oil to the idler pulley.
MC--01648
Check the cap sealing edge to make sure it is not damaged. Replace the cap as needed. Make sure the sealing edge on the hub bore and cap sealing edge is clean and free of oil, put a bead of sealant (PIN 6633538) on the cap [D]. Install the cap.
Added Oct. 95
-3-32­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
DRIVE BELT TENSIONER PULLEY (Cont'd) Checking Pulley End Play Install the pulley/mounting bracket assembly in to vise
[A].
Install a dial indicator on the pulley hub [B].
Move the pulley by hand, back and forth. The correct end play is 0.005-0.013' (0,13-0,33 mm) [C]. If the end play is not correct, there is not adjustment. Replace the hub, pulley and/or bearings.
Added Oct. 9S
-3-33­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
-3-34-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
DRIVE SYSTEM Page Number
AXLE SEAL
Removal and Installation .................... 4-16
AXLE, SPROCKET AND BEARINGS
Checking Axle End Play . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-19
Removal and Installation .................... 4-19
CENTER TRANSMISSION COVER
Installation .......................... 4-10
CHAINCASE FLUID
Replacing the Chaincase Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-24
DRIVE CHAIN
Removal and Installation .................... 4-23
DRIVE
SYSTEM
FRONT CHAINCASE COVER
Removal and Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11
MOTOR CARRIER
Disassembly and Assembly (Early Models) ............ Disassembly and Assembly (Later Models) ....... , .... Removal and Installation (Later Models) ............. Shaft Seal Replacement ....................
4-15 4-15 4-14 4-12
PARKING BRAKE
Adjustment .......................... Brake Block and Pads ..................... Brake Discs ......................... Removal and Installation ....................
4-3 4-7 4-9 4-4
REAR CHAINCASE COVER
Removal and Installation .................... 4-11
TIGHTEN ALL HARDWARE PER SIZE TO GRADE 5 TORQUE (SEE STANDARD TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS FOR BOLTS, SECTION 8) UNLESS OTHERWISE SPECIFIED.
-4-1­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
-4-2-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
PARKING BRAKE
Adjustment When the parking brake is in good condition and adjusted correctly, it will keep the loader from moving when the steering levers are moved. Raise the operator cab. (See Page 1-1). Turn the nut (Item 1) [A] to adjust the parking brake. OLD STYLE: There must be 3/4' (19 mm) movement from the top of the cover (not the bolt head) to bottom edge (heel) of the brake pedal. NEW STYLE: Adjust the release pedal so there is 2' ± 0.1' (51 mm ± 2 mm) from the top of the release pedal to the top of the chaincase cover [B].
B
NOTE: If the correct adjustment can not be obtained by turning the nut, the brake lever must be adjusted using the following procedure.
Lift Release Pedal to Remove Linkage End Play
8-13810
Disconnect the spring from the brake lever [C].
Loosen the nut (Item 1) [0].
Revised Oct. 95
-4-3­
750 Series Loader Service Manua'
PARKING BRAKE (Cont'd) Adjustment (Cont'd) Loosen the bolt on the brake lever [A]. Do not remove the bolt.
Pry up on the lever and hit the bolt with the hammer until brake lever is loose [B]. Remove the bolt and brake lever.
Turn the brake block shaft counterclockwise until the
brake pads make contact with the brake discs.
Install the brake lever. Install the bolt and tighten to 65-70
ft.-Ibs. (88-95 Nm) torque.
Adjust the parking brake again.
Removal and Installation
Raise the lift arms. (See Page 1-1).
Raise the operator cab. (See Page 1-1).
Remove the bolt and nut from the lift pedal linkage [C].
Disconnect the lift linkage from the control valve spool
[0].
Revised Oct. 95
750 Series Loader Serv;i;e Manual
PARKING BRAKE (Cont'd) Removal and Installation (Cont'd)
Remove the pivot bolt from the lift linkage crossmember [A].
Remove the linkage crossmember [B]. Remove the plastic washer (Item 1) [B] and check for wear and replace as needed.
Remove the nuts from the brake linkage rod [C].
Disconnect the brake lever spring. NOTE: If the brake block and pads are going to be disassembled, loosen the brake lever bolt. Pry up on the lever and hit the bolt until the brake lever is loose [0].
Revised Oct. 95
750 Series Loader Serv;ce Manual
PARKING BRAKE (Cont'd) Removal and Installation (Cont'd)
Remove the cotter pin from the brake pedal pivot shaft
[A].
Remove the brake pedaillinkage rod assembly [B].
Remove all the cover bolts [C].
Revised Oct. 95
-4-6-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
PARKING BRAKE (Cont'd) Removal and Installation (Cont'd) Remove the cover/brake block assembly [A] & [B].
NOTE: Early model bakes are cast iron machined [A]. Later model brakes are made of steel and have a spacer (Item 1) [B] between the brake pads.
Installation: Clean and dry the cover. Clean the surface on the chaincase where the cover sets. Use a new gasket under the cover. (See Parts Microfiche for serial number and part number.) Align the brake discs so they are . centered and in-between the brake pads [A].
Brake Block and Pads Remove the brake lever bolt [C].
Installation: Tighten the bolt to 65-70 ft.-Ibs. (88-95
Nm) torque.
Remove the brake lever [0].
Revised Oct. 95
-4-7­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
PARKING BRAKE (Cont'd) Brake Block and Pads (Cont'd)
Remove the bolts from the brake block [A]. Installation: Tighten the bolts to 65-70 ft.-Ibs. (88-95 Nm) torque.
Remove the guide and pads [B] & [C].
Check the pads for wear and replace them as needed.
Remove the bolts which fasten the brake block to the cover [0]. Installation: Tighten the bolts to 65-70 ft.-Ibs. (88-95 Nm) torque.
Revised Oct. 95
750 Series Loader Service Manual
PARKING BRAKE (Cont'd)
Brake Block and Pads (Cont'd)
Remove the brake block [A].
Installation: Clean and dry the brake block. Put a bead
of R.T.V. sealant on the brake block.
NOTE: 00 Not use excessive R.T.V. sealant on the block. Make sure the brake shaft does not rub.
Remove the shaft from the brake block [B]. Check the parts for wear or damage and replace as needed.
Installation: Always install a new O-ring when the shaft is installed. Make sure shaft rotates freely in the cover.
Brake Discs To remove the brake discs, the following items must be
removed from the chaincase first:
Remove the front cover. (See Page 4-11).
Remove the motor carrier. (See Page 4-12).
Remove the front axle and sprocket. (See Page 4-16).
Remove the snap ring [C].
Remove the brake discs from the front chaincase hole [0]. Check the brake discs for damage. Replace the brake discs as needed. DO NOT grind the brake discs.
Revised Oct. 95
-4-9­
750 Series Loader
Service Manual
CENTER TRANSMISSION COVER
A
Installation
SHOULDER BOLT LOCATION
When installing the center cover on the transmission, always use three shoulder bolts where shown. See your Bobcat loader dealer for the correct shoulder bolt. Tighten the bolts to 20-25 ft.-Ibs. (27-34 Nm) torque. NOTE: Be sure the warning decal is installed on the inside of the left fender. CENTER
it.
COYI!I lOCATIOIf
I
.dEl
WARNING
MC-Q1707
AVOID INJURY OR DEATH The cent. 1l..,mklMn (:(MI, c. mIMI if not properly NCUI'ed. 1 hi$ can .... lmprope' oP'f,alion of the loll<>
Revised Oct. 95
6705158
-4-10-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
FRONT CHAINCASE COVER
Removal and Installation Remove the front panel/steering lever assembly. (See
Page 3-1.)
Remove the parking brake pedal.
Remove all the bolts from the front cover [A].
Remove the cover from the chaincase [8].
Installation: Clean and dry the cover. Clean the surface on the chaincase where the cover sets. Install a new gasket under the cover. (See Parts Microfiche for correct serial number and part number.)
REAR CHAINCASE COVER
Removal and Installation
Remove the steering linkage. (See Page 3-1.)
Disconnect the steering linkage.
Remove all the bolts from the rear cover [C].
Remove the cover from the chaincase [0].
Installation: Clean and dry the cover. Clean the surface on the chaincase where the cover sets. Install a new gasket under the cover. (See Parts Microfiche for correct serial number and part number.)
Revised Oct. 95
-4-11­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
MOTOR CARRIER
A
Shaft Seal Replacement The tools listed will be needed to do the following procedure: MEL 1399 - Axle Seal Tool MEL1402 - Carrier Seal Tool Remove the hydrostatic motor. (See Page 3-1.) Pull the seal carrier from the motor carrier [A].
Remove the old O-ring and replace with a new O-ring [6].
Remove the old seals from the seal carrier.
Install the seal carrier on the axle seal tool (M EL1399) [C].
CD-08845
D
Install two seals on the tube shaft of the motor carrier seal tool (face the seal lips with one inward and one outward)
[0].
Revised Oct. 95
-4-12-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
MOTOR CARRIER (Cont'd)
Shaft Seal Replacement (Cont'd)
Install the two seals and shaft into the top half of the seal
carrier tool [A].
CD-09949
Install the seaVtool assembly into the motor carrier seal housing [8]. Hit the tool with a hammer to seal the seals in the housing.
C
Install the seal/seal carrier housing into the motor carrier [C].
Install the seal carrier installation tool into the seal carrier housing. Hit the tool with a hammer until the seal housing is fully seated [0].
Revjsed Oct. 95
-4-13­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
MOTOR CARRIER (Cont'd) Removal and Installation (Later Models)
Raise the lift arms. (See Page 1-1.)
Lift and block the loader. (See Page 1-1.)
Raise the operator cab. (See Page 1-1.)
Remove the front panel/steering lever assembly. (See
Page 3-1.) Remove the parking brake/cover assembly. (See Page
4-4.).
Remove the fluid from the chaincase. (See Page 4-24.)
Remove the front axle and sprocket. (See Page 4-16.)
Remove the hydrostatiC motor. (See Page 3-1.)
Remove from the motor carrier mounting bolts from inside
the chaincase [A].
Installation: lighten the bolts to 125-140 ft.-Ibs.
(170-190 Nm) torque.
Move the motor carrier housing toward the rear of the
chaincase. Remove the rear drive chain from the motor carrier sprockets [8].
Remove the front drive chain from the motor carrier
sprockets.
Remove the motor carrier assembly from the chaincase
[C].
Installation: Clean the motor carrier housing flange. Install the gasket on the mounting surface [0]. NOTE: When installing the motor carrier with through holes in the flange, either a gasket or sealant can be used. Put sealant between the bolt heads and the chaincase to prevent leakage.
Revised Oct. 95
-4-14-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
MOTOR CARRIER (Cont'd)
LATER MODELS
A
Disassembly and Assembly (Later Models) The tool listed will be needed to do the following procedure: MEL 1402 - Carrier Seal Tool Use [A] as a guide to disassemble and assemble the motor carrier. The correct shaft end play is 0.008' (0,2 mm) and is
controlled by the snap ring (Item 5) [A].
The snap ring (Item 5) [A] comes in two different widths.
(See Parts Microfiche for the correct procedure.)
1. 2. 3. 4. 5.
Shaft Bearing Race Snap Ring Spacer
6. 7. 8. 9. 10.
Housin~
Snap Ring O-nng Seal Adapter Seal
Lip Faces OUT
MC-01936
Disassembly and Assembly (Early Models)
The tool listed will be needed to do the following
procedure:
B
EARLY MODELS
MEL 1402 - Carrier Seal Tool
Use [B] to disassemble and assemble the motor carrier.
The correct shaft end play is 0.008' (0.2 mm) and is
controlled by the snap ring (Item 7) [B].
The snap ring (Item 7) [B] comes in two different widths.
(See Parts Microfiche for the correct part number.)
1. Shaft 2. Bearing
3. Race
4. Snap Ring 5. Spacer Revised Oct. 95
--4-15­
Lip Faces OUT
6. Housin~ 7. Snap Ring
8. O-rIng
9. Seal Adapter 10. Seal
C-03083
750 Series Loader
Service Manual
AXLE SEAL
A
Removal and Installation
The tools listed will be needed to do the following procedure: MEL 1242 - Port-a-Power MEL 1399 - Axle Seal Tool To loosen the axle hub bolt use the following procedure: With the tires on the ground, loosen the hub bolt. If the axle and bearings are being replaced, loosen the sprocket bolt while the tires are still on the ground. (See page 4-19.) Lift and block the loader. (See Page 1-1.) Remove the tire/wheel assembly. Installation: Tighten the bolt to 575-625 ft.-1bs. (780-848 Nm) torque.
Install wheel nuts on two studs straight across from each other. Use a hammer to remove the wheel studs [B].
Remove the wheel nut and studs from the hub [C]. Installation: After the hub has been removed, use a hammer to install the wheel stud in the hub.
Revised Oct. 95
-4-16-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
AXLE SEAL (Cont'd)
Removal and Installation
Install a puller on the wheel hub [A].
A slide-hammer or Port-a-Power can be used to remove the hub. A Port-a-Power is used in the following sequence: Install a spacer on the end of the axle and against the Port-a-Power ram [B].
A WARNING
NEVER STAND IN-LINE OF THE HUB WHEN REMOVING A HUB FROM AN AXLE. The hub has a tapered fit on the axle end and can come off the axle with great force and cause serious injury. W-2186-0395
Remove the hub from the axle [B]. Remove the key from the axle [C].
Drill a small hole into the axle seal [0].
CD-08861
Revjsed Oct. 95
-4-17­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
AXLE SEAL (Cont'd) Removal and Installation (Cont'd) Install a puller and remove the axle seal [A]. Clean the seal area and inspect the shaft for wear. If necessary, order an axle repair sleeve from Melroe Parts Sales.
Installation: Install the new seal on the axle and into the axle tube [8]. Installation: Install the seal drive tool over the axle [8].
Installation: Use a hammer, install the new axle seal until the tool is flush with the edge of the axle tube [C].
Revised Oct. 95
-4-18-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
AXLE, SPROCKET AND BEARINGS Removal and Installation The tools listed will be needed to do the following procedure: MEL1242 - Port-a-Power MEL 1202B - Axle Bearing Service Set
NOTE: The procedure shown for removal and installation of the axle, sprocket and bearings is for a front axle. This procedure is the same for the rear axle. Loosen the axle sprocket bolt while the tires are on the ground [A]. Raise the lift arms. (See Page 1-1.) Lift and block the loader. (See Page 1-1.) Raise the operator cab. (See Page 1-1.) Remove the front panel/steering lever assembly. (See Page 3-1.) Remove the front or rear cover depending which axle is being removed. (See Page 4-11.) Remove the fluid from the chaincase. (See Page 4-24.)
Installation: Tighten the axle sprocket bolt to 220-245 ft.-Ibs. (298-332 Nm) torque. Remove the axle hub. (See Page 4-16.) Install the Port-a-Power ram between the two sprockets with a spacer against the end of the axle [B]. Push the axle out until the ram is at the end of the stroke. Add a spacer and push the axle out again. Repeat this procedure until the axle is out of the sprocket [C]. Remove the inner bearing from the chaincase [0].
Installation: Pack the outer and inner bearing with grease before installing them. Checking Axle End Play With the axle shafts reinstalled, attach a dial indicator and measure the axle end play. The allowable axle end play is .010 inch (0,254 mm) maximum. If the axle end play exceeds the maximum range, remove the axle sprocket bolt and washer [A]. Install new washer (PIN 6563606 available from Melroe Parts Operation) and the bolt and tighten the bolt to 220-245 ft.-Ibs. (298-332 Nm) torque.
NOTE: The washer (PIN 6563606) is marked on each
side surface with the amount of end play the washer will take up .005 inch (0,127 mm) or .010 inch (0,254 mm).
Revised Oct. 95
-4-19-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
AXLE, SPROCKET AND BEARINGS (Cont'd)
Removal and Installation (Cont'd)
Remove the axle sprocket from the chaincase [A].
If the other side axle, sprocket and bearings are removed with one axle removed, use spacer plates and the Port-a-Power ram [B].
Install the bearing cup puller tool into the axle tube [C].
Pull the bearing cup from the axle tube [0].
Revised Oct. 95
-4-20­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
AXLE, SPROCKET AND BEARINGS (Cont'd)
A
Removal and Installation (Cont'd)
Use a long rod and bearing cup tool to remove the inner
bearing cup [A].
B
Use the correct size driver, install the outer bearing cup [B].
Install the long threaded rod into the axle tube. Install the correct size bearing cup driver tool. Install the washer and nut [C].
Inside the chaincase, install the bearing cup driver tool, washer and nut [0].
Revised Oct. 95
-4-21­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
AXLE, SPROCKET AND BEARINGS (Cont'd)
Removal and Installation (Cont'd)
Hold the nut inside the chaincase [A].
B
Turn the nut on the outside of the axle tube until the inner bearing cup is on its seat [B].
8-07682
c~
Use a press to remove the bearing from the axle [C]. Turn the axle around and press the new bearing into position on the axle [C).
~ i

~
I
i~~ II 111;';t:::=t::':::1:tI1 I: iT' I
)t-~
9--;-­
I I 8-07691
Revised Oct. 95
-4-22-

~I
8-07692
750 Series Loader Service Manual
DRIVE CHAIN Removal and Installation The tools listed will be needed to do the following procedure: MEL 1242 - Port-a-Power MEL1037 - Chain Link Tool Raise the lift arms. (See Page 1-1.) Lift and block the loader. (See Page 1-1.) Raise the operator cab. (See Page 1-1.) Remove the front panel/steering lever assembly. (See
Page 3-1.)
Remove the parking brake/cover assembly. (See Page
4-4.)
Remove the front and rear cover. (See Page 4-11.)
Remove the fluid from the chaincase. (See Page 4-24.)
Remove the front axle sprocket bolt [A].
Installation: Tighten the axle sprocket bolt to 220-245
ft.-Ibs. (298-332 Nm) torque.
Install a Port-a-Power ram between the two sprockets
with a spacer against the end of the axle [8].
Push the axle out until the ram is at the end of the stroke.
Add a spacer and repeat the procedure until the axle is out
of the sprocket.
Remove the motor carrier. (See Page 4-14.)
Remove the front and rear drive chain from the chaincase
[C].
Installation: If a new chain is installed, a connector link must be used to connect the chain together. Use a chain link tool and #80 chain adapter. Use a large wrench to hold the tool while pressing the chain link. Tighten the chain link tool bolt to 180 ft.-Ibs. (244 Nm) torque to press the chain link onto the chain [0].
Revised Oct. 95
-4-23­
750 Series Loader Service Manua'
CHAINCASE FLUID
Replacing the Chaincase Fluid Remove the cover from underneath the engine floor pan and behind the chaincase [A].
NOTE: When the drain plug is removed, install new rubber bushing on reassembly.
Remove the plug (Item 1) [8] and drain the oil into a container. To add fluid to the chaincase, remove the chaincase cover (see Page 4-10) and add the correct fluid to the chaincase. (See Specifications, Page 8-1.)
Revised Oct. 95
-4-24-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
MAIN FRAME
Page Number BOB-TACH
Bob-Tach Lever and Wedge .................. 5-11
Bob-Tach Stops (If Equipped) ................. 5-12
Removal and Installation .................... 5-8
FUEL TANK
Fuel Level Sender . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-16
Removal and Installation .................... 5-15
LIFT ARMS
Removal and Installation ... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-13
OPERATOR CAB
Removal and Installation .................... 5-5
OPERATOR CAB GAS CYLINDER
Disassembly and Assembly .................. 5-4
Removal and Installation .................... 5-3
REAR DOOR
Removal and Installation .................... 5-6
MAIN
FRAME
REAR GRILL
Removal and Installation .................... 5-7
SEAT BAR
Installation .......................... 5-6
Removal ........................... 5-6
TIGHTEN ALL HARDWARE PER SIZE TO GRADE 5 TORQUE (SEE STANDARD TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS FOR BOLTS, SECTION 8) UNLESS OTHERWISE SPECIFIED.
Revised Oct. 95
-5-1­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
-5-2-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
OPERATOR CAB GAS CYLINDER Removal and Installation
A WARNING
Cylinder contains high pressure gas. Do not open. Opening cylinder can release rod and cause injury or death.
W-2113-0288
Remove the operator cab stop (both sides) [A].
NOTE: Be careful not to break the rear window when the cab is raised after the cab stops are removed. Raise the operator cab. (See Page 1-7.) Remove the bolts from the bracket which mounts to the loader fender; Left side [B]; Right Side [C]. Slide the mounting bracket forward to release the tension on the gas cylinder.
Installation: Use a punch to align the holes in the mounting bracket with the holes in the loader fender. CD-08878
Remove the cotter pin from the top pivot pin [0].
Revised Oct. 95
-5-3­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
OPERATOR CAB GAS CYLINDER (Cont'd) Removal and Installation (Cont'd)
Remove the pivot pin and bushing [A] & [B].
Remove the gas cylinder.
Repeat the procedure to remove the other gas cylinder.
Disassembly and Assembly Remove the clevis (Item 1) [C] and washer (Item 2) [C)
from the end of the gas cylinder.
Remove the gas cylinder from the outer housing.
Installation: Install a replacement cylinder inside the cylinder housing. Apply a small amount of liquid adhesive (LOCTITE #242) on the threads of the cylinder rod [0]. Re-Install the washer and clevis on the cylinder rod.
Revised Oct. 95
-5-4-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
OPERATOR CAB
Removal and Installation Remove the gas cylinders. (See Page 5-3.) Disconnect the electrical wiring harness connectors [AJ.
B
Lower the operator cab. Connect a chain hoist to the operator cab as shown in figure [B].
Remove the nut from the pivot bolt (both sides) [C].
Installation: lighten the pivot bolt and nut to 25-35 ft.-Ibs. (34-47 Nm) torque.
Remove the pivot bolt (both sides) [0].
Lift the operator cab and remove it from the loader frame.
Revised Oct. 95
-5-5­
750 Series Loader
Service Manual
REAR DOOR
A
Removal and Installation
,.l'
Connect a chain hoist to the rear door [A].
Remove the pivot bolt and nut (both top and bottom) [B]. Remove the rear door from the hinges and loader.
c
SEAT BAR Removal Remove the bolt (Item 1) [C] that holds the seat bar pivot assembly (both sides).
NOTE: Check the position of the washer (Item 6) [C] and plate (Item 5) [C] for assembly. Remove the bolt (Item 2) [C], remove the parts from the
seat bar.
Remove the seat bar.
I
Installation
0-01870
Install the seat bar in the ROPS. Install spring (Item 4) [C] and plate (Item 5) [C] on the bushing (Item 3) [C]. Install bushing through seat bar and install washer (Item 6) [C] and bolt (Item 2) [C]. Align bushing with hole in ROPS and install bolt (Item 1) [C] through ROPS hole. lighten the bolts (Items 1 & 2)
[C]. Put grease on the pivot surface of the plate (Item 5) [C].
Revised Oct. 95
-5-6­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
REAR GRILL
Removal and Installation
Raise the rear grill.
Disconnect the wiring harness for the lights [A].
Remove the pivot bolt and nut and disconnect the left gas cylinder from the rear grill [8].
Remove the cotter pin from the pivot pin (both sides) [C]. Remove the pivot pin (both sides) [C].
Lift the rear grill from the loader [0].
Revised Oct. 95
-5-7­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
BOB-TACH
Removal and Installation Tilt the Bob-Tach fully forward until the front edge is on the floor [A]. Stop the engine. Move the hydraulic controls to release the hydraulic pressure.
Remove the retainer bolt from the pivot pin [B].
Installation: Tighten the retainer bolt to 18-20 ft.-Ibs. (24-27 Nm) torque.
Remove the grease fitting from the pivot pin [C].
Use a punch and hammer, remove the tilt cylinder rod end pivot pin [0).
C[)-{)871 0
Revised Oct. 95
-5-8­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
BOB-TACH (Cont'd) Removal and Installation Remove the hydraulic cylinder rod end. Remove the seals [A].
Installation: Put a piece of shim stock on each side over the seals. Install the rod end into the Bob-Tach frame [B].
Remove the grease fitting from the Bob-Tach frame for the pivot pin (both sides) [C].
NOTE: The grease fitting at the pivot pin must be removed because the grease can cause a lock and the pivot pin can not be pushed into the Bob-Tach frame.
Loosen the bolt at the Bob-Tach pivot pin (both sides) [0].
Installation: lighten the bolt to 130-140 ft.-Ibs. (176-190 Nm) torque.
Revised Oct. 95
-5--9-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
BOB-TACH (Cont'd)
Removal and Installation (Cont'd)
Hit the bolt to start the pivot pin into the Bob-Tach frame (both sides) [A]. Remove the bolt. Use a punch to push the pivot pin all the say into the Bob-Tach frame.
Installation: A long bolt may be needed to tum into the pivot pin. Pull the pivot pin into the lift arms. Remove the Bob-Tach frame from the lift arms.
Remove the seal dust cap (both sides) [B].
Remove the rubber seal (both sides) [C].
Turn the bolt into the pivot pin. Remove the pivot pin from the Bob-Tach frame [0]. Check for wear and damage. Replace the pivot pins as needed.
Revised Oct. 95
-5-10-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
BOB-TACH (Cont'd)
Bob-Tach Lever and Wedge
Use the following procedure to remove and install the
Bob-Tach lever, spring and wedge:
Remove the nut from the Bob-Tach lever [A].
Installation: lighten the nutto 25-28 ft.-Ibs. (34-38 Nm)
torque.
Remove the bushing and spring [B].
Remove the Bob-Tach lever [C].
Use a punch and hammer, remove the roll pin from the Bob-Tach wedge and spring bolt clevis assembly [0].
Revised Oct. 95
-5--11­
750 Series Loader Service Manua
BOB-TACH (Cont'd)
Bob-Tach Lever and Wedge (Cont'd)
Remove the spring, bolt and clevis assembly [A].
If the spring is damaged, put the assembly in the vise and remove the bolt [B]. Replace the worn or damaged parts as needed.
Remove the wedge from the Bob-Tach frame [C]. Always replace bent or broken wedges.
Bob-Tach Stops (If Equipped) Remove and replace the Bob-Tach stop (Item 1) [0] (both sides) if worn or damaged.
NOTE: The Bob-Tach stop (Item 1) [0] must contact the lift arm at the same time the tilt cylinder reaches full extension. Use available shims to adjust the Bob-Tach stop and tilt cylinder sequence as closely as possible.
Revised Oct. 95
-5-12-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
LIFT ARMS
A
Removal and Installation Tilt the Bob-Tach fully forward. Stop the engine. Move the hydraulic controls to release the hydraulic pressure. Remove the Bob-Tach frame from the lift arms. (See Page 5-8.) Install a chain hoist and chains on the lift arms as shown [A]. Remove the hydraulic hoses from the lift cylinders. (See Page 2-1.)
8-13100
Remove the retainer bolt and nut from the lift arm cylinder rod end pivot pin (both sides) [B].
Installation: Tighten the bolt and nut to 18-20 ft.-lbs. (24-27 Nm) torque. NOTE: The lift arms may have to be raised (use a floor jack) so there is clearance to remove the lift cylinder rod end pivot pin.
Remove the rod end pivot pin (both sides) [C]. Lower the lift arms. Remove the floor jack.
Remove the retainer bolt and nut from the lift arm link pivot pin (both sides) [0].
Installation: Tighten the retainer bolt and nut to 18-20 ft.-lbs. (24-27 Nm) torque.
Revised Oct. 95
-5-13­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
LIFT ARMS (Cont'd)
Removal and Installation (Cont'd)
Remove the lift arm pivot pin (both sides) [A]. Raise the lift arm link with a chain hoist and remove it from the loader frame.
A WARNING
Wear safety glasses to prevent eye injury when any of the following conditions exist: • When fluids are under pressure. • Flying debris or loose material is present. • Engine is running. • Tools are being used.
W-2019-1285
Revised Oct. 95
-5-14-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
FUEL TANK
Removal and Installation Remove the cover over the drain plug which is located
under the loader behind the chaincase.
Remove the drain plug (Item 1) [AJ from the fuel tank.
Drain all the fuel into a container.
Remove the enginelhydrostatic pumps assembly from
the loader. (See Page 7-1.)
Remove the bolts from the battery holddown plate [8].
Remove the battery holddown plate from the loader [C].
Disconnect the fuel fill hose and vent hose from the fuel tank [OJ.
Added Oct. 95
-5-15­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
TIGHTEN ALL HARDWARE PER SIZE TO GRADE 5 TORQUE (SEE STANDARD TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS FOR BOLTS, SECTION 8) UNLESS OTHERWISE SPECIFIED.
Revised Sept. 93
750 Series Loader Service Manual
WIRE LEGEND NO. 's 1M 10
lOA 10E 10EA 10M 12C 12DB 12DL 12DR 12HW 19C 19L 19S 19W 2 'IR 38A 38AA 38AM 38B 38BA 38BM 40FR 41 42FL 42FR 42R
46 46L 46R 56A
56L 56P 57L 60H 60W
64
COLOR Red Black Black Black Black Black Orange Orange Orange Orange Orange Red/White Red/Wh ite Red/White Red/White White Purple/Red Purple/Red Purple/Red Purple /Wh i te Purple /Wh ite Purple/White Black Pink Dk. Blue Dk. Blue' Dk. Blue/Yellow Brown Brown Brown Dk . Green/Yellow Lt. Green/Blue Lt. Green/Red Lt. Green/Pink Black Black Orange /B Iue
Pr inted in U. S . A .
PARTS LEGEND GAUGE 16 10 12
16 16 16
CD
GD
@ @
Harness Connectors
Operator Cab Ground
Wiper Sw itch (Opt.)
Wiper
(Opt.)
14 18
® ®
Left Front Light
16
(J)
Flasher
18 18
16 16 16 16 16
® ®
Left Flasher Light (Opt,)
Right Front Light Right Flasher Light (Opt.)
18
@ Q]) @
16 16
@
18 18 18
@
Light Switch
®
Ignition Switch
16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16
@ @ @
Instrument Panel Display Display Back Light Aux i I iary Hydraul ics Control Switch Diagnostic Monitor Connector
HOI-n (Opt.) Frame Ground Horn Connector
16
16 16
16 16 16 16
Me 18771e
WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6724018) Sheet 1 Of 3 With BOSS - With Hi-Flow Hydraulics Operator Cab 753 (SIN 511011007 «Above) (SIN 511475003 - 75999) (SIN 512711001 - 15999) (Printed January 1995)
Printed in U S.A.
Me
1877'118
WIRE LEGEND NO. 's 1M 10 10A 10E 10EA 1
12DB 12DL 12DR 12HW 19C 19L 19S 19W 21R 38A 38AA 38AM 38B 38BA 38BM 40FR 41 42FL 42FR 42R 46 46L 46R 56A 56L 56P 57L 60H 60W 64
COLOR Red Block Black Block Black I ck ange
Orange Orange Orange Orange Red/White Red/White Red/White Red/Wh ite White Purple/Red PurQle/Red Purple/Red Purple/White Puq~le/White
Purple/White Block Pink Dk. Blue Dk. Blue Ok. Blue/Yellow Brown Brown Brown Dk .' Green/Yellow Lt. Green/Blue Lt. Green/Red Lt. Green/P ink Block Block Orange/Blue
Pr inted in US. A .
PARTS LEGEND GAUGE 16
10 12 16
16 1 18 16 18
18 16 16
16 16 16
18 16
16 18 18
18
16 16
16
16 16
16
16
16
16
16
16
16
16
16
16
CD ®
Harness Connectors
@ @
Wiper Switch (Opt. )
® ®
Left Flasher Light (Opt.)
Left Front Light
(j)
Flasher
® ®
Right Front Light
Operator Cob Ground Wiper
(Opt. )
Right Flasher Light (Opt. 1
@
Instrument Panel Display
<>
Display Back Light
@
Auxil iary Hydraul ics
Contro I Sw itch D iagnost ic Mon itor
Connector
@ @
Light Switch
®
Ignition Switch
@ @ @
HOI-n (Opt.) Frame Ground
HOI-n Connector
Me 18771e
WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6724018) Sheet 2 Of 3 With BOSS - With Hi-Flow Hydraulics
Engine Wiring 753 (SIN 511011007 &- Above) (SIN 511475003 - 75999) (SIN 512711001 - 15999) (Printed January 1995)
Pr hted in U. S A
1876ti 18
WIRE LEGEND NO. 's
o
I lA lAA lAB lB
ICB ID
IF 1M IT 10
10CB 10E 10H
10HA 12B 12C
12CA 12CB
120L
12DR
12G
12HW
12S 14F 14R 19C 19F
19S 19SA
20
20A 20B
20C
20F 20M
20S 21R
215 23F 23F
23FA 23FP
28A 28B
30AF 30CL 30F
30P
30PE
30S
30T 30TE
31S 33P 33T
34F 34P
34PA
34T
36A 36C
36F 38A 38B
40 41
42R
50A
50V
51
COLOR
WIRE LEGEND (Cont'd)
GAUGE
Black Red Red Red Red Red Red Red Red Red Red Black Black Black Black Black Orange Orange Orange Orange Orange Orange Orange Orange Orange Lt. Green Lt. Green/White Red/White Red/White Red/White Red/White Black Black Black Black Black Black Black White White/Lt. Green White/Black (Harness) Red/Blue (T imer Module) Red/Blue White/Blue Lt. Blue/Orange Lt. Blue /Orange Black Black Black Black Black Black Black Black Yellow /Lt, Blue Yellow /Green Yellow/Red Yellow /Dk. Blue Yellow /L t, Blue Lt. Blue Yellow/Brown Purp I e Purple/L t. Blue Purple Purple/Red Purple/White Black Pink Dk, Blue/White Black Black Lt. Blue/White
Prinled in U.S.A.
Cable Cable 12
14
12 10 16
14
12
16 14 14 14 16 16 16 16 14 16 16 16 16 16 16
16 16
16
16 12 14 14 14 14 16
16
16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 14 16
12
16 16 16 16 16 16
16 16 16 16 16 16
16 16 16
16 16 16 16 16
16 16 16 16
16 16
NO. 's 51B 51S
51SA
51SS 56A 56L
56P
570A 57L
66
COLOR
GAUGE
16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16
Orange/Blue Orange/White Orange/White White/Orange Dk. Green/Yellow Ok. Green/Blue Ok. Green/Red Yellow Ok. Green/Pink Orange/Green
16
PARTS LEGEND
CD Harness Connectors ® Left Tail Light ® Left Rear Work Light @
® ®
CD
® ® ® QD
@ @
(j3) @ @ @ @ @
®
@ @
@ @
@ @ @ @ @
Radiator Coolant Level Sender Right Rear Work Light Right Tail Light Shut-Down Relay Hydraul ic Flu id Different ial Pressure Sensor Back-up Alarm (Opt.) System Operating Unit Hydraul ic Charge Pressure Sensor Hydraulic Fluid Temperature Sensor Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor Air Cleaner Switch Alternator Engine Oil Pressure Sender Fuel Shut-Off Solenoid Magnetic Pickup (Engine RPM) Fuel Sensor Starter Fuel Pump Connector Glow Plugs Ground Battery Starter Relay Glow Plug Relay Fuse 25 Amp. - Ignition Fused 25 Amp. - Accessory Fused and Switched Power Fused Accessory Power Back-Up Alarm Connector
® ® ® Oiverter Valve (Opt.) ® Fuel Shut-Off Solenoid Timer ® Not Used On This Appl icat ion
Module
Me
18761e
WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6724018) Sheet 3 Of 3 With BOSS - With Hi-Flow Hydraulics Operator Controls 753 (SIN 511011007 «Above) (SIN 511475003 - 75999) (SIN 512711001 - 15999) (Printed January 1995)
?r inteo in U. S . A
2023ti 18
PARTS LEGEND
WIRE LEGEND
NO.
's 12 12B 12H 12HW 12K 12L 12M 12S 50A 50B 50C 50D 50E 50F 50G
50V 56A 56AL 56B 56BA 56BB 56L 56P 56R 56RA 56RC 57DA 57F 57L 57RB 57RB 57RBA 57RBB 57RR 57RR 57RRA 57R
Printed
COLOR
GAUGE
Orange 16 Orange 16 Orange 16 Orange 16 Orange 16 Orange 16 Orange 16 Orange 16 Black 16 Black 16 Black 16 Black 16 Black 16 Black 16 I k 1 lack 1 Black 16 Ok. Green/Yellow 16 Dk. Green 16 Ok. Green/Red 16 Ok. Green/Red 16 Ok. Green /Red 16 Lt. Green/Blue 16 Lt. Green/Red 16 Ok. Green/L t . Green 16 Ok. Green/L t . Green 16 Ok. Green/Lt. Green 16 Yellow 16 Lt. Blue/Red 16 Lt. Green/Pink 1 ue ed Yellow (Console Harness) 16 Yeliow/White(High Flow Harness)16 White/Yellow 16 Yellow 16 Brown (High Flow Harness) 16 Yeliow/White(Console Harness) 16 Brown 16 1 ue 16
in LJ. S. A.
CD
® @ (D
® ® rJ)
®
Left Multi-Switch Control Handle Right Multi-Switch Control Handle Auxil iary Control Module Horn Connector Hydraul ic Control Valve High Pressure Rei ief Valve Front Aux i I iary Soleno id (Base End/Female Coupler) Front Auxil iary Solenoid (Rod End/Male Coupler)
® Hi-Flow
On/Off Switch
@ @
Hi-Flow Solenoid
®
D iverter Soleno id
Diodes
~ Rear/Secondary Front Auxiliary Solenoid (Base End/Female Coupler)
~ Rear/Secondary Front Auxiliary Solenoid (Rod End/Male Coupler)
Me
20231e
WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6724019) Sheet 1 Of 3 With BOSS - Without Hi-Flow Hydraulics Operator Cab 753 (SIN 508690400 - 92999) (SIN 511525541 & Above) (SIN 512711001- 15999) (Printed January 1995)
Pr irited iri U. S . p., .
~c
18Tlt; 19
NO.
's
r'v~
10
10J 10 1O~.A 10 Ii1
12C 120B 12 L
19/1/ 1R
WIRE LEGEND COLOR ed Black BI k BloCK Bla k Bleck Orange rang ra e range Orange Red/Wh ite Red/White Red/Wh ite Rea/White
41 '-12R
56A 56L 6P 5 L
60
6 W 64
GAUGE 10
CD ®
12
@)
Wioer~
Switch
G)
W; oer
( pt.)
® ®
Left Flasher Light (Opt.)
16 16 16 14
18 16 1
18 16 16 16 1
16 18 16 16 18 18
38B.A 38BM 40FR 4 F 42FR
PARTS LEGEND
lue B!ue Ok. Blue/Yellow Brown f3rown 13rown k. Green/Yellow i. Green lue Lt. Lt. ink l3lach: Block Orange /B! ue
Printed in U . . A.
16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16
Harness
'lnectors
Operator Cab Ground (Opt,)
L ft Front Light
G)
F IClsher
® ®
Right Front Li
@ CI}) @
@
Right Flasher Light Ins
nel iJ isploy
um
Oi olay Bock Light AUXiliary Hy auli s Contra I Sw itch Dio nosiic Monitor anne tor
@
Ughi
®
I grl it i 0'1 S wit c h
@ @ @
t
HOI-n
From Horn
Switcr (Opt.) Ground nn ctor
~6
16 16 16 16 16 16
~AC
18771e
.)
WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6724019) Sheet 2 Of 3 With BOSS - Without Hi-Flow Hydraulics Engine WiT ing 753 (SIN 508690400 - 92999) (SIN 511525541 & Above) (SIN 512711001- 15999) (Printed January 1995)
Me 1876ri 19
WIRE LEGEND
NO,
'5
COLOR
..- = .-­
.~-~--
WIRE LEGEND (Cont'd)
GAUGE
NO,
COL OR
'5
GAUGE
e e
PARTS LEGEND
CD Harness
® ® @
Connectors Left Toil Li t Left Rear Work L i Raolator Coo;ant Level Sender
® ®
Right Real' Work Light Ri t Tail Li ([) Shut -Down Re lay
® ®
®
QD @ @ @
®
Hydraul ic F!u id Different ial Press:Jre Sensor Bock-up Alarm (0 .) S
em Operat ing Unit
Hydraul ie Charge Pressure Sensor ydraul ic Flu id emperature Sensor tir
ine Coolant Temperature Sensor leaner Switch
@
Alternator ine Oi: Pressure Sender
@ @
Fuel Shut-Off Solenoid tv1agnet ie Pickup ng ine RPM)
@ @
Fuel Sensor Starter Fuel Pump Connector Glow Plugs
@ @ @
Battery Starter R.::lay Glow Plug Relay
® ®
@ Ground
@Fuse 25 Amp.
@
® ® ® ® ® ® Printed in U S.A.
Ignition
Fused 25 Amp. Accessory Fused and Sw itched Power Fused Power Back-Up !,Iarm ConnecT0r !)iverrer Valve
(Opt.)
Fuel Shut Off Soleno Id Timer Module Not Used On Th is Appl icaT ien Me
18761e
WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6724019) Sheet 3 Of 3 With BOSS - Without Hi-Flow Hydraulics Operator Controls 753 (SIN 508690400 - 92999) (SIN 511525541 «Above) (SIN 512711001 - 15999) (Pr lnted January 1995)
M'
Iti 19
WIRE LEGEND
PARTS LEGEND GAUGE
12B
range Orange
CD
Left Two-Sw itch Control Handle
@
Left Multi-Switch Control Handle (Opt. )
®
Right Two-Sw itch Control Handle
16 1
@
Right Multi-Switch Control Handle (Opt. )
16 1
®
Auxil iary Control Module
@)
Horn Connector
® ®
Hydraul ic Control Valve
(J)
Front Aux i I iary Soleno id (Rod End/Male Coupler)
16 1 16
12K ange Orange lack ack Black ack Green/Yellow Green Green/Red Green/Red Green/Red Green/Blue Green/Red Green/Lt. Green Green/L t . Green Green
16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 1 1 16 1 1 16
Front Auxiliary Solenoid (Base End/Female Coupler)
Me ZOZ lie
WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6724020) Sheet 1 Of 3 Without BOSS - Without Hi-Flow Hydraulics Operator Cab 753 (SIN 511350883 & Above) (SIN 512711001 - 15999) (Printed January 1995)
riC
I
NO.
WIRE LEGEND COLOR GAUGE
's
PARTS LEGEND
CD ® @
Harness Connectors Operator Cab Ground Auxiliary
draulics Cornector
@
Left Flasher L·
® ®
Left Front Li
(J)
® ®
@ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @) @ @
em
@
t. ) )
Flasher Ri
Front Light
(
ight Flasher Light
t.) (Opt.
Shutdown Module
(Opt.)
'o/ViperSwitch(
t.)
Wip
(
t)
Ign it ion Sw Itch Light Sw itch Glow PIJg Pr'e -Heat Button Igr it ion FU3e Accessory
~use
Hourmeter Fuel ture Vol trneter Engine Warning TI~ansmissicn
Warning
Horn Cornecto r
® Horn

. !
~'~-~'--'~'--'--'--'--'~'----
..
~-.~.~-
--~
..
Pr,ntea in L: S.A.
-
__ __
·._-_.__.
.
.
--_.­ Me 17041e
WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6724020) Sheet 2 Of 3 Without BOSS - Without Hi-Flow Hydraulics Engine Wiring 753 (SIN 511350883 & Above) (SIN 512711001 - 15999) (Printed January 1995)
Printed ir U.S.A.
Me
'895t120
WIRE NO. 's
PARTS LEGEND
GEND GAUGE
COLOR
CD Harness Connectors ® Left Tall Light ( @ @
® ® CD ® ® @ C[j)
Left
or Work
. )
t';:lghl Rear Work Ri
(Opt.
t.)
Tail Li
t .)
Bad' Up Alarm Starler C:::e ay Glow Plug r~eloy
used and Sw itch Power Fused Accessory Power Glow P
@ Ground @ @ @ @ @ @ @
®
@ @ @
@ @
~~~~-----
Printed in U.S.A.
.
- -. - -..
Battery Fuel Sender' Eng ine 0 i I Pressur
Sender
!=uel Shut-Off Solenoid I ic (!jorge Pressure Sw itch H
ic
luid
ure Switc'1
_ng ine Coolant Temoeratt.;re Sendor Starter Alternator Back
Alorm Cornector
Fuel Shut -Off Soleno id T i rr,er 1v1odule
~
ouli
Filter Pressur
D iverter Volve
Switch
(Opt.)
­
Me
18951e
WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6724020) Sheet 3 Of 3 Without BOSS - Without Hi-Flow Hydraulics Operator Controls 753 (SIN 511350883 & Above) (SIN 512711001 - 15999) (Printed January 1995)
pr'nred in U. S
lAC ZOZ It
WIRE LEGEND COLOR
PARTS LEGEND GAUGE 1 16 1 18 16
lZB
56R 5 A 56RC 57 A 57L 57R 57RB 7 64
Printe
Orange Orange lack Black Black lack lac Ok. Green/Yellow Gr n Green/Red Green/Red Green/Red Green/ lue Green/Red Green /L t . Green reen Green
Ye!low ite Yellow/ rang /Blue
in U.S.A.
1 16 1 1 16 16 16 16 16
16 6 16 16 16
CD
Left Two Sw itch Control Handle
@
Left Multi-Switch Control Handle (Opt. )
®
Right Two-Sw itch Control Handle
@
Right Multi Sw itch Control Handle (Opt.
@ (3)
1
Aux i I iary Control Module Horn Connector
® ®
Hydraul ic Contro I Valve
(j)
Front Auxiliary Solenoid (Rod End/Male Coupl er)
Front Auxiliary Solenoid (Base End/Female Coupler)
16 16 16 16 16 16 16
Me 20211e
WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6724021) Sheet 1 Of 3 Without BOSS - With Hi-Flow Hydraulics Operator Cab 753 (SIN 512711001 - 15999) (Pr inted January 1995)
Printed in U.S.A.
tv'C
1704tlZ 1
WIRE LEGEND NO. 's
COLOR
PARTS LEGEND GAUGE
CD
Harness Connectors
~ Operator Cab Ground
®
@ @
® CD ® ®
@ @ @ @ @ @
Auxiliary Hydraulics Connector Left Flasher Light Left Front Light
(Opt.)
(Opt.)
Flasher Right Front Light Right
(Opt.)
lasher Li
Shutdown Module Wiper Switch
(Opt. (Opt.)
[Opt.)
Wiper (Opt.) Ignition Switch Light Switch Glow Plug Pre-Heat Button Ign it ion Fuse
~ Accessory Fuse
@ @) @
Hourmeter
@ @ @ @
Voltmeter
®
Printed in U
. A.
Fuel Temperature Gouge ine Warning Lamp Transmissicn Warning Lamp Horn Connector i-'orn (Opt.)
Me
17041e
WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6724021) Sheet 2 Of 3 Without BOSS - With Hi-Flow Hydraulics Engine Wiring
753 (SIN 512711001 - 15999) (Printed January 1995)
Pr inted In U. S. A.
M:
1895ti21
WIRE LEGEND COLOR GAUGE
NO. 's
PARTS LEGEND
CD Harness Connec1ors ® Left Tall Light [Opt.) @ @
Left Rear Work Light Right Rear Work
® Ri t ® Bock (J)
® ®
Tail Light Alarm
(Opt.)
ight
(
.)
(Opt.) (Opt.)
Starter Re.ay Glow Plug Relay Fused and Sw itch Power
~ Fused Accessory Power
(jJ)
G:ow Plugs
@ @ @ @ @ @
Battery
@ Ground
J ;0.
t·.
~~-.-.---
Eng ine 0 i I Pressure Sender Fue
Shut -Off Soleno id
Hydraul ic Charge Pressure Sw itch Hydrauli
FlUid
oture SWitch
®
Engine Coolant Ternperature Sendo,·
®
Start r
@
Alternator
®
Bock
@
Fuel Shut
@
I ic Filter Pressure Switch l)iverier Volve (Opt.)
®
- - - ....
Fuei Sendel'
Alorrn Con'18cior
ff Soleno id Timer Modul
WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6724021) Sheet 3 Of 3 Without BOSS - With Hi-Flow Hydraulics Operator Controls 753 (SIN 512711001 - 15999) (Printed January 1995)
Printed ;n U.S.A.
Me 2023ti21
WIRE LEGEND
PARTS LEGEND
COLOR
50C
GAUGE
Orange Orange e range Orange Ora ange Orange Black lack Black BI k
50F
Ilow
Green Green/Lt. /
reen Green
16 16 1 16 16 16 1 16 1 1 16 16 1 16 16 1 16 1 6 16 1 1 16 16
16 16 1 Harness) 16 16 1 16 16 Harness) 16 16
CD
Left Multi-Switch Control Handle
®
Right Mult I -Sw Itch Control Handle
@
Au>( iii ar y Contro I Module
0 ® ®
Horn Connector
(J)
Front Auxiliary Solenoid (Bese End/Female Coupler)
®
Front Auxiliary Solenoid (Rod d/Male Coupler)
®
Hi-Flow On/Off Switch
@ @ @ @ @
Hydraul ic Control Valve High Pressure Relief Valve
Diodes Hi--Flow Soleno id Oiverter Soleno id Rear/Secondary Front fuxiliary Solenoid (Base End/Female Coupler) Rear/Secondary Front Auxiliary Solenoid (Rod End/Male Coupler)
lue ---~--~----~---~
Printed in U. S. A.
Me 20231e
WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6724022) Sheet 1 Of 1
Optional Attachment Wiring Harness
753
(For use on Models with Multi-Switch Handles Only)
(Printed January 1995)
Pri~ted
,n
.S A.
Me Z0631 iZZ
WIRE LEGEND COLOR
GAUGE
16
14
CD ®
PARTS LEGEND Connect r-Water Kit
Wir ing i· :rness Connectot' Aux i I iary Bleed Connector - Fused and Sw i tche Connector - Hot and Fused (An Ie Brooni) Connec or Stump Gr i nder (High Flow Valve) Power Relay SturY',P Grinder Power R lay Angle Broom Power Relay - Front/Rear Auxlliory @) Plu In Connector - Lift Arm arness QJ) Diode Mociule 12 Connector - 0 iode Mule Connector - Right Control Hande Connector Loader Control Harness Connector Control Handle

ffi®
* Alternate Color Used On Some Harnesses.
Pr Inted in U. S . A.
Me 20631e
(12-12-941
OPERATOR CAB WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6720317)
Model 753 (SIN 11078 & Below)
(Printed August 1990) 1 Of 3 Pages
lector
e-R
: :'l:
Q) (I) (')
ORANGE/BLACK
~
:::'«l:
:::'l: 0
(I) ('>')
~O
' BLACK
ft
: :'l:
~;:
r:J
v-lJoo-'11 ~lOA - - - - - - - - - - - - - ­
,
1=1=
10
trol
,--­ r­
-
-
-
-
-
r
-
r,-~ Uo::
I
«OQ)IJJ
NN-aJOl«lO
'1''1'('>')-(')-
~,
.J
00200:: N N
r:!~:::'l:i5<>
I()L!')--u'll()
ITII...-G
[A]
[I]
Electrical Chart - Page 1

~
s:
~
~
:::I :::I :::1:::1
~


~
~
NNN
~
QQ
II I QQ QQ

. :::. . rIr
• nnn ::r::r::r
~
II'I!!!!!! -!p.p.
[O]~~
rJrJrJ
VI
~~~ VI VI
~
~ :::I
n 0 0 n n
I ,
f'-.
w'ht.1-. •
~

'
tite
e [O]~~
.!. ... ... ...
o
G~
-
ft:::::-
-
)
I
I
I
I
--'
10E
lZDR-------------------~
38BA-------------------~
10EA
! 20B - - - - - - '
GREENWHITE - - - - - - - - - - - - .
56P 51L - - - - - - - - - ­
1Z H i / f Y - - - - - - - ­
56L -
19S - - - - - - '
10
)
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
19C-­
I
) 1I I I I I I J
IIII
I I I
:;~
~~~
ZC
55A--~
~
46R
~
e
t
-------cO
42FR
ot
CD 1
CD
t
46~
46L 46R ____
10
'-;~~~ '-~---
I
II
46L-6
CD
PARTS LEGEND
WIRE LEGEND NO.'s COLOR lD IF 1M 10 lOA 10E 10M 10EA 12C 12DB 12DL 12DR 12HW 19C 19F 19L 19S 19W 21R 38A 38AA 38AM 38B 38BA 38BM 40FR 41 42FL 42FR 42R 46 46L 46R 56A 56L 56P 57L 60W
Red Red Red Black Black Black Black Black Orange Orange Orange Orange Orange Red/White Red/White Red/White Red/White Red/White White Purple/Red Purple/Red Purple/Red Purple/White Purple/White Purple/White Black Pink Dk. Blue Dk. Blue Dk. Blue/White Brown Brown Brown Dk. Green/Yellow Dk. Green/Blue Lt. Green/Red Lt. Green/Pink Black
GAUGE 12 16 16 12 12 16 16 18 14 18 16 18 18 16 16 16 16 16 16 18 16 16 18 18 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16
0
e
Operator Cab Ground
6)
Wiper Switch (Opt.)
e
Wiper (Opt.)
e
e
e
e
e e
Diagnostic Monitor Connector Left Flasher Light (Opt.) Left Front Light Flasher (Opt.) Right Front Light
-e
Right Flasher Light (Opt.)
4D
Fuse . Ignition
(8
Fuse . Acc.essory
e
Light Switch
fa
Ignition Switch
CD
e2 e2 e2
Harness Connectors
Electrical Chart - Page 1 ­
Instrument Panel Display Display Back Light Auxiliary Hydraulics Control Switch
ENGINE WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6720317) Model 753 (SIN 11078 Be Below)
UGE 16
16
16
(Printed August 1990) 2 Of 3 Pages
~
16
16
~
F=mii=1J1 . ' '
~ t
~
16
16
16
16
16
~~w-----. 57L - - - . . . 56P - - - , .
~
16 16
66-­ 128­
56L
o
--------., ,.----­ ,----­
-
-­ - ­ -­
ed)
,-----­
Electrical Chart - Page 2 ­
e
f)
•.
-i 6cE
~ .-~o-w o
~~
~
v':t
~~
:~~.
.rn:t::= ::, ­ 41
.-~ ~~~
n~
;~~----12G - - - - - - - - - - - - ­ - - - - - 2 3 F ------------- .
.)
TTTTI/I/...-rTT111
~ ~ ~ ~ ~;; ~~ ~g ~~ ~~ ~ gl~lgl1S
I:~=
JTF ~~~ H o ~ I 3' ~ U~.O
:1:!Jtl-tIJI1' ~;JOo-. I~I~ -1-1-1-1-----------------------­ -
~~
i::
~-G)
1-8
r-:::::.:::c::m - fr ~:: =fJJ, --::U ·I=::~d J 0
4D

~URPLE/RED 18 PURPLE
- - 1-1-1-1-1-1 -- -- --,-.­ LLu.
<><>
~
-+-E)
20
-30PE~
31S1[;:
fa :t
/n 1-23FA...-~ 23,::fJj
---I
-G»
I
[J
W
i-33P
~4-0
IAl Connects To IAl
M.-G) MC-1112
Elect. [IJ Connects to [j] Elect. ~ Connects to ~ Elect. Connects to [~ Elect.
rm
Chart-Page Chart-Page Chart-Page Chart-Page
1 1 1 3
NO.'s 0 1 lA lAA lAB lB lCA lCB lD 1M 10 10CB 10E 10H 10HA 12B 12C 12CA 12CB 12DL 12DR 12G 125 12HW 14F 14R 19C 20 20B 20C 20F 20M 205 21R 215 23FA 23FB 28A 28B 30AF 30CL 30F 30P 30PE 305 30T 30TE 315 33P 33T 34F 34P 34T 36A 36C 36F 38A 38B 40 40L 40LA 40R 40RA 41 41L 41R
WIRE LEGEND COLOR Black Red Red Red Red Red Red Red Red Red Black Black Black Black Black Orange Orange Orange Orange Orange Orange Orange Orange Orange Lt. Green Lt. Green/White Red/White Black Black Black Black Black Black White/Lt. Green White/Lt. Green Red/Blue White/Blue Lt. Blue/Orange Lt. Blue/Orange Black Black Black Black Black Black Black Black Yellow/Lt. Blue Yellow/Green Yellow/Red Yellow/Dk. Blue Yellow/Lt. Blue Yellow/Brown PUfl~le
Purple/Lt. Blue Purple Purple/Red Purple/White Black Black Black Black Black Pink Pink Pink
GAUGE Cable Cable 12 14 12 10 16 16 10 16 14 14 16 16 16 16 14 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 14 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 14 16 12 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16
WIRE LEGEND (Cont'd)
NO.'s COLOR GAUGE
42R 42RR sOA SOY 51 slB 515 s15A 5155 s6A s6L S6P s7L s7DA 66
Dk. Blue/White Dk. Blue/White Black Black Lt. Blue/White Orange/Blue Orange/White Orange/White White/Orange Dk. Green/Yellow Dk. Green/Blue Dk. Green/Red Dk. Green/Pink Yellow Orange/Green
16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16
PARTS LEGEND
0
e
e 0 e
e G e e
G G
e G) e
e e 8 e
G
~ f) ~ i)
G
e e G e
Harness Connectors Left Tail Light Left Rear Work Light Radiator Coolant Level Sender Right Rear Work Light Right Tail Light Shut-Down Relay Hydraulic Fluid Filter Differential Pressure Switch Charge Pressure Sender Hydraulic Fluid Temperature Sender System Operating Unit Air Cleaner Switch Engine Coolant Temp, Sender Alternator Fuel Shut-Off Solenoid Engine Oil Pressure Sender Fuel Pump Connector Glow Plugs Magnetic Pick-Up (Engine Speed) Fuel Sender Starter Ground Battery Diverter Valve Glow Plug Relay Starter Relay Fused and Switch Power Fused Accessory Power
AUXILIARY HYD. WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6720317) Model 753 (SIN 11078 & Below) (Printed August 1990) 3 Of 3 Pages
-0 570 12K
~~
570-­ 12K
::::clil
~
N
~
, - - - - - - - 64
/
r=f:
d
8
~
Cf)
N
-
-
IO~_
56B - ­ 570 - ­ 56RA r _ 56R -570A 56BA 57R 56AL
~
--J
-r- -( en oLO
12 50B
56L 56P 12HW 57L
I
G+ ~
57L ~ 12HW 56P ­ 56L 570A
~ Electrical Chart - Page 3 ­
~12S
50A 'IRA
I
,
.
-(-f
« 0
lC)
56R
-
568

::::::cm co a::
«)«) L0L0
a
56AL 12M
57R
50V
I
~.,.~
.:.J
~.2 L0N
11 5~~~
-0
()
o
L0
MC-1114
~ Connects To ~ Elect. Char~-Page
:2
WIRE LEGEND NO.'s COLOR 12 12HW 12K 12M 12S 50A SOB SOC SOD 50V 56A 56AL 56B 56BA 56BB 56L 56P 56R 56RA 57D 57DA 57L 57R 64
Orange Orange Orange Orange Orange Black Black Black Black Black Dk. Green/Yellow Dk. Green Dk. Green/Red Dk. Green/Red Dk. Green/Red Lt. Green/Blue Lt. Green/Red Dk. Green/Lt. Green Dk. Green/White Yellow/Lt. Green Yellow Lt. Green/Pink U. Blue/Red Orange/Blue
PARTS LEGEND GAUGE 16
16 16 16
16 16
16 16
16
16 16
16 16
16
16
16
16
16
16
16
16
16
14
16
0
e e e e e G e
Electrical Chart - Page 3 ­
Left Steering Lever Control
Harness Connectors Horn Relay Switch Box
Right Steering Lever Control
Harness Connector (Future Use) Auxiliary Solenoids
Hydraulic Control Valve
OPERATOR CAB WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6720582) Model 753 (SIN 11079 Thru 13487) (Printed September 1991) 1 Of 3 Pages (
~-e w ' - ORANGE/BLACK

~
~LAC' - - - - .
[
1----
60W-------------- --­
t.)
I - - - - 19W - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - ,
III
lOA 10-····
t
0
-
,---­
-ltrol
,--­
,r-­
-

-
- -

-
I
-
-1­

-1­
­
-
OCt: <:ocow NN-(()(l)(()0
-'<><>
-
-
-
-
,­ - -
...,
- -1­ - -1­ - - - - - - -
,--­
(/)criS
r-ft
cr
..J<:
( )°_ N-O _lN N
~'~--8----+-11
I..JQ.
1'-<><><>
1f)1f)--If)LCl
....-Itlr--,'
~::::J
~~
lZC
S
1 • S~
56A
Electrical Chart - Page 1 ­

19S
i' B) .-6)
::0
(') C
CD
CO>
II)
CD
CO>
II)
(') C
~
31 . .:3
~
31
~
~
(')
(')
CO>
~
CD
1'1'1
(')
1'1'1
CD
~
CD
1'1'1
-
­ . .
=- =- =­ ... ... ...
I I I
~ ~ ~
'FJ 'FJ 'FJ
II)
CD
= = =
= = = .. .. ~
C
(')
~ ~ ~
w co w
~
l
5:
-r]
N
.r;,.
e .
~
<>
~
Ol
~
::0
N
I
I
I
I
-56P --57L
12HW V
50L
38AMI ­
10M
I
I
I
I
I
I I
I
I
I)
I
I I
)
10E
1ZDL
I
I
I
I
I
I
-I
I
T
11
' ' I I -4
I
I I I I
2DR--------·----------~
38AA
12DB 10EA 38BA
GREE ',WHITE~ _ _ _ _ GREE
~
I
I
I
I
I
1M
I
I
I
I
I I
I I
42FL 42FR 38BM
I
I
46
e--. ~~_ ;~~ ) !!!! J I J e . ~I ------------~~~~~- e .
)
I
r
46
I
' - - - - - 46R
CD ''-0
III
W
.
W
_A
-G
46L~~ _ 46R~JIII
,6L
'------- :~?,--~-.
l
WIRE LEGEND NO.'s COLOR 1M 10 lOA 10E 10EA 10M 12C 12DB 12DL 12DR 12HW 19C 19L 19S 19W 21R 38A 38AA 38AM 38B 38BA 38BM 40FR 41 42FL 42FR 42R 46 46L 46R S6A S6L S6P S7L 60W
Red Black Black Black Black Black Orange Orange Orange Orange Orange Red/White Red/White Red/White Red/White White Purple/Red Purple/Red Purple/Red Purple/White Purple/White Purple/White Black Pink Dk. Blue Dk. Blue Dk. Blue/White Brown Brown Brown Dk. Green/Yellow Lt. Green/Blue Lt. Green/Red Lt. Green/Pink Black
PARTS LEGEND GAUGE 16 12 12 16 18 16 .-~
18 16 18 18 16 16 16 16 16 18 16 16 18 18 18 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16
0
e 8
e e
e
Harness Connectors Operator Cab Ground Wiper Switch (Opt.) Wiper (Opt.)
Left Flasher Light (Opt.) Left Front Light
0
Flasher (Opt.)
0
Right Front Light
CD CO G
Right Flasher Light (Opt.)
e
Instrument Panel Display Display Back Light Auxiliary Hydraulics Control Switch
CD 4D
Diagnostic Monitor Connector
'
Ignition Switch
Electrical Chart - Page 1 ­
Light Switch
ENGINE WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6720582)
Model 753 (SIN 11079 Thru 13487) (Printed September 1991) 2 Of 3 Pages
o
fJ ~
[AJ / [jJ
~Fr~
M~;il~~
o
~,[email protected]~---.J
1ii: ;0~ ~
;!~§~~g
G +
I:.
19 - - - - - - ' IM-­ 1J'lDA~
-118

zoc-­ ----IM-­
IIS-I­ ~---1J'lDA
-
+ + + f'-fJi *'40
-
~----5OV
~' m~.*J ~ tltl-j-JJJ­ ­ -
I' ID
IF lAB
e-B
Electrical Chart - Page 2 ­
I
I3FI 211
'-41
'--_ _ _ _1
o
o
* ~i
0
0
l
+
~R
l
1r ~
r------------------------------2OW-------~ -----------------------------5'B------------~ Z~A---------------

o
~ ~ ; Ri ~ R~ ~ ~I
@:=
E=ml~~· ~ U0 =::::::tJSP . lOT :MT
_
:~~''~--G
e
:'-m:J::.
CD
0
1.
~
lIOF'E: P'
:::::::m:.J:a

l ::::::c:.J ~ PlII'E/IED I'IIII'U! - - - - - - - - j
141' 18
lO
2ft z:!JFA
::: '---------­
:
3aJn :::::tJ [If:::::::E
:::tt=cJ
[ }.-G)
'-0
1-+-0 MC-1392
[A] Connects To ~ Connects to ~ Connects to ~ Connects to
[A] Elect. Chart-Page ~ Elect. Chart-Page ~ Elect. Chart-Page ~ Elect. Chart-Page
WIRE LEGEND NO.'s COLOR 0 1 lA lAA lAB lB lCB lD IF 1M 10 10CB 10E 10H 10HA 12C 12CA 12CB 12DL 12DR 12G 12S 12HW 14F 14R 19C 19F 19S 19SA 20 20B 20C 20F 20M 20S 21R 21S 23F 23FA 23FB 28A 28B 30AF 30CL 30F 30P 30PE 30S 30T 30TE 31S 33P 33T 34F 34P 34T 36A 36C 36F 38A 38B 40 40L 40LA 40R 40RA
Black Red Red Red Red Red Red Red Red Red Black Black Black Black Black Orange Orange Orange Orange Orange Orange Orange Orange Lt. Green Lt. Green/White Red/White Red/White Red/White Red/White Black Black Black BblCk Black Black White/Lt. Green White/Lt. Green White/Black Red/Blue White/Blue Lt. Blue/Orange Lt. Blue/Orange Black Black Black Black Black Black Black Black Yellow/Lt. Blue Yellow/Green Yellow/Red Yellow/Dk. Blue Yellow/Lt. Blue Yellow/Brown Pur~le
Purple/Lt. Blue Purple Pur~le/Red
Purple/White Black Black Black Black Black
GAUGE Cable Cable 12 14 12 10 16 10 16 16 14 14 16 16 16 14 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 14 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 14 16 12 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16
WIRE LEGEND (Cont'd)
NO.'s COLOR GAUGE
41 41L 41R 42R 42RL 42RR SOA SOV 51 SIB SIS SISA SISS S6A S6L S6P S7L S7DA
Pink Pink Pink Dk. Blue/White Dk. Blue/White Dk. Blue/White Black Black Lt. Blue/White Orange/Blue Orange/White Orange/White White/Orante Dk. Green/ ellow Dk.Green/Blue Dk. Green/Red Dk. Green/Pink Yellow
PARTS LEGEND
0
•ee .,e ••e •., CO G CD CD
. e
G) G)
., Ci>
~ I€ )
e
Ei ~ ~
C)
e
G
Electrical Chart - Page 2 -
Harness Connectors Left Tail Light Left Rear Work Light Radiator Coolant Level Sender Right Rear Work Light Right Tail Light Shut·Down Relay Hydraulic Fluid Filter Differential Pressure Switch Charge Pressure Sender Hydraulic Fluid Temperature Sender Engine Coolant Temp. Sender Air Cleaner Switch Alternator Engine Oil Pressure Sender Fuel Shut·Off Solenoid Magnetic Pickup (Engine Speed) Fuel Sender Starter Fuel Pump Connector Glow Plugs Ground Battery Diverter Valve Starter Relay Glow Plug Relay Fuse • Accessory Fuse • Ignition Fused and Switch Power Fused Accessory Power System Operating Unit
16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16
AUXILIARY HYDRAULIC WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6720582)
Model 753 (SIN 11079 Thru 13487)
(Printed September 1991) 3 Of 3 Pages
se)
~=
, ,-6' J
---c::Eil
64?__e --A--------­ r - - - ­
IZI< rn[] IZI< - - - - - ­ 57RR~ ~57RR '-- 57RB----u;;:.o, f~ 57RB---___tt
8
--r--­
~ ~
570
570
S6AL - - - - - - ' !56R - - - - - - '
CIRCUITRY
S6R 1 - - ­ !56B
_- _ _ __
.i.----
----,--..~
1 ____-
56B - - - - - '
1 - - - - - 57R - - - ­
56RA---­
----56RA ~---56BA
56BA - - - ­
----570A
-
-
-
570A---­
IZ 5OB----­
ClRCUITRY-.L.---~1
CIRCUITRY
1--- S6L
-----.. !56P - - - - - . .
~~
CIRCUITRY
1]
1ZHW
56P - - - - - - '
, - - , , - S6L - - - - - '
. - - 570A----' lZS - - - - - - - ' 50A - - - - - - - - - . . . / 56A - - - - - - - - ­
Electrical Chart - Page 3 ­
8----'
o
56AL
1 ~!:iSAL
--12M~ !56R
12M
56Br:::EJ
~56R
't
!:iOB
-~~~. t
G
-----------­ -----------­
5SRA --~ 50D - - - . , .
8--..
___
56BA~ '6A~
O~ 50C ­
, ..
~~ ~ MC-1416
[Ii] Connects To [Ii] Elect. Chart-Page 2
WIRE LEGEND
NO.'s COLOR 12 12HW 12K 12M 12S SOA SOB SOC SOD SOV S6A S6AL S6B S6BA S6BB S6L S6P S6R S6RA S7D S7DA S7L S7R S7RB S7RR 64
Orange Orange Orange Orange Orange Black Black Black Black Black Dk. Green/Yellow Dk. Green Dk. Green/Red Dk. Green/Red Dk. Green/Red Lt. Green/Blue Lt. Green/Red Dk. Green/Lt. Green Dk. Green/White Yellow/Lt. Green Yellow Lt. Green/Pink Lt. Blue/Red Yellow Yellow/White Orange/Blue
PARTS LEGEND GAUGE 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 14 16 16 16
0
e e
e e
e e e
Left Steering Lever Control Harness Connectors Horn Relay Switch Box Right Steering Lever Control Harness Connector (Future Use) Auxiliary Solenoids Hydraulic Control Valve
OPERATOR CAB WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6720959)
Model 753 (SIN 13489 Thru 17641)
(Printed August 1992) 1 Of 3 Pages
tt OR~E/BLACK I­
~
~LACK
[
----..
-
1------- 60W ­ 1------- 19W ­
111~10A-----­
t
-
-
10
G ,­ ,­
-
-
-
-
r-­
r
r
- -
- -
-1 -
- - -

r
-.:or
-
,­ '.....­

o:::-J
~
N
'
I
- - S:
-J« I-JCL f'-(l) 2 N(l)
64 wire
lZC
56A
Electrical Chart Page 1 ­
19~ers:
r;-
CD
0
n
0
n
';}
(I)
';}
~
';}
(')
(I)
(')
(I)
(')
= = = = = = CD CD CD .. .. ..
0
n
~ [ji] ~
N
o
-.J
>
5:
e ..
~
r;- I
CDO
n~~
J>.
~
e--. e--.
..,.
I
~
.
~
lZHW IV
56L
56P
- - - 57L
}:­ ~
OJ
0J
0Q.~ m -
~.
OJ
0J
co
38AM
lOEM
38BM 1M
4ZFL 4ZFR
46
4ZR 41
G
~
rr=
I I
I I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
)
I
I
1
I
lOE
1ZDL
)
I
I
I
I
I I
I
I
)
I
I
I
I
I
I
J J
d
III IIIII
1ZDR
I
I
I
I
I
J
I
J
I I
38BA 38AA
lOEA
____ 1ZDB
I I
!!!!!
I I
------------------------­
GREE jWHITE ~GREE jWHITE
~
_ _ _ 19C
19L 19L
19S 19W
LI~
I
1 46L
<)-0
'-­
I
I
46R
-----tf ~.-e
40FR
46
A
46R~~W
46~~ ~
lOA~ ­ II r- 40FR 4ZFL ~~
( I
l
u
NO.'s COLOR 1M 10 lOA 10E 10EA 10M 12C 12DB 12DL 12DR 12HW 19C 19L 19S 19W 21R 38A 38AA 38AM 38B 38BA 38BM 40FR 41 42FL 42FR 42R 46 46L 46R S6A S6L S6P S7L 60H 60W 64
Red Black Black Black Black Black Orange Orange Orange Orange Orange Red/White Red/White Red/White Red/White White Purple/Red Purple/Red Purple/Red Purple/White Purple/White Pqrple/White Black Pink Dk. Blue Dk. Blue Dk. Blue/White Brown Brown Brown Dk. Green/Yellow Lt. Green/Blue Lt. Green/Red Lt. Green/Pink Black Black Orange/Blue
[A] Elect. Chart-Page 2
IJ
PARTS LEGEND
WIRE LEGEND GAUGE 16 12 12 16 18 16 16 18 16 18 18 16 16 16 16 16 18 16 16 18 18 18 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16
0
e e 8
Harness Connectors Operator Cab Ground Wiper Switch (Opt.) Wiper (Opt.)
e
Horn (Opt.)
0
Left Flasher Light (Opt.)
0 0
Left Front Light Flasher ()pt.)
e
Right Front Light
CD
Right Flasher Light (Opt.)
4D CD
Instrument Panel Display Display Back Light Auxiliary Hydraulics Control Switch
CD
Diagnostic Monitor Connector
(8
Light Switch
CO
Ignition Switch
e
Horn Connector
NOTE: Wires 60H (Black) & 64 (Orange/Blue) were added to the wire harness at the following Serial Numbers: 17270, 17277 & 17280 & Above.
Elect. Chart-Page 2
~ Elect. Chart-Page 2
Electrical Chart - Page 1 ­
ENGINE WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6720959)
Model 753 (SIN 13489 Thru 17641) (Printed August 1992) 2 Of 3 Pages
Electrical Chart - Page 2 ­
JGE
•t
o

~
0
~
l
n 1f IT ea ~jj C~~ - = = - - - IZG-~ 1f
d ....
.,.,
...
!
g!!E
..'
--
----lOt.A __ ~ lid. :;', 0 ~~.~'UH' '~_*;-q
I ~-::::,:::~ _ U ~ =---------30T:=::::::ntP... _~ -----34T
W
~
l
~I~I
#'
-=-:~-=::::otP. G) _ '=:::ot:P-0
- =: :1= --1=1:1:1:1::=
l=:Jll=I:::
-3OA

4D
---=1=1
r:
::t3J~~/REO
- - - 3Of'E-::::u:t::::D
I:~~
~3IS~
_____________ ~
~
~
PURPI.E
/3l rn
-'
~F~
lAJ
) MC-1392
Connects To [A] Elect. Chart-Pal [j] Connects to [j] Elect. Chart-Pal ~ Connects to ~ Elect. Chart-Pal ~ Connects to ~ Elect. Chart-Pal
WIRE LEGEND NO.'s COLOR GAUGE
Ie 1 Ie 1 Ie 1 le3
0 1 lA lAA lAB lB lCB lD IF 1M 10 10CB 10E 10H 10HA 12C 12CA 12CB 12DL 12DR 12G 12S 12HW 14F 14R 19C 19F 19S 19SA 20 20B 20C 20F 20M 20S 21R 21S 23F 23FA 23FB 28A 28B 30AF 30CL 30F 30P 30PE 30S 30T 30TE 31S 33P 33T 34F 34P 34T 36A 36C 36F 38A 38B 40 40L 40LA 40R 40RA
Black Red Red Red Red Red Red Red Red Red Black Black Black Black Black Orange Orange Orange Orange Orange Oranle Orange Orange Lt. Green Lt. Green/White Red/White Red/White RediWhite Red/White Black Black Blaek Black Black Black White/Lt. Green White/Lt. Green White/Black RediBlue White/Blue Lt. Blue/Orange Lt. Blue/Oranle Black Black Black Black Black Black Black Black Yellow/Lt. Blue Yellow/Green Yellow/Red Yeliow/Dk. Blue Yellow/Lt. Blue Yellow/Brown Pur~le
Purple/Lt. Blue Purple Pur~le/Red
Purple/White Black Black Black Black Black
Cable Cable 12 14 12 10 16 10 16 16 14 14 16 16 16 14 16 16 16
16 16
16
16 16
16
16 16
16
16 14
16 16 16 16 16
16 16 16
16 14
16 12 16
16 16 16
16
16 16
16 16
16
16 16
16
16 16
16
16 16
16 16
16
16 16
16
WIRE LEGEND (Cont'd) NO.'s COLOR GAUGE 41 41L 41R 42R 42RL 42RR sOA SOV 51 SIB SIS slSA slSS s6A s6L S6P s7L s7DA
•ee •ee • f)
0 G) CD
Pink Pink Pink Dk. Blue/White Dk. Blue/White Dk. Blue/White Black Black Lt. Blue/White Orange/Blue Orange/White Oranle/White white/Orante Dk. Green/ ellow Dk.Green/Blue Dk. Green/Red Dk. Green/Pink Yellow
PARTS LEGEND
Harness Connectors Left Tail Light
Left Rear Work Light Radiator Coolant Level Sender
Right Rear Work Light
Right Tail Light
Shut·Down Relay Hydraulic Fluid Filter Differential
Pressure Switch
Charge Pressure Sender
Hydraulic Fluid Temperature Sender
Engine Coolant Temp. Sender Air Cleaner Switch
Alternator
e ee
e
.,
•e G) ~
G
~ fi)
Engine Oil Pressure Sender
Fuel Shut·Off Solenoid Magnetic Pickup (Engine Speed) Fuel Sender Starter
Fuel Pump Connector
Glow Plugs Ground
Battery Diverter Valve
Starter Relay
eG
Glow Plug Relay

Fuse • Accessory
Fuse • Ignition
G
Fused Accessory Power System Operating Unit
Cf) ~ tf)
Electrical Chart - Page 2 ­
Fused and Switch Power
16
16
16
16
16
16
16
16
16
16
16
16
16
16
16
16
16
16
AUXILIARY HYDRAULIC WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6720959)
Model 753 (SIN 13489 Thru 17641) {Printed August 1992} 3 Of 3 Pages ,--
­
-
'I
I
. 0
~
--f
a:: !D a:: :xc: a::
I'­
N
U') -
I'-
U')
'<>
J:
<0
;::!
!)
6'rO
/8
e
.
then
=§IcS
-12H
~~~~: 0
g
8
!r
~
57RB 56Al 56RA 57RR 57R 12B 56BA 57DA
~
OJ
«
U')
U')
0
0
~~~ - - - - - - - - - - ,
56P - - - - - - - - ' - - - , 12HW - - - - - - - - - - -
._-
56l--~
-------- 57DA - - - - ' 12S-----' 50A - - - - - - - - - - - - ' 56/ - - - - - - ­
Electrical Chart
- Page 3 ­
(-----1
'f-'­ I
1LL)
o ·
aJ ;t --'N­ I cr:1:2l <>
G
I ~)
-56AL
-lZL~
-56R
-56B~
=:::~!
-50V~G
lo
- - - - - - - - - - - - 56RC ---~ - - - - - - - - - - - - 50D--~
'i
o o
LJ/
It I

...
I
-
'F~
56BA
4'
56A~
b---n.--­
5DC 56BB
n MC-1543
~ Connects To ~ Elect. Chart-Page
WIRE LEGEND NO.'s COLOR 12 12B 12H 12HW 12K 12L 12M 12S 50A SOB SOC SOD 50V 56A 56AL 56B 56BA 56BB 56L 56P 56R 56RA 56RC 57DA 57L 57R 57RB 57RR 64
e2
Orange Orange Orange Orange Orange Orange Orange Orange Black Black Black Black Black Dk. Green/Yeliow Dk. Green Dk. Green/Red Dk. Green/Red Dk. Green/Red Lt. Green/Blue Lt. Green/Red Dk. Green/Lt. Green Dk. Green/White Dk. Green ,..-Lt. Green Yellow Lt. Green/Pink Lt. Blue/Red Yellow Yellow/White Orange/Blue
PARTS LEGEND GAUGE 16
16 16 16
16 16
16 16
16 16 16
16 16
16
16 16 16 16
16
16 16
16 16
16
16
14
16
16
16
0
Left Steering Lever Control
e e e e
e 0 e
e
Harness Connectors
Horn Relay Switch Box Right Steering Lever Control Harness Connector (Future Use) Auxiliary Solenoids
Hydraulic Control Valve
Diode
G) Harness (PIN 6704114) (Used When Optional Rear Auxiliary Hydraulics Are Installed) NOTE: See Operator Cab Wiring
Diagram (Page 1) for serial number break for Horn wire change.
Electrical Chart - Page 3 ­
OPERATOR CAB WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6722301)
Model 753 (Star'ting With SIN 17642) (Printed August 1992) 1 Of 3 Pages

~
~LACK
[
111~tOA
t
~
- -
-
cow 19W
10
8 r-­ ~
-
-
-
r-­ r­
-
-

- - -
r
.ttl
- -'­ - -
-:tor -
r-­
-
r-­ ~
I-~<.:>a:: «<.:>cow NN-o:::lOlCOO
'''<'1
<'1­
(f)1l::i5 OlCl
a:: NO -
-~--N
Electrical Chart - Page 1 ­
''
1.0
-
~~~i15i.i5~ 1.01.0
1.01.0­
-
-4JBLI:)
'~:)81]
01 S~:)8UUO:) ~ [j] 01 sp8UUO:) [j]
-4JBLI:)
'~:)81]
00 01 S~:)8UUO:) 00
-4JBLI:)
'~:)81:3
et
~
CJ;;!2v
161~
GfD t.::::::::::.t
ZOLL <>
9v
0
eCD
16L 861
t
Lv
t
QQ
;u;u
mm mm
;U»»}>OJ
zz //
:E
:s::;ur
:s;::S::
~
CD
:E:E
II
=i=i
mm
'---1
--
- - - - - - - - - -­ - - - - - - - - -­ - - - - - - - - - -­ - - - - - - - - - -­ '­ - - - - - - -­
-
-
m

-

-­ -­

l
- -
-
-
~ ~
-­ -­ -­ -­ -­
- - - - - - -
t
e
~~r
r .t. C1>
.,
N ;u
o:E
.t. 0 ., ;u
~t 0
.
'-­
-

I~
.t. C1> ;u
-

-
0 r
-l
-

N
0
- -- -
.t.
'---­
-­ I-
l 0
(jl
»
t
e
t
0
I
.t. Ol
r
t
0
WIRE LEGEND NO.'s COLOR 1M 10 lOA 10E 10EA 10M 12C 12DB 12DL 12DR 12HW 19C 19L 19S 19W 21R 38A 38AA 38AM 38B 38BA 38BM 40FR 41 42FL 42FR 42R 46 46L 46R S6A S6L S6P S7L 60H 60W 64
Red Black Black Black Black Black Orange Orange Orange Orange Orange Red/White Red/White Red/White Red/White White Purple/Red Purple/Red Purple/Red Purple/White Purple/White Purple/White Black Pink Dk. Blue Dk. Blue Dk. Blue/White Brown Brown Brown Dk. Green/Yellow Lt. Green/Blue Lt. Green/Red Lt. Green/Pink Black Black Orange/Blue
PARTS LEGEND GAUGE 16 12 12 16
18 16
16 18
16 18 18
16 16 16 16 16 18 16 16 18 18 18 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16
0
e
e e
e e
e e
G CO
-e 8
e e 8
e
Page2 Page2 Page2
Electrical Chart - Page 1 ­
Harness Connectors Operator Cab Ground Wiper Switch (Opt.) Wiper (Opt.)
Horn (Opt.)
Left Flasher Light (Opt.) Left Front Light Flasher (Opt.)
Right Front Light Right Flasher Light (Opt.) Instrument Panel Display Display Back Light Auxiliary Hydraulics Control Switch Diagnostic Monitor Connector Light Switch Ignition Switch Horn Connector
ENGINE WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6722301)
Model 753 (Starting With SIN 17642) (Printed August 1992) 2 Of 3 Pages
I~::·=-o.(u.e
~
~~~~~~~2
~lD
----,.
iF - - ,
;:,
'---1,.,6----,.
.-[~~r----~-~ Electrical Chart - Page 2 ­
0 + ~
8
f)
i
-' IS! ~~
0 ~
!
!
n fi
t 11 ' ' ~fO
0
...
~311J j~
e~O
12G­
,..1 1
20M
=I
518
23FA
~
CD
~(Qu.~r:i.g:''~t-t-Q.o.u.Vl O-lDOnOnO'fO'fO'q'O
0
!')tJ')(I')~(I')nnnt'){'}t'1t'1l'1n
@'­
=(-']
=n '-~ -- - - - - - -~=I--_-_ --
-1-----vvv--~ -
i
-
I .
~1
' U ::::m::J::>
''---.
o
JOP 3AP
34T
-
'':::::::iJlP __• 33T
-I
30AF~ .......
'
4D
- -1- - - - - - - ;
D1-1-1-1
~
-~
I
ED
l L-.:t_·__ ·-l­ ~ iii ---1­
1
33P
-1­
14R
_
18
- ,--0---1 -
---1­
1
I =1
-.-
~-l=:::
A
3OPE~.
1
-_
=
14F
W :::c:E:I ~RPLE/RED PiJRPlE
_ _ _ __
~~ ?JJ
CD
~
n=1 [}
23FA
Me-1687 -, IS
::::IlJ [Q::=:::iEJ
~
---_ - -_ - '_ ' ' _:::::(J:J=Di~ '-
-tD
t
e
.
4D
[A] Connects To [A] Elect. Chart-Pi [j] Connects to [j] Elect. Chart-Pi
~ Connects to ~ Elect. Chart-Pi ~ Connects to ~ Elect. Chart-Pi
~ge 1 ~ge
1 Jage 1 rage 3
WIRE LEGEND NO.'. COLOR GAUGE
WIRE LEGEND (Cont'd)
NO.'. COLOR GAUGE
0 1 lA lAA lAB lB lCB 10 IF 1M IT 10 10CB 10E 10H 10HA 12B '12C 12CA 12CB 120L 120R 12G 125 12HW 14F 14R 19C 19F 195 19SA 20 20B 20C 20F 20M 205 21R 215 23F
23FA 23FB 28A 28B 30AF ~OCL 30F 30P 30PE 305 30T 30TE 315 33P 33T 34F 34P 34T 36A 36C 36F 38A 38B 40 40L 40LA 40R 40RA 41
41L 41R 42R 42RL 42RR 50A 50V 51 51B 515 51SA 5155 56A 56L 56P 57L 570A 66
Black Red Red Red Red Red Red Red Red Red Red Black Black Black Black Black Orange Oranle Orange Orange Oranle Orange Orange Oranle Orange Lt. Green Lt. Green/White Red/White Red/White Red/White RedlWhlte Black lack Black Black Black Black White/Lt. Green White/Lt. Green White/Black Red/Blue WhitelBlue Lt. BluelOrange Lt. Blue/Orange Black Black Black Black Black Black Black Black Yellow/Lt. Blue Yellow/Green Yellow/Red Yellow/Ok. Blue Yellow/Lt. Blue Yenow/Brown Purple/Red Pur~le/Lt. Blue Purple Purple/Red Pur~le/White
Black Black Black Black Black Pink
Cable Cable 12 14 12 10 16 14 12 16 14 14 14 16 16 16 16 14 16 16 16 16
16 16 16 16 16 16 12 14
14 14 16 16
16 16 16 16 14 16 16 14 16 12 16 16 16
16 16 16 16
16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16
16 16 16 16 16 16 Electrical Chart - Page 2 ­
•• •• •• •• • • CD
(8 I)
CD 48 CD CD CD
• •• • e .•., ., •.,., . I>
I)
8)
G
Pink Pink Ok. Blue/White Ok. Blue/White Ok. Blue/White Black Black Lt. Blue/White Oranle/Blue Orange/White Orange/White White/Oranle Ok. Green/Yellow Ok.Green/Blue Ok. Green/Red Ok. Green/Pink Yellow Oranle/Green
PARTS LEGEND Harness Connectors Left Tail Light
Left Rear Work Light Back·Up Alarm (Opt.) Right Rear Work Light Right Tail Light
Radiator Coolant Level Sender Shut·Down Relay Resistor
Charge Pressure Sender Hydraulic Fluid Filter Differential Pressure Switch Hydraulic Fluid Temperature Sender Engine Coolant Temp. Sender Air Cleaner Switch
Alternator Fuel Shut·Off Solenoid Fuel Timer Module (Starting Wtih SIN 17946)
Fuel Sender Magnetic Pickup (Engine Speed) Engine 011 Pressure Sender Diode
Starter Fuel Pump Connector Glow Plugs Ground Battery Diverter Valve Starter Relay
Glow Plug Relay Fuse • Ignition Fuse • Accessory Back·Up Alarm Connector Fused and Switch Power Fused Accessory Power System Operating Unit
16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16
AUXILIARY HYDRAULIC WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6722301)
Model 753 (Starting With SIN 17642) (Printed August 1992) 3 Of 3 Pages
,r-­ l
64---1
Vhen ----------tics ......--1'---12H - - - - - - ­ - _ . . 57RR------~
~57RB-~-~----.. 12K 'L ____ _
I
-e
~-/

-
-1­
57RB
56Al ­ ~
t----.-_ _
J
56RA ­ 57RR - - - - - '
57R - - ­
CD
o
If'l
« 0
If'l
12B--­ 55BA - - - - - - - - ­
57DA - - - - - - - - - ,
D€
~~~ -=--=-=-=--=--=,­ -----'
56P - - - - - - - ­ 12HW --------~
50A - - - ' - - - - - - - '
Electrical Chart
- Page 3 ­
56A
---~-~---
-., I
(' I
j « .lD 0
-I-+ttJI. .
..JI N _
o:.lZl1D <>
~
-56AL~ -l2.L~
~
-56R~ 568
12M
,
I
-57R~. -50V~
t o - - - - - - - - - - - - 56RC
---~
- - - - - - - - - - - - 50D ------.
'1
(,)
o
lD
.~
o
IWr~~
)
Me-1698
,
000.
~
56BB~ 50C
~ Connects To [~ Elect. Chart-Page 2
WIRE LEGEND NO.'s
COLOR
12 12B 12H 12HW 12K 12L 12M 12S 50A SOB SOC SOD 50V 56A 56AL 56B 56BA 56BB 56L 56P 56R 56RA 56RC 57DA 57L 57R 57RB 57RR 64
Orange Orange Orange Orange Orange Orange Orange Orange Black Black Black Black Black Dk. Green/Yeliow Dk. Green Dk. Green/Red Dk. Green/Red Dk. Green/Red Lt. Green/Blue Lt. Green/Red Dk. Green/Lt. Green Dk. Green/White Dk. Green/Lt. Green Yellow Lt. Green/Pink Lt. Blue/Red Yellow Yellow/White Orange/Blue
PARTS LEGEND GAUGE 16
16 16
16
16 16
16 16
16
16 16
16 16
16
16
16 16 16
16
16
16
16
16
16
16
14
16
16
16
0
Left Steering Lever Control
e
Harness Connectors
e e 8
e e
8 CD CO
Horn Connector Relay Switch Box
Right Steering Lever Control
Harness Connector (Future Use) Auxiliary Solenoids
Hydraulic Control Valve
Diode
Harness (PIN 6704114) (Used When Optional Rear Auxiliary Hydraulics Are Installed)
Electrical Chart - Page 3 ­
OPERATOR CAB WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6722827) Model 753 (SIN 511525001 Thru 511525540) Model 753H (SIN 511011001 Thru '511911006) (Printed November 1993) 1 Of 4 Pages
o ~
G)
~ r
~
2
L
-
-
1­ 1­ '­
-
:1
~
-
. . .1 ­
~
,---­

- ­ -1- ; ­

- - -i-
-

.

- .

J:

-
r--­
,-­
un::<{cnw
'q'-Vt'l')t'!')­
U O'l
-
~~~~
-
l~ ~ [AJ
[IJ
o
1 t
e
I.r
-
-1­

---
-

..
1-­
1­ I­
1-­

~ ~' 1
~~ ~ ~ ~~~~~-
I.O-Ifl-t')lf')
~N
~~
r-­
-
. -1­
-' <{:t;0--' o<{ r-:::i:<><><>
-
-
-i- I­
-NN«)<>
- ­ 1­
'
-
-
-t­
----~~~~''
~--~

r
-





'-­

c
-' . ­
-
1--< 1-­

~'
Iljl
It/
CD
~'
ZIR
u
e
19S
56A
Ignition Switch
Electrical Chart - Page 1 ­
C
o t
o
o
!
~
o ~
_'r ''''
y
'1'....
II
I
e: !:e:
N
00
~ :;: '
w
er
---1ICL---1
CON COr­
----l-
l()-LC)lO
---------- eJ -----------
I
OR-4 Nc, Bt. f>e
-4C'.~-4C'.
ww
erer ClCl
.-0
m<><>
-----7 I I
---I I
I
/
I
/
I I
46
19C
1M
.. ,I
0
388M
42FL
19W
42FR
Light Switch Diagnostic Monitor
Coupler
Me-1877
[A] Connects To [A] Elect. Chart-Page 2 [j] Connects To [j] Elect. Chart-Page 2
[g Connects To [g Elect. Chart-Page 2
WIRE LEGEND NO.'s COLOR 1M 10 lOA 10E 10EA 10M 12C 12DB 12DL 12DR 12HW 19C 19L 19S 19W 21R 38A 38AA 38AM 38B 38BA 38BM 40FR 41 42FL 42FR 42R 46 46L 46R S6A S6L S6P S7L 60H 60W 64
Red Black Black Black Black Black Orange Orange Orange Orange Orange Red/White Red/White Red/White Red/White White Purple/Red Purple/Red Purple/Red Purple/White Purple/White Purple/White Black Pink Dk. Blue Dk. Blue Dk. Blue/White Brown Brown Brown Dk. Green/Yellow Dk. Green/Blue Lt. Green/Red Lt. Green/Pink Black Black Orange/Blue
PARTS LEGEND GAUGE 16 10 12 16 18 16 14 18 16 18 18 16 16 16 16 16 18 16 16 18 18 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16
0
e e e e e 0
e
e
Harness Connectors Operator Cab Ground Wiper Switch (Opt.) Wiper (Opt.)
Left Lasher Light (Opt.) Left Front Light Flasher Right Front Light Right Flasher Light (Opt.)
8
Instrument Panel Display
4D
Display Back Light
e e CD e CO e e
Electrical Chart - Page 1 ­
Auxiliary Hydraulics Control Switch Diagnostic Monitor Connector Light Switch Ignition Switch Horn (Opt.) Frame Ground Horn Connector
ENGINE WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6722827)
UGE
Model 753 (SIN 511525001 Thru 511525540) Model 753H (SIN 511011001 Thru 511011006) (Printed November 1993) 2 Of 4 Pages
i
r
-~-
~R
I
I
Electrical Chart - Page 2 ­
1
_f~~M~ ,_J T1 i
'~
~
.._ :
r.l---,. •
:1
I,
.-4()RA
41R'
0--.
p~ !
/'
Z3FA - - - - - - - - - - - '
.,!!l
~ 1''-41
.
30AF
I
ill,
-~.-.~-.-e -®-® -+-ta
~
'jI't,---.,.J
~a e .,
!
::::::E1:l :!::: ----------~-------1B--------------------~______~ 14F 14R
~ ~;vr~· MC-1876
00
Connects To 00 Elect. Chart-Page 1 [IJ Connects to [B.l Elect. Chart-Page 1 ~ Connects to ~ Elect. Chart-Page 1 ~ Connects to ~ Elect. Chart-Page 3
WIRE LEGEND NO.'s COLOR 0 1 lA lAA lAB lB lCB lD IF 1M IT 10 10CB 10E 10H 10HA 12B 12C 12CA 12CB 12DL 12DR 12G 12HW 12S 14F 14R 19C 19F 19S 19SA 20 20A 20B 20C 20F 20M 205 21R 215 23F 23F 23FA 23FP 28A 28B 30AF 30CL 30F 30P 30PE 305 30T 30TE 315 33P 33T 34F 34P 34PA 34T 36A 36C 36F 38A 38B
Black Red Red Red Red Red Red Red Red Red Red Black Black Black Black Black Orange Oranle Orange Orange Oranle Orange Orange Orange Orange Lt. Green Lt. Green/White Red/White Red/White Red/White Red/White Black Black Black Black Black Black Black White White/Lt. Green White/Black (Harness) Red/Blue (Timer Module) Red/Blue White/Blue Lt. Blue/Oranle Lt. Blue/Orange Black Black Black Black Black Black Black Black Yellow/Lt. Blue Yellow/Green Yellow/Red Yellow/Dk. Blue Yellow/Lt. Blue Lt. Blue Yellow/Brown Purple Purl!lefLt. Blue Purple Purple/Red Purl!le/White
GAUGE Cable Cable 12 14 12 10 16 14 12 16 14 14 14 16 16 16 16 14 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 12 14 14 14 14 16 16 16 16 16 16 14 16 16 16 14 16 12 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16
WIRE LEGEND (Cont'd)
NO.'s COLOR GAUGE
40 41 42R 50A SOY 51 SIB SIS 51SA 5155 56A 56L 56P 57DA 57L 66
Black Pink Dk. BluefWhite Black Black Lt. BluefWhite Orange/Blue OrangefWhite OranlefWhite WhitelOran«e Dk. Green/ ellow Dk. GreenfBlue Dk. Green/Red Yellow Dk. Green/Pink Orange/Green
•• •• ••., •., •• ••., • •• • ••• •. •., .,.,
PARTS LEGEND
CD
(;>
fa
8)
I>
Harness Connectors Left Tail Light Left Rear Work Light Radiator Coolant Level Sender Right Rear Work Light Right Tail Light Shut-Down Relay Hydraulic Filter Differential Pressure Sensor Back-up Alarm (Opt.) System Operating Unit Hydraulic Charge Pressure Sensor Hydraulic Fluid Temperature Sensor Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor Air Cleaner Switch Alternator Engine Oil Pressure Sender Fuel Shut·Off Solenoid Magnetic Pickup (Engine RPM) Fuel Sensor Starter Fuel Pump Connector Glow Plugs Ground Battery Starter Relay Glow Plug Relay Fuse 25 Amp. • Ignition Fuse 25 Amp. • Accessory Fused and Switched Power Fused Accessory Power Back-Up Alarm Connector Diverter Valve Fuel Shut·Off Solenoid Timer Module
Electrical Chart - Page 2 -
16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16
AUXILIARY HYD. WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6722827) Model 753 (SIN 511350001 Thru 511350882) Model 753 (SIN 511525001 Thru 511525540) Model 753H (SIN 511011001 Thru 511011006) (Printed November 1993) 3 Of 4 Pages
~-12M------~
--56B------~
,----56R
-----~
s
[[tors
-liary
56BA­ - ­ 57RR­ 57RB­ -~ 1_-56RA--­ 1----57DA- _~ 57R--­ 126--­ 56AL­ _ _
~
~~~W_ _ _ __ 56L-----­ 57L-----­

12 -0 ---­ 5 6 ---­
56A 12S
12HW
t e
>
C
tC
[D1
56L 56P 57L 57DA 50A
Electrical Chart - Page 3 ­
-56BA ­ -56A­
ll::j -0 --56AL
~
- - 12L-----~ 56R----~
568 - - - - - - - 1 --12M
,/
~56AL
~12L----------------------,
~ ------
56T
56B-----------------~
12M
--------------~
I
- - - - - - 50D - - - - - - - - - - ,
1.-• •
---------56RC-----------~
.
~
'1'­ '1.(')
,
, tmJ'
'
iJl-ttf
r{) I.(')
I
I
1l 0 ~
ID I.(')Nr{)
_
I
11'1
J

~
------------------50C------------­ • 568B - - - - - - - - - ­
MC-1833
~ Connects To [~ Elect. Chart-Page 2
[EJ Connects To [EJ Elect. Chart-Page 3 & 4
~ Connects To [H] Elect. Chart-Page 3 & 4
WIRE LEGEND
NO.'s COLOR 12 12B 12H 12HW 12K 12L 12M 12S sOA SOB SOC SOD SOV s6A s6AL s6B s6BA s6BB s6L S6P s6R s6RA s6RC s7DA s7L s7R s7RB s7RR 64
Orange Orange Orange Orange Orange Orange Orange Orange Black Black Black Black Black Dk. Green/Yelow Dk. Green Dk. Green/Red Dk. Green/Red Dk. Green/Red Lt. Green/Blue Lt. Green/Red Dk•.Green/Lt. Green Dk. Green/Lt. Green Dk. Green/Lt. Green Yellow Lt. Green/Pink Lt. Blue/Red Yellow Yellow/White Orange/Blue
PARTS LEGEND GAUGE 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16
0
e
e e e e
Left Steering Lever Control Right Steering Lever Control Auxiliary Control Moldule Horn Connector Hydraulic Control Valve Left Handle Controls Connectors (Hi Flow)
0
Control Valve Base End Connectors (Hi Flow)
e
High Pressure Relief Valve
CD CO
-e
Front Auxiliary Solenoid (Base) Front Auxiliary Solenoid (Rod) Connector (Not Used) Harness (PIN 6704114) (Used When Optional Rear Auxiliary Hydraulics Are Installed)
Electrical Chart - Page 3 ­
HIGH FLOW WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6722827)
Model 753H (SIN 511011001 Thru 511011006) (Printed November 1993) 4 Of 4 Pages
wll­ O/'­ '(Hil
r--57RR­
~ '
~57RRA-
..- - - - ,
57RR8~
-----+::57RB­ 57RBA­
~
~-57RBB-
-
57RRB
Electrical Chart - Page 4 ­
~
al8d-,Jtrll:l ·,3a I:3
~
0.1 S'~9UU0:l [II]
~
al8d-,Jtrll:l ·,3913
00
0.1 S,3auUO:l
~
--------
, I
,
___ 1 _ _ _ _ _
,
,
,
,-
L ____ _
-------
,
,
I
I I
~
~
WIRE LEGEND NO.'s COLOR 12K SOC SOD SOE SOF SOG SOH S6B S6BA S7F S7RB S7RBA S7RBB S7RR S7RRA S7RRB
Orange Black Black Black Black Black Black Dk. Green/Red Dk. Green/Red Lt. Blue/Red White/Yellow White/Yellow Yellow Brown Brown Brown
PARTS LEGEND GAUGE 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16
0
e e e
e
e G
Hi Flow On/Off Switch Auxiliary Control Harness Connectors Diodes Hi Flow Solenoid Diverter Solenoid Rear/Secondary Front Auxiliary Solenoid (Base) Rear/Secondary Front Auxiliary Solenoid (Rod)
3
3
Electrical Chart
- Page 4 ­
OPERATOR CAB WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6722831) Model 753 (SIN 511350001 Thru 511350882)
JGE
(Printed November 1993) 1 Of 2 Pages
16 16 16
016 16 16 16
e 0 G l t
f ' - -.
.I
.y ·~·'·'r'··''·' '1
I ~~ ~:J.--w ~ Q I
t
'<

~G)
49 l~n0
A ' W 19C~19L ~
ZIR
41
46
I
2SA 12C I~
B
19We 19F
19S 19G
42FR
ST
56A
42FL
light Switch
Electrical Chart - Page 1 ­
Ignition Switch
3'
4D
-+-10
~
i
o
G
I
I
~9
.1
I
'Ii I' 11~~ Il11
-
,.II.
i
p
~:z;
I I

,--­
r-
1
I
----------------ltiI1nnrrlttttrrrrrmJln' ----~-~~ ~=III VIii! ~~~~~~!~~~§~~~~~~E~~5!~~S~
II!I
A~A .... ... ) e w . , . ..A'. A W Un .4-;-W
91
~ ~ 9V
12T
n
I~
S
I
G
t2L
49f
30T
30
30.
I
G
Temp. Gauge
12V
36
S
50W
I
tZV
.
12F
G
+
30T
121
30G
Fuel Gauge
Voltmeter
MC-1704
[A] Connects To [A] Elect. Chart-Page 2 [BJ Connects To [BJ Elect. Chart-Page 2 ~ Connects To ~ Elect. Chart-Page 2
WIRE LEGEND NO.'s
COLOR
lD IF lOA lOB 12A 12C 12F 12HW 12L 12T 12V 19C 19F 19G 19H 19L 19S 19W 21R 21RM 23F 26A 28 30 30G 30T 31 31P 32 32F 3SH 36 36T 40FL 40FR 41 42FL 42FR 42R 46 46L 46R 49F 49T 49V
Red Red Black Black Orange Orange Orange Orange Orange Orange Orange Red/White Red/White Red/White Red/White Red/White Red/White Red/White White White White/Black Lt. Blue/Green Lt. Blue/Black Black Black Black Yellow/Green Yellow/Green Yellow/Dk. Blue Yellow/Dk. Blue Yellow/Brown Purple Purple/White Black Black Pink Dk. Blue Dk. Blue Dk. Blue/White Brown Brown Brown Gray Gray Gray
WIRE LEGEND (Cont'd) GAUGE 12 14 12 16 16 14 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 14 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16
NO.'s COLOR S6A S6L S6P S7L 60H 60W 64
GAUGE
Dk. GreenlYeliow Lt. Green/Blue Lt. Green/Red Lt. GreenlPink Black Black Orange/Blue
PARTS LEGEND
e
--e 0
e e 0
0
e
CO
G 8'
e e e
e e(I) e e e
efJ) e
Harness Connectors Operator Cab Ground Auxiliary Hydraulics Connector Left Flasher Light (Opt.) Left Front Light (Opt.) Flasher Right Front Light (Opt.) Right Flasher Light (Opt.) Shutdown Module (Opt.) Wiper Switch (Opt.) Wiper (Opt.) Ignition Switch Light Switch Glow Plug Pre-Heat Button Ignition Fuse Accessory Fuse Hornmeter Fuel Gauge Temperature Gauge Voltmeter Engine Warning Lamp Transmission Warning Lamp Horn Connector Horn (Opt.)
16 16 16 16 16 16 16
ENGINE WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6722831)
Model 753 (SIN 511350001 Thru 511350882)
(Printed November 1993) 2 Of 2 Pages
I~ii:;
• i'';
L
c:
~ ~ .-~ ~-
I
~tI
L:4i
40 41 4ZR
m
Ii'
OPEtI
~IR
:If I~
I
'~I
~$~~
';u.r
_NNN
~~p ~tI
<.,IE:g -(.INN
I
~
:~.
1J lQE::
Z3l' IT 20
!r~
!t~
288-,
~tI
c:::::::::;r- 19C
e
~36T
~
~12CA
witch
~.-
....Jl:=:IZB
e
60
c(}::=::=~eA liP' I
3Of-
36F-
ROOOCJrR + - !
'-IT
-Ig loW IA I
ZIS •
-..-.
~lrW
~tn
Q
er
l~witch
Electrical Chal - Page 2 ­

•••
~------------~ -------------------l-------------I----f -----1-_____, f
I
40R
::::::::t:::~~::::::=:~~::::::~~~~A------~ 41R - - - - - - - - ­
:
--------------------------------------------------------------~
-0 /A
g.•
• ' ,1'­
,

-,
jL~ ---0-®--0-0 .
-
~
/v
r~'

-e
------------------------IB-------------------------4
~.
.-e
e-e Me-1895
[A] Connects To [A] Elect. Chart-Page 1 [II Connects To [II Elect. Chart-Page 1
~ Connects To ~ Elect. Chart-Page 1 ,t
~ Connects To ~ Elect. Chart (PIN 6722827) Page
WIRE LEGEND NO.'s COLOR lA lAA lB lD IT 10 12B 12C 12CA 12HW 12S 14F 14R 19C 20 20A 20S 21R 21S 23F 23F 23FA 23FP 28 28B 30F 31P 32F 32P 32T 3SH 36F 36T 40 41 42R SOA SOV S6A S6L S6P S7DA S7L 66
e3
PARTS LEGEND GAUGE
Red Red Red Red Red Black Orange Orange Orange Orange Orange Lt. Green Lt. Green/White Red/White Black Black Black White White/Lt. Green White/Black (Harness Side) Red/Blue (Module Side) Red/Blue White/Blue Lt. Blue/Black Lt. Blue/Orange Black Yellow/Green Yellow/Dk. Blue Yellow Yellow/Black Yellow/Brown Purple Purple/White Black Pink Dk. Blue/White Black Black Dk. Green/Yellow Lt. Green/Blue Lt. Green/Red Yellow Lt. Green/Pink Orange/Green
12 14 10 12 14 14 16 14 16 16 16 16 16 16 14 16 16 16 14 16 16 16 14 16 12 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16
e
Harness Connectors
8
Left Tail Light (Opt.)
0 0
Left Rear Work Light (Opt.)
e e 0
e e
Right Rear Work Light (Opt.) Right Tall Light (Opt.) Back-Up Alarm (Opt.) Starter Relay Glow Plug Relay Fused and Switch Power
G
Fused Accessory Power
G
Glow Plugs
8
Ground
4D CD CD
Battery
e 4D e G)
e e
fa)
e
e
Electrical Chart . Page 2 .
Fuel Sender Engine Oil Pressure Sender Fuel Shut·Off Solenoid Hydraulic Charge Pressure Switch Hydraulic Fluid Temperature Switch Engine Coolant Temperature Sender Starter Alternator Back-Up Alarm Connector Fuel Shut-Off Solenoid Timer Module Hydraulic Filter Pressure Switch Diverter Valve
WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6722195)
BUCKET POSITION VALVE LOCKOUT (OPTIONAL)
Model 753, 7753, 843, 843B & 853
(Printed April 1992)
O--'.L
MC-1450 MC-1118
WIRE LEGEND WIRE NO.
COLOR
12S·A
Orange
12S·B 59E·A 59E·B 50·A 50·B
Orange Orange Orange Black Black
CONNECTS TO Loader Wiring Harness Fused & Switched Power Switch Switch Solenoid Solenoid Ground
PARTS LEGEND
o e e e e •

Switch Cover Switch Solenoid Terminal Connector Bucket Position Valve Wiring Harness
6 ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
A WARNING
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM INFORMATION Description
Instructions are necessary before operating or servicing machine. Read Operation & Maintenance Manual, Handbook and signs (decals) on machine. Follow warnings and instructions in the manuals when making repairs, adjustments or servicing. Check for correct function after adjustments, repairs or service. Failure to follow instructions can cause injury or death.
The loader has a 12 volt, negative ground electrical system. There are two main circuits. 1. The charging circuit has an alternator (with built-in regulator) and a battery. 2. The starting circuit has glow plugs, starter motor and solenoid for starting the engine.
W-2003-0797
Optional equipment for the loader are windshield wiper, horn and back-up alarm. SIN 11078 & Below: The electrical system is protected by two fuses in the instrument panel. SIN 11079 & Above: The electrical system is protected by two fuses in the wiring harness [A]. Fuses protect the electrical system from an overload.
TROUBLESHOOTING
The following troubleshooting chart is provided for assistance in locating and correcting problems which are most common. Many of the recommended procedures must be done by authorized Bobcat Service Personnel only.
PROBLEM
CAUSE
Battery will not take a charge
1,2,3,4,5
Alternator will not charge.
1,2,5
Starter will not turn the engine.
2,3,4,5,6,7,8,9
KEY TO CORRECT THE CAUSE
1. Alternator belt is loose or damaged. 2. Battery connections are dirty or loose. 3. Battery is damaged. 4. The ground connection is not making a good contact. 5. The alternator is damaged. 6. The engine is locked. 7. The starter is damaged. 8. The wiring or the solenoid is damaged. 9. Check the fuses.
-6-1­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
BATTERY Removal and Installation
A WARNING
Batteries contain acid which burns eyes and skin on contact. Wear goggles, protective clothing and rubber gloves to keep acid off body. In case of acid contact, wash immediately with water. In case of eye contact get prompt medical attention and wash eye with clean, cool water for at least 15 minutes. If electrolyte is taken internally drink large quantities of water or milk! DO NOT induce vomiting. Get prompt medical attention. W-2065-1296
Open the rear door.
Disconnect the negative (-) battery cable [A].
Disconnect the positive (+) cable (Item 1) [B).
Remove the nuts from the holddown clamp [C].
Remove the holddown clamp.
Remove the battery from the loader [0].
A WARNING
Keep arcs, sparks, flames and lighted tobacco away from batteries. When jumping from booster battery make final connection (negative) at engine frame. Do not jump start or charge a frozen or damaged battery. Warm battery to 60°F. (16°C.) before connecting to a charger. Unplug charger before connecting or disconnecting cables to battery. Never lean over battery while boosting, testing or charging. Battery gas can explode and cause serious injury.
W-2066-1296
-6-2-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
ALTERNATOR
Checking the Alternator Output (Old Style)
A
REAR VIEW OF ALTERNATOR OLD 6632211
A WARNING
Put jackstands under the front axles and rear corners of the frame before running the engine for service. Failure to use jackstands can allow the machine to faU or move and cause injury or death.
W-2017-0286
Lift and block the loader (Page 1-2).
MC-01813
B
Disconnect the negative (-) cable from the battery.
Disconnect the orange wire (Item 1) from the alternator.
Connect the wire to the negative (-) side of the ammeter.
Connect the positive (+) side of the ammeter to the output
terminal on the alternator (Item 2).
Close the fuel shut-off valve.
Connect the negative (-) cable to the battery.
Turn on the lights and crank the engine for 30 seconds to
discharge the battery.
Open the fuel shut-off valve.
Start the engine and run at 2600 RPM.
The ammeter reading should be between 45 & 55 amps.
@ 2600 RPM.
8-09570
If the reading is low, remove the screws and pull the
regulator cover away from the alternator.
Disconnect the battery and connect a jumper wire from the alternator output terminal (Item 1) [A] to the regulator terminal (Item 2). Connect the battery cable, start the engine and check the ammeter. If the reading is within the rated amperage (45-55 amps. @ 2600 RPM) replace the diode trio.
Revised Sept. 93
750 Series Loader Serv'ce Manual
ALTERNATOR (Cont'd) Checking the Alternator Regulator (Old Style)
A
Connect the positive (+) voltmeter lead to the positive (+) battery terminal and connect the negative (-) voltmeter lead to the negative (-) terminal [A].
A WARNING
Put jackstands under the front axles and rear corners of the frame before running the engine for service. Failure to use jackstands can allow the machine to fall or move and cause injury or death.
W-2017-{)286
A WARNING
8-03710 8-08068
B
When an engine is running in an enclosed area, fresh air must be added to avoid concentration of exhaust fumes. If the engine is stationary, vent the exhaust outside. Exhaust fumes contain odorless, invisible gases which can kill without warning. W-20SG-128S
Start and run the engine at 1500-2000 RPM. The voltmeter reading should be between 13.9-14.7 volts [A]. If the reading is low, stop the engine and disconnect the battery. 8-09569
Remove the screws and pull the regulator cover away from the alternator. Connect the jumper wire from the ground stud (Item 1) to the brush terminal (Item 2) (the tan wire) [8]. Connect the battery and start the engine. Run at 1500 RPM. DO NOT allow the meter to exceed 16 volts. If the reading is 14.5 or above, replace the regulator. If the reading is 14.5 or below, repair or replace the alternator.
Revised Sept. 93
750 Series Loader Service Manual
ALTERNATOR Test the New Style alternator as follows: a. Alternator Output Test b. Rectifier (Diode) Test c. Alternator Regulator Test
A
REAR VIEW OF ALTERNATOR OLD 6661611
Alternator Output Test (New Style)
A WARNING
Put jackstands under the front axles and rear corners of the frame before running the engine for service. Failure to use jackstands can allow the machine to fall or move and cause injury or death.
MC-01813
W-2017~286
Lift and block the loader (Page 1-2).
Disconnect the negative (-) cable from the battery.
Disconnect the red wire (Item 1) from the alternator.
Connect that wire to the negative (-) side of the ammeter
[8).
Connect the positive (+) side of the ammeter to the output
terminal on the alternator (Item 2) [8].
Disconnect the fuel stop solenoid connector.
Connect the negative (-) cable to the battery.
Turn on the lights and crank the engine for 30 seconds to
discharge the battery.
Connect the fuel stop solenoid, start the engine and run
at 2600 RPM.
The ammeter reading should be between 45 & 55 amps.
@ 2600 RPM.
If the reading is low, remove the screws and pull the
regulator cover away from the alternator.
Rectifier (Diode) Test (New Style)
The alternator is removed from the loader for clarity
purposes [C].
Disconnect the negative (-) cable from the battery.
Install the wires in their original location on the back of the
alternator.
Connect a jumper wire (Item 1) to the alternator output
terminal and the regulator terminal [C).
Connect the battery negative (-) cable.
Start the engine and run at 2600 RPM.
If the reading is within 45-55 AMPS at 2600 RPM replace
the rectifier (diode) assembly or replace the alternator.
If the reading is low, do the Alternator Regulator Test.
Revised Sept. 93
750 Series Loader
Service Manual
ALTERNATOR (Cont'd)
Alternator Regulator Test (New Style)
A WARNING
When an engine is running in an enclosed area, fresh air must be added to avoid concentration of exhaust fumes. ' the engine is stationary, vent the exhaust outside. Exhaust fumes contain odorless, invisible gases which can kill without warning. W-2OS6-1285
Connect the positive (+) voltmeter lead to the positive (+) battery terminal [A].
Connect the negative (-) voltmeter lead to the negative
(-) battery terminal [A].
Start the engine and run at 1500-2000 RPM.
The voltmeter should read between 13.9-14.7 volts.
If the reading is low stop the engine and disconnect the
battery negative (-) cable.
The alternator is removed from the loader for clarity
purposes [B].
Remove the wires from the back of the alternator.
Remove the regulator cover from the back of the
alternator.
Install the wires on the back of the alternator.
Connect a jumper wire (Item 1) from the brush terminal to
the ground stud [B].
Connect the negative (-) battery cable and start the
engine. Run at 1500 RPM.
If the voltmeter reading is 14.5 or above replace the
regulator.
Ifthe voltmeter reading is below 14.5, repair or replace the
alternator.
Revised Sept. 93
750 Series Loader Service Manual
ALTERNATOR
Removal and Installation (Old Style)
IMPORTANT
Damage to the alternator can occur if: • Engine is operated with battery cables disconnected. • Battery cables are connected when using a fast charger or when welding on the loader. (Remove both cables from the battery.) • Extra battery cables (booster cables) are connected wrong. 1-2023-1285
Raise the operator cab (Page 1-5).
Open the rear door.
Disconnect the negative (-) battery cable.
Disconnect the orange lead from the alternator [A].
Disconnect the wire harness connectors [B].
Remove the adjustment bolt [C].
Remove the alternator belt from the alternator pulley.
Installation: Move the alternator until the belt has 5116' (8,0 mm) movement at the middle of the belt span with 15 Ibs. (66 N) of force.
Remove the mounting bolt [0].
Remove the alternator from the mounting bracket.
Revised Sept. 93
-6-7­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
ALTERNATOR (Cont'd)
A
Disassembly (Old Style)
~.,0~--1
1
~,~e-(t~-
Disassemble the alternator as shown in figure [A].
I 2
Remove the three bolts (Item 4) holding halves tog ther [A]. Pry the halves apart. Use a soft jaw vise to hold the otor while removing the pulley nut (Item 1) [A].
I
5
~
I,
.'. •
L..--­
Assemble: lighten the nut on the altemator shaft t 50 ft.-Ibs. (68 Nm) torque.
---­
,~,_/J 9 6 I
-----------'-­ i ~.I ft 7'
r ~. ~I ----­
I
I
6
~ ~ ~ ......'.-_... -'
8
_--­
,
',_.-'
r,
Remove the front case half (Item 5) from the rotor u ing a plastic hammer or press [A].
!:
Melt the solder holdin~ the stator wires to the rectifi r to test the stator and rectIfier. Use a needle nose plier t aid in removal of the wires.
...
I
__... -..
_ .­
--.­
,Ii'-' '~
1. Nm
: ~'
,.....,.
r

_•• ~ .,.
~lJl I
10 11
.....

.. I'·: '
I
~... -­ ....-
,­._1
I
,_--,1
.._,---­
.'.-'
--1
~
.I I
I
I
,.-J 13 .,-,-­ 12 , - '._,.,
r----i~~--- ~.-~ Q
2. Pulley 1--', /l 3. Fan ill 4. Bolt ~.4' 5. Case Half (Front) 6. Bearing 11. Heat Sink (-) 7. Rotor 12. Case Half (Rear) 8. Slip Ring 13. Condenser Assy. 9. Stator 14. Brush Holder 10. Heat Sink (+) 15. Regulator
1..-----1 D-01760
B
Checking the Rotor (Old Style) Use the following procedures with an ohmmeter to est the rotor: Touch both probes on the slip rings. There must be a 5 ohm reading B].
to
Touch one probe to the shaft and one probe to a slip r ng, then touch the other slip ring. There must be maxi um resistance [C].
C
6-09376
Revised Sept. 93
750 Series Loader Service Manual
ALTERNATOR (Cont'd) Checking the Stator (Old Style) Use the following procedure with an ohmmeter to test the stator: Touch two wire ends of the stator with the probes, take a reading. Move one probe to the other wire. The reading should be the same [A].
Test the ground by touching one probe on the metal surface of the stator and the other probe on the bare wire. There must be no needle movement [8].
Checking the Rectifier (Old Style)
c
Use the following procedure with a circuit tester to test the rectifier: Touch the positive probe to the positive diode holder and the negative probe to each diode terminal. There must be continuity [C].
Reverse the probes and check the continuity in the other direction. There must be no continuity [0].
Revised Sept. 93
D
750 Series Loader Service Manual
ALTERNATOR (Cont'd)
A
Checking the Rectifier (Old Style) (Cont'd) Touch the negative probe to the negative diode holder and the positive probe to each diode terminal. There must be continuity [A].
B
Reverse the probe and check the continuity in the other direction. There must be no continuity [8]. Check the brushes for wear. The maximum of exposed brushes should be 0.125' (3,0 mm). Replace broken or rusted brush springs. To assemble the alternator, reverse the order of disassembly.
Revised Sept. 93
-6-10-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
ALTERNATOR (Cont'd)
A 2.1.
Disassembly and Inspection (New Style)
3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8.
Disassemble the alternator (See Parts Identification [A]).
Remove the regulator cover and regulator.
Remove the four bolts holding halves together.
c-- c-
Pry the halves apart (use a press if needed).
Unsolder the stator leads from the rectifier. Remove the
stator.
Rectifier (Diode) Case Half (Rear) Condenser Assy. Strap Regulator Brush Cover
-®[email protected])-m-C)-l ~
I
---- .,-i-----------­
Use a soft jaw vise to hold rotor while removing pulley nut.
Remove front case half from the rotor using a plastic
hammer or press.
9. 10. 11. 12. 13. 14. 15.
Nut Pulley Fan Bolt Case Half (Front) Bearing Rotor Stator
~_-.J
1
r--~.-~_(j)--®--~--ft-l
,~
L.-(J)---
llJ
1
__
6
!
7
r---------------
__ .J
-------12---­ e--1-­
I
,---
I
I
I I I L----
e--­
.---
~_.
flitt'
~~-JJ-. ~~:~, '-Jf': -::::----,I I -- ~.».-_ :·::n.-~· 114 lr
I
9
-
I
10
L_e-.J I _-J
__13--­
,----­
! ~:=r.:J~­ L.-V- -'
15- --­
I
C-03312
Stator Continuity Test (New Style)
Use an ohmmeter to test the stator.
Touch the probes to two of the bare stator wires [B].
Move one of the probes to the third wire.
The readings should be the same.
If there is no continuity, replace the stator.
P-01369
Stator Ground Test (New Style) Touch one probe to a bare stator lead and the other probe
to the bare metal surface of the stator [C].
There should be no continuity.
Replace the stator if there is continuity.
Revised Sept. 93
-6-11-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
ALTERNATOR (Cont'd) Rotor Continuity Test (New Style)
Touch the probes to the slip rings [A].
The ohmmeter should read between 3.065-3.385 ohms.
If there is no continuity replace the rotor.
Rotor Ground Test (New Style) Touch one probe to one of the slip rings and the other
probe to the rotor shaft [8].
There should be no continuity.
Replace the rotor if there is continuity.
Rectifier Continuity (Diode) Test (New Style) NOTE: In the diode tests there should be continuity in one direction only. If the diode being tested shows no continuity or continui~ in both directions, replace the rectifier assembly. Touch the probes to the terminals of each diode and read the meter [C]. Reverse the probes to check the diode in the other direction. There should be continuity in one direction only.
Touch one probe to the diode and the other probe to the connected heats ink and read the meter [D]. Reverse the probes to check the diode in the other direction. There should be continuity in one direction only.
Revised Sept. 93
-6-12­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
ALTERNATOR (Cont'd) Rectifier Continuity (Diode) Test (New Style) (Cont'd)
Touch one probe to the diode and the other probe to the connected heatsink and read the meter [Al Reverse the probes to check the diode in the other direction. There should be continuity in one direction only.
Assembly (New Style)
Reverse the order of disassembly.
Do not assemble the rear case half.
Place the rotor in soft jaws when tightening the shaft nut.
lighten to 50 ft.-Ibs. (68 Nm) torque [8].
Install the rear case half and the remaining parts.
Revised Sept. 93
--6-13­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
STARTER Wire
Checking the Starter The key switch must be in the 'OFP' position. The battery must be at full charge. The cable connections on the battery must be clean and tight. Connect a jumper wire between 'S' terminal and 'BAr' terminal [A]. If the starter turns but does not tum the engine, the starter drive has a defect.
A-01992
Connect a jumper wire between the 'M' terminal and the
'BAr' terminal [8].
. lllnn..
Wire
If the starter turns, the defect is in the solenoid.
If the starter does not tum, the starter is defective.
Removal and Installation
Disconnect the negative (-) cable from the battery.
Disconnect the positive (+) cable from the starter solenoid
[C].
Disconnect all the wires from the starter solenoid [0].
Revised Sept. 93
-6-14­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
STARTER (Cont'd)
Remove the top and side mounting bolts [A].
Remove the bottom mounting bolt and ground cable [B].
Remove the starter from the engine [C].
Disassembly and Assembly Remove the starter thru-bolts [D].
Revjsed Sept. 93
-6-15­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
STARTER (Cont'd) Remove the screws for the brush holders [A].
Remove the starter end cap [8].
Remove the starter housing/armature assembly from the reduction gear drive [C].
Remove the armature and brushes from the starter housing [0].
Added Sept. 93
-6-16-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
STARTER (Cont'd)
Remove the bolts from the reduction gear housing [A].
Remove the reduction gear housing [8].
Cleaning and Inspection Use a brush and air pressure to clean the drive, field coils, armature and starter housing.
NOTE: DO NOT use solvent to clean the drive assembly. The solvent will remove the lubricant and the drive will slip. Check the following items: Armature Broken or burned insulation Loose connections at commutator Open or grounded circuits [C] & [0]. Worn shaft or bearings Rough commutator Brush Holders Broken springs Broken insulation Spring Tension Field Coils Broken or burned insulation Electrical continuity Brush connections Drive Gears Worn Teeth Tooth engagement
A-()1994
Added Sept_ 93
-6-17-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
STARTER (Cont'd) Parts Identification
3 I
4/
2
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. 13. 14. 15. 16. 17. 18. 19. 20. 21. 22. 23. 24. 25. 26. 27. 28. 29. 30. 31. 32. 33. 34. 35. 36. 37. 38. 39.
1
I ~--~-l~~--c:a>
j ____ ~1 il----~ :
($)/
~I 15 6 8 1
I
:I I I I
:
~
7 1
r-O-()
I
~-1~~~~(DCD~~--' ·II~~ ~III
10 1 @
12 13
: ~GD 1
I
I
14
I
116
18 20
17
: I
I I
15
11
r---------------------------------------~ I ~
I
:
26
22!
l--·~O- ----~--l I
I t#
I
I
27
221 I 21 r--------------------------------~ I I 35 I 35 34 : 341~ 28 ~-
40.
!
l I
OI~
I
-~--~'@
[email protected] I
29
I
30
I 31
1
32
I
38
Screw Solenoid Bolt Lever Washer Nut Plug Washer Housing Drive Washer Bushing Ring Stop Drive Drive Support Support Drive Shaft Washer Washer
Washer
Screw
Brush
Frame Assy. Gasket Pin
Armature Support
Bolt Spacer Bearing Armature Bearing Spring Holder Assy. Brush Screw O-ring Frame Washer Screw Bolt
o[~c~=I
33
j
39
=4=,0Ole
I
36
I
37
0-02119
Added Sept. 93
-6-18-
750 Series Loader ;:;ervlce Manual
OPERATING SYSTEM UNIT
Removal and Installation Raise the operator cab (Page 1-5). Disconnect the negative (-) cable from the battery. Disconnect the wire harness connectors from the operator cab wiring harness [A].
Loosen the mounting bolt [8].
Remove the operating system unit from the operator cab. Remove the wire hamess connector screws [e].
Disconnect the wire harness connectors from the operating system unit [0].
Added Sept. 93
-6-19-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
INSTRUMENT PANEL (SIN 11079 & Above) Removal and Installation
Remove the front light from the operator cab (both sides) [A].
Remove the instrument panel mounting bolts (both sides) [B].
Pull the right side instrument panel down and away from the operator cab [C]. Disconnect the wire harness connectors from the instrument panel display. Replace parts as needed.
Pull the left instrument panel down and away from the cab
[0]. Disconnect the wire harness connectors from the gauge and switches. Replace the parts as needed.
Added Sept. 93
-6-20-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
ENGINE SERVICE
Page Number AIR CLEANER
Removal and Installation .................... 7-25
BELT SHIELD
Removal and Installation .................... 7-35
BLOWER HOUSING/FAN GEARBOX
Removal and Installation .................... 7-7
Tension Pulley ........................ 7-10
CRANKSHAFT AND BEARINGS
Removal and Installation .................... 7-65
Servicing the Crankshaft and Bearings .............. 7-66
CRANKSHAFT GEAR
Removal and Installation .................... 7-59
CYLINDER BORE
Checking the Cylinder Bore ................... 7-70
CYLINDER HEAD
Disassembly and Assembly .................. Removal and Installation .................... Servicing the Cylinder Head .................. Top Clearance ........................
7-46 7-45 7-47 7-47
ENGINE
Removal and Installation .................... 7-27
ENGINE COMPRESSION
Checking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-36
ENGINE SERVICE
ENGINE MUFFLER
Removal and Installation .................... 7-6
FAN GEARBOX
Assembly ~LOng Housing) ................... . Assembly Short Housing) ................... . Checking acklash ...................... . Disassembly (Long Housing) ................. . Disassembly (Short Housing) ................. . Parts Identification ...................... .
7-16
7-18
7-21
7~11
7-13
7-24
FLYWHEEL
Flywheel Ring Gear ...................... 7-34
Removal and Installation .................... 7-34
FUEL CAMSHAFT
Governor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-58
Removal and Installation .................... 7-58
FUEL INJECTION PUMP
Adjusting Shut-Off Linkage .................. . Checking the Injection Pump ................. . Removal and Installation ................... . Timing the Injection Pump ... , ................ .
Revised Oct. 95
-7-1­
7-38
7-38
7-39
7-41
750 Series Loader Service Manual
ENGINE SERVICE (Cont'd) Page
Number FUEL INJECTION NOZZLES
Checking the Injector Nozzle .................. 7-44
Removal and Installation .................... 7-42
GLOW PLUGS
Checking ........................... 7-37
Removal and Installation .................... 7-37
IDLER GEAR AND CAMSHAFT
Removal and Installation .................... 7-54
ServiCing the Camshaft .................... 7-55
ServiCing the Idler Gear and Shaft ............... , 7-56
OIL PUMP
Checking Engine Oil Pressure ................. Oil Pump Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal and Installation .................... Relief Valve .........................
7-60 7-59 7-59 7-60
PISTON AND CONNECTING ROD
Connecting Rod Alignment .... ' .......... ' ... 7-64
Removal and Installation .................... 7-61
Servicing the Piston and Connecting Rod ............ 7-62
RADIATOR
Removal and Installation .................... 7-4
ROCKER ARM AND SHAFT
Checking ....'. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-51
TIMING GEARS
Checking Backlash ..... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-57
TIMING GEARCASE COVER
Removal and Installation .................... 7-52
TROUBLESHOOTING
Chart ............................ 7-3
VALVE CLEARANCE
Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-35
VALVE, VALVE SEAT AND GUIDE
Checking the Valve Guide ................... 7-48
Reconditioning the Valve and Valve Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-49
Valve Spring ......................... 7-50
WATER PUMP
Disassembly and Assembly .................. 7-71
Revised Oct. 95
-7-2-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
ENGINE SERVICE TROUBLESHOOTING The following troubleshooting chart is provided for assistance in locating and correcting problems which are most common. Many of the recommended procedures must be done by authorized Bobcat Service Personnel only.
PROBLEM
Slow cranking speed. Engine will not start. Difficult to start. No power for engine. Engine is mis-firing. Too much fuel consumption. Black exhaust. Blue/white exhaust. Low oil pressure. Enaine knocking. Enaine runnina rouah. Vibration. High oil pressure warning. Overheatina. Too much crankcase pressure. Poor compression. Start and stop.
CAUSE
1,2,3 2,5,6,7,8,9,11,12,13,14,15,16,19,27,28,29 1,2 5,7,8,9,10,11,12,13,15,16,17,18,19,20,25,27,28,29 8,9,10,11,12,13,15,16,17,18,20,21,22,23,27,28,29 8,9,11,12,13,15,16,17,21,22,24,25,26,28 10,12,13,15,16,17,19,20,21,23,24,25,27,28,29 10,12,13,15,16,17,19,20,21,23,24 25 27,28,29 4,10,15,16,17,21,23,27,29,30,50 4,31,32,33,34,35,37,38,39,52 13,15,16,19,22,24 25 27 29 3140 41 53 7,8,9,10,11,12,13,17,18,22,24,25,26,29,40,53 12,13,17,21,22,25,26,29,40,42,43 4,33,36 10,12,13,15,16,20,21 40 44,45,46 47,48,51 22 27,29,30,40 49 10,16,21,24,25,27,28 29 30 41,53 9, 10, 11 KEY TO CORRECT THE CAUSE
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. 13. 14. 15. 16. 17. 18. 19. 20. 21. 22. 23. 24. 25.
Alternator belt is loose or damaged. Bad electrical connections. Faulty starter motor. Incorrect grade of oil. Low cranking speed. Fuel tank empty. Faulty stop control operation. Plugged fuel line. Plugged fuel filter. Restriction in the air cleaner. Air in the fuel system. Faulty fuel injection pump. Faulty fuel injectors. Broken injection pump drive. Incorrect injection pump timing. Incorrect valve timing. Poor compression. Plugged fuel tank vent. Incorrect grade of fuel. Exhaust pipe restriction. Cylinder head gasket leaking. Overheating. Cold running. Incorrect tappet adjustment. Sticking valves.
28. 29. 30. 31'. 32. 33. 34. 35. 36. 37. 38. 39. 40. 41. 42. 43. 44. 45. 46. 47. 48. 49. 50. 51. 52.
26. Incorrect fuel lines.
53. Broken valve spring.
27. Worn cylinder bores. Revised Oct. 95
Worn valve and seats. Broken or worn piston rings. Worn valve stems or guides. Worn or damaged bearings. Not enough oil in the crankcase. Switch/sensor is defective. Oil pump worn. Relief valve is sticking open. Relief valve is sticking closed. Broken relief valve spring. Faulty suction pipe. Plugged oil filter. Piston seizure. Incorrect piston height. Faulty engine mounting. Incorrect flywheel alignment. Faulty thermostat. Restriction in water jacket. Loose alternator belt. Plugged radiator. Faulty water pump. Plugged breather pipe. Damaged valve stem deflectors. Coolant level to low. Plugged oil pump pipe strainer.
-7-3-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
RADIATOR Removal and Installation Open the rear door. Remove the rear grill. (See Page 5-1.) Loosen the radiator cap. Open the engine block drain (Item 1) [A] and drain the coolant into a container.
A WARNING
Do not remove radiator cap when the engine is hot. You can be seriously burned. W-207o-1285
Remove the oil cooler. (See Page 3-1.) Disconnect the radiator hoses (both sides) [8].
Disconnect the wires from the low water level sender unit
[C]. Disconnect the over-flow hose (Item 1) [C] from the radiator filler neck.
Remove the radiator mounting bolts (both sides) [0].
Revised Oct. 95
-7-4­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
RADIATOR (Cont'd)
A
Removal and Installation (Cont'd)
Lift the radiator up and out of the loader frame [A].
Remove the radiator from the loader.
Revised Oct. 95
-7-5-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
ENGINE MUFFLER
Removal and Installation
Open the rear door. Raise the rear grill.
Loosen the muffler and shield mounting bolts (both sides)
[A].
Remove the exhaust pipe clamp [B]. Disconnect the exhaust pipe from the muffler.
Remove the muffler from the shield [e].
Remove the mounting bolts. Remove the muffler from the loader [0].
Revised Oct. 95
-7-6-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
BLOWER HOUSING/FAN GEARBOX
Removal and Installation Raise the operator cab. (See Page 1-7.)
Lift up on the tension pulley and remove the fan drive belt
[A]. Remove the hydraulic fluid reservoir. (See Page 2-1.)
Remove the four mounting bolts from the fan blower housing [B] & [C].
Pull the fan/gearbox assembly down and out of the loader frame [0]. Remove the blower housing from the loader frame.
Revised Oct. 95
-7-7-
750 Series Loader S9rvtc9 Manual
BLOWER HOUSINGIFAN GEARBOX (Cont'd) Removal and Installation (Cont'd) Remove the lock nut and spacer [A].
Installation: lighten the nutto 45-55 ft.-Ibs. (61-75 Nm) torque.
Use the following procedure to remove the fan from the shaft: Use a center punch to mark the aluminum bushing in the fan where shown [B].
A WARNING
AVOID INJURY OR DEATH
.562 .562 to to .570 .570
Wear safety goggles to prevent eye injury when drilling or grinding. W-2108-n86
To insure straight drilling and tapping of the holes, a drill press is recommended. Drill the two holes 1.00' (25,4 mm) deep using a 13/64' (5 mm) bit [C]. Use a 1/4' NC bottom tap to cut maximum threads in the holes.
Install the nut (Item 1) [0] on the tapered shaft to protect the shaft and threads. Install the puller on the fan as shown [0]. As the center bolt (Item 2) [0] is tightened, periodically strike the bolt head to loosen the fan from the shaft.
Revised Oct. 95
-7-8­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
BLOWER HOUSING/FAN GEARBOX (Cont'd) Removal and Installation (Cont'd) Remove the fan from the tapered shaft [A].
To remove the blower housing mounting plate, remove the six bolts (Item 1) [B].
Installation: Clean the surface where the blower housing contacts the loader frame. Put a bead of R.T.V. sealant on the blower housing [C].
Revised Oct. 95
-7-9-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
BLOWER HOUSING/FAN GEARBOX (Cont'd) Tension Pulley Removal and Installation
Loosen the idler pulley bolt [A].
Installation: Install the retainer bracket (Item 1) [A] for
the fan belt at the three o'clock position.
Remove the spacers, bolt and washer from the arm [B].
Installation: Put a small amount of grease around the outside edge (Item 1) [C] on the grease rings.
Remove the bolt, spring and arm for the idler pulley [0]. Check all parts for damage or worn and replace them as needed.
Revised Oct. 95
-7-10-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
FAN GEARBOX Disassembly NOTE: When repairing the gearbox order the following as needed. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5.
Complete Assembly Long Housing· Assembly Long Housing Short Housing Assembly (See Note Below) Internal Parts
NOTE: The short housing is only available as an assembly. See the parts identification page (page 7-23) for reference. (Order parts from Melroe Parts Sales.) NOTE: Be sure to count the number and thickness of shims during disassembly. Install the shims in the original location during assembly. NOTE: Always replace seals during assembly. Replace the parts in the gearbox as needed. Remove the fan and blower housing mounting plate. (See Page 7-9.)
Long Housing Loosen the set screws (Item 1) [A] and remove the pulley (Item 2) [Al Remove the long key (Item 3) [AJ. Remove the four mounting bolts and the part number tag [B]. Remove the oil from the gearbox.
A WARNING
AVOID INJURY OR DEATH Wear safety goggles to prevent eye injury when drilling or grinding. W-2108-1186
Drill an 1/8 inch (13 mm) hole in the seal. Use a slide hammer tool to remove the seal [C]. Remove the small snap ring [0].
Revised Oct. 95
-7-11­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
FAN GEARBOX (Cont'd) Disassembly (Cont'd) Remove the small shims [A].
NOTE: Use the same size and thickness of shims during assembly.
Remove the screw and washer from the shaft [B].
Support the lower flange and press the shaft from the bearing [C].
NOTE: The gear and the other bearing (pulley end) will be removed with the shaft.
Support the bearing and press the shaft from the bearing [0].
Revised Oct. 95
-7-12-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
FAN GEARBOX (Cont'd)
Disassembly (Cont'd)
Short Housing
Remove the end cap [A].
Use care not to damage the housing.
A WARNING
AVOID INJURY OR DEATH Wear safety goggles to prevent eye injury when drilling or grinding. W-2108-1186
Drill an 1/8 inch (3 mm) hole in the seal. Use a slide hammer tool to remove the seal [B].
Remove the large snap ring from the flange end of the housing [C].
Remove the large shims from the housing [0].
NOTE: Use the same size and thickness of shims during assembly.
Revised Oct- 9S
750 Series Loader -7-13­
S.rvtc. Manual
FAN GEARBOX (Cont'd) Disassembly (Cont'd) Remove the screw and washer (Item 1) [A] from the shaft.
Remove the snap ring from the cap end of the housing
[B].
Press the shaft from the housing [C].
NOTE: Both bearings may come out of the housing
with the shaft. If one bearing remains in the
housing use a non metal object to tap the
bearing from the housing.
- Press the bearing from the tapered end of the shaft [D].
Revised Oct. 95
-7-14-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
FAN GEARBOX (Cont'd)
Disassembly (Cont'd)
Press the bearing, shims and gear from the shaft [A].
Remove the key from the shaft [B].
Revised Oct. 95
-7-15-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
FAN GEARBOX (Cont'd) Assembly NOTE: See Note Page 7-9 when ordering parts for the Fan Gearbox. NOTE: Do not install the seals and cap in the housing until after the backlash has been checked. NOTE: Use care when pressing the bearings into the aluminum housing. The housing can be damaged if too much pressure is used. NOTE: For procedures requiring the use of LOCTITE adhesive, thoroughly clean and dry affected parts before the application of LOCTITE. Long Housing Press a bearing on the short keyed end of the long shaft
[AJ. Install the long housing on the shaft [B]. Be sure the bearing is seated in the bore at the lower end of the housing.
Install a bearing on the long keyed end of the shaft [C]. Support the lower bearing and press the other bearing in the housing until the bearings seat in the housing [C].
Install on the bearing, the same number and size shims that were removed during disassembly [0].
Revised Oct. 95
-7-16-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
FAN GEARBOX (Cont'd)
Assembly (Cont'd)
Install the small snap ring in the groove above the shims
[A].
Install the gear key in the flange end of the shaft [B].
Align the key and gear. While supporting the bearing on the other end, press the gear on the shaft until it seats against the bearing [C].
Install the washer (Item 1) [0]. Put liquid adhesive (LOCTITE 242) on the screw threads. Install and tighten the screw [0].
Revised Oct. 95
-7-17-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
FAN GEARBOX (Cont'd) Assembly (Cont'd) Short Housing Install a bearing in the flanged end of the housing [A].
Install the large shims on the bearing (flanged end) [B].
Install the large snap ring in the groove above the shims
[C].
Install the short key (Item 1) [0]. Align and press the gear on the shaft (teeth toward the tapered end of the shaft) [0].
Revised Oct. 95
-7-18-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
FAN GEARBOX (Cont'd) Assembly (Cont'd) After the gear is seated, drive the key down inside the gear key way [A].
NOTE: This will prevent damage to the shims when the bearing is installed later.
Install the shaft in the housing, tapered end in the bearing at the round flange end of the housing [B].
Install on the shaft, the same number and size shims that were removed during disassembly [C].
Install a bearing on the gear end of the shaft [0].
Revised Oct. 95
-7-19-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
FAN GEARBOX (Cont'd) Assembly (Cont'd) Install the snap ring in the groove above the bearing [A].
Install the washer (Item 1) [B] on the shaft. Put liquid adhesive (LOCTITE 242) on the screw threads and install the screw [B].
Revised Oct. 95
-7-20-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
FAN GEARBOX (Cont'd) Checking Backlash NOTE: For procedures requiring the use of LOCTITE adhesive, thoroughly clean and dry affected parts before the application of LOCTITE.
The backlash tolerance between the gears should be .005'-.008' (0,127-0,203 mm). To check the gear backlash use the following procedure: Put the short housing in a vise, square flange facing up as shown [A].
Install the same size and number of square shims (if present during disassembly) between the two housings
[B]. Set the long housing on the short housing with a small amount of liquid adhesive (LOCTITE 242) between the mounting surfaces. NOTE: If square shims are used, put a small amount of the liquid adhesive on both sides of all shims.
Install the four mounting bolts through the flange holes [C]. Install the part number tag [C]. Install and tighten the nut to 25-28 ft.-Ibs. (34-38 Nm) torque.
Install the long key (Item 1) [0] and the pulley (Item 2) [0]. Install a bolt in the set screw hole to maintain a 1.00' (25,4 mm) distance from the shaft center to the bolt head (to be used with a dial indicator) [0].
Revised Oct. 95
-7-21-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
FAN GEARBOX (Cont'd) Checking Backlash (Cont'd) Put the fan nut (Item 1) [A] on the shaft and tighten snugly. Install a locking pliers on the fan nut and support the handle against the long housing [A].
Using a magnetic based dial indicator mounted on a bench vise, touch the dial stem on the bolt (Item 1) [B]. Hold the locking pliers against the long housing and rotate the pulley back and forth to read the dial gauge [B]. If the backlash is GREATER than .008' (0,203 mm), do the following: 1. Remove a square shim(s) (if present) between the two housings. 2. Remove a large shim(s) from the tapered end of the short shaft and add a small shim (s) of the same thickness between the bearing and the gear on the screw end of the shaft. If the backlash is LESS than .005' (0,127 mm) do the following: 1. Add a square shim(s) between the two housings. 2. Remove a small shim(s) between the bearing and the gear on the screw end of the short shaft and add a large shim(s) of the same thickness between the snap ring and the bearing on the tapered end of the shaft.
Revised Oct. 95
-7-22-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
FAN GEARBOX (Cont'd)
Checking Backlash (Cont'd)
When the backlash is correct, install the seals, cap and
gear oil as follows:
Remove the bolts from the flanges and separate the two housings. Put liquid adhesive (LOCTITE 242) on the outside diameter of the seal(s) [A].
Install the seal(s) flush with the housing surface [B] & [C].
Add SAE 90 gear oil in the short housing to about 1/2' (12
mm) below the flange surface [0].
Clean any oil from the flange surface.
Install the long housing on the short housing flange.
Install the four bolts and part number tag.
Install and tighten the nuts to 25-28 ft.-Ibs. (34-38 Nm)
torque.
Revised Oct. 95
-7-23-
750 Series Loader Service· Manual
FAN GEARBOX (Cont'd) Parts Identification 1. Seal
2. Snap Ring (Small)
3. Shims (1.000 inch 0.0.)
4. Bearing
5. Shaft (long)
6. Shims (2.000 inch 0.0.)
7. Long Key 8. Shaft (Short) 9. Short Key 10. Long Housing 11. Nut 12. Gear 13. Washer 14. Screw 15. Square Shim 1
*16. Short Housing I 17. 18. Ring (Large) 19. Cap
20. Long Housing Assy.
21. Short Housing Assy.
22. Fill Plug
=~:p
@-1 I
I
I
I
C::>-18 I
I
«:.!>
~~6
f
3
@---6---- ,/ v---_ 6-
,';11'
/,'
®-4
'=-
I
=:::::::::.:'. _ _ .,.
/ ,..--­
----
--__
/'
22
/'
I
J>'
/'
r
----__
'
/'
',<>
-------J
/~
,/
,/
4 /' __ _
r
7 (I 5 I
--- -- __ ~I l' --
,--­ '
I
I
'
----0
.I'
4
I
12
I
V!'C._ -- (j- __ ~I ___ I --__ ~ ,-_ I ~ -------- ---- ------
9
13
14
--~---
I
---
15
21 ~
I
C-:-- tq I
I
~-12
17
I
I
:>3
o
c.!> I
I
I
~-4
I
~-13 I
l!-14 I
I
I
C.!.>-18 I
I
I
~-19 * Individual Part not available (See Note Page 7-19). Revised Oct. 95
-7-24-
T8-1002
750 Series Loader Service Manual
AIR CLEANER
A
Removal and Installation Remove the muffler. (See Page 7-6.) Remove the hose clamp from the air cleaner intake hose
[A].
,
Loosen the hose clamp on the intake hose [8]. Disconnect the hose from the manifold.
Remove the air cleaner housing mounting bolts [C].
Installation: Tighten the bolts to 25-28 ft.-Ibs. (34-38 Nm) torque.
Move the air cleaner housing out of the engine compartment for clearance. Disconnect the wires from the sender unit [0].
Revised Oct. 95
-7-25­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
AIR CLEANER
Removal and Installation (Cont'd)
Remove the air cleaner housing assembly from the loader
[A1·
Revised Oct. 95
750 Series Loader -7-26-
Service Manual
ENGINE Removal and Installation
Remove the rear door. (See Page 5-1.)
Remyve the rear grill. (See Page 5-1.)
/
~ise the operator cab: (See Page 1-1.)
..
Remove the battery. (See Page 6-1.) Remove the muffler. (See Page 7-6.) Remove the air cleaner. (See Page 7-10.) Remove the coolant from the cooling system. Disconnect the radiator hose from the engine (both sides) [A]. Disconnect the throttle linkage [8].
Disconnect the fuel hose from the fuel filter [e].
Disconnect the fuel return hose [0].
Revised Oct. 95
-7-27-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
ENGINE (Cont'd)
Removal and Installation (Cont'd)
Disconnect the ground cable from the start mounting bolt
[A].
IMPORTANT
When making repairs on hydrostatic and hydraulic systems, clean the work area before disassembly and keep all parts clean. Always use caps and plugs on hoses, tubelines and ports to keep dirt out. Oirt can quickly damage the system. 1-2003-0284
Disconnect the hose which goes from the control valve to the hydraulic fluid reservoir [B]. When this hose is disconnected fluid will drain from the reservoir. Drain the fluid into a container.
Remove the suction hose [C].
Disconnect the outlet high pressure tubeline [0].
Revised Oct. 95
-7-28­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
ENGINE (Cont'd)
Removal and Installation (Cont'd)
Loosen the hose clamps on the fuel tank fill hose [A].
Remove the fuel fill hose [B].
Disconnect the vent hose (Item 1) [B] from the fuel tank.
Disconnect the small hose (if equipped) from the outlet fitting on the hydraulic pump. Disconnect the steering linkage [C].
Revised Oct. 95 ',­
-7-29-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
ENGINE (Cont'd) Removal and Installation (Cont'd) Disconnect the case drain hose from the hydrostatic pump [A].
Mark the high pressure hoses for correct installation. Remove the high pressure hoses from the hydrostatic pumps [8].
A WARNING
Always clean up spilled fuel or oil. Keep heat, flames, sparks or lighted tobacco away from fuel Bnd oil. Failure to use care around combustibles can cause explosion or fire which can result in injury or death. W-2103-1285
Disconnect the wire harness connectors in front of the hydrostatic pump [C].
Disconnect the fuel level sender wire [0].
Revised Oct. 95
-7-30­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
ENGINE (Cont'd) Removal and Installation (Cont'd) Disconnect the engine wiring harness from the operator cab wiring harness [A].
SIN 11079 & Above
The relays (Item 1) [B} and fuses (Item 2) [B} are loosened when air cleaner is removed and are removed with the engine wiring harness when the engine/hydrostatic pumps are removed.
Remove the bolt and nut from the engine/hydrostatic pump mount (both sides) [C}.
Remove the bolt and nut at the rear engine mount (both sides) [OJ.
750 Series Loader Revised Oct. 95
-7-31-
Service Manual
ENGINE (Cont'd)
~ (fJr
'--------l ~~~ ~ .·l,!­
Removal and Installation (Cont'd) A tool will be needed so the engine/hydrostatic pump assembly can be lifted a small amount (off the engine mounts) and moved out of the loader. Use the dimensions in [A] to make the engine removal tool.
1-112' I.S. Oi~. 2-112' O.S. O,a.
,
J
1-112' Square Tubing
1/4'(4) Thick Gusset
16'
P-4'
~~2' ::-1-1' .3125' (2)
.375'
I-r
Use Two 318' X 1-1/4' Bolts for Drilled and Tapped Holes.
MC-1799
Install a chain on the engine lifting tool. Connect the chain hoist to the ring on the lifting tool and connect the chain to the lifting eye brackets on the engine [B]. Lift the engine/hydrostatic pump assembly and remove them from the loader.
750 Series Loader Revised Oct. 95
-7-32-
Service Manual
ENGINE (Cont'd)
Installation
There is a kit available to replace the existing engine
mounts in older model 753 loaders. (See your Bobcat
loader dealer for the kit needed.)
Use the following procedure to install new engine mounts:
Remove the existing mount from the engine [A].
Replace all four engine mounts 2 front and 2 rear.
B
Use the parts shown to install the new engine mounts [6].
1-~ !
c- 2 .. . ,.
v
Item 1 - square nut - used on left side engine mounts
3-~
Item 2 - hex nut - used on rear side engine mounts
[email protected]
Item 3 - mount washer
5-0
Item 4 - engine mount Item 5 - tube spacer (front mount) - 1.47' (37.3 mm) tube spacer (rear mount) - 1.57' (39.9 mm)
6-®
Item 6 - snubbing washer
7-A
Item 7 - mounting bolt Install the new engine mount as shown in the cut away side view [C].
IMC-1771
IC
TIghten the mounting bolts to 9(}-100 ft.-Ibs. (125-130 Nm) torque.
Snubbing Washer
Revised Oct. 95
-7-33-
MC-1765
750 Series Loader Service Manual
ENGINE (Cont'd) Installation
There is a kit available to replace the existing engine
mounts in older model 753 loaders. (See your Bobcat
loader dealer for the kit needed.)
Use the following procedure to install new engine mounts:
Remove the existing mount from the engine [A).
Replace all four engine mounts 2 front and 2 rear.
8-
B
Use the parts shown to install the new engine mounts [B). Item 1 - square nut - used on left side engine mounts
2

Item 2 - hex nut - used on rear side engine mounts

Item 3 - mount washer Item 4 - engine mount
5-C
Item 5 - tube spacer (front mount) - 1.47' (37,3 mm) tube spacer (rear mount) - 1.57' (39,9 mm)

Item 6 - snubbing washer
7
Item 7 - mQunting bolt
MC-1771
C
Install the new engine mount as shown in the cut away side view [C). Tighten the mounting bolts to 90-100 ft.-Ibs. (125-130 Nm) torque.
Snubbing Washer
Revised Oct. 95
-7-33-
MC-1765
750 Series Loader Service Manual
FLYWHEEL Removal and Installation Remove the bolts from the flywheel [A1.
Remove the flywheel from the crankshaft [B].
Installation: Put liquid adhesive (LOCTITE #242) on the flywheel bolts before installation [C1.
Installation: Tighten the bolts to 83-90 ft.-Ibs. (113-122 Nm) torque [0]. Flywheel Ring Gear The ring gear on the flywheel is an interference fit. Heat the ring gear enough to expand it and hit it with a hammer, to remove it evenly. Clean the outer surface of the flywheel to give a smooth fit. Clean the new ring gear and heat it to a temperature of 4SQ-SOO°F (232-260°C). Fit the ring gear over the flywheel. Make sure the gear is on the seat correctly.
Revised Oct. 95
-7-34-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
BELT SHIELD Removal and Installation Remove the bolt from the timing gearcase cover [A].
Remove the bolt from the thermostat housing [B].
Remove the bolt from the alternator mounting bracket
[C].
Remove the belt shield from the engine [0].
Revised Oct. 95
-7-35-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
VALVE CLEARANCE
A
Adjustment
rFn. ~ . ~ ~~Il.
Make the valve clearance adjustment with the engine stopped and cold.
rci~°l:t·009 in.
r~~( 0 ~~~~_=_'_~rm)
r
The correct valve clearance is 0.007-0.009' (0,18-0,22 mm) [A].
-~--r-=
o !!HI! 0 o o o o
Make sure the piston is at TO.C. when making the adjustment for the intake and exhaust valves of the particular cylinder.
o
o MC-1368
IB
Put the correct size feeler gauge between the rocker arm and the valve stem. Turn the adjustment bolt until the clearance is correct [8]. Tighten the adjusting bolt lock nut.
ENGINE COMPRESSION
Checking
The tools listed will be needed to do the follOwing
procedure:
OEM1074 - Engine Compression Kit
MEL1404 - Compression Adapter
The engine must be at operating temperature.
Remove the glow plugs. (See Page 7-37.)
Install the correct compression adapter into the cylinder
head [C].
Connect the compression gauge [0].
Make sure the throttle is fully backward (engine idle).
Disconnect the fuel stop solenoid.
Crank the engine with the starter at 200-300 RPM.
If the measurement is below the allowable limit, check the
cylinder, piston ring, top clearance, valve and cylinder head. . Compression Pressure 412-469 PSI (2840-3233 kPa)
Allowable Limit (minimum) .... 327 PSI (2255 kPa)
No more than 10% variance among cylinders.
Connect the fuel stop solenoid.
Revised Oct. 95
-7-36­
750 Series Loader Service Manua'
GLOW PLUGS Removal and Installation Disconnect the negative (-) cable from the battery. Remove the nut from the glow plugs [A].
Remove the glow plug connecting strap [8].
Loosen and remove the glow plug [C]. Installation: Tighten the glow plug 15-18 ft.-Ibs. (20-24 Nm) torque.
Checking Disconnect the glow plug cables and leads. Use an ohmmeter to check the glow plugs. Touch one probe to the end of the glow plug and the other probe to the body of glow plug [0]. The reading must be between 1 and 2. If the resistance is infinite, the coil of the glow plug is broken. Repeat the procedure for each glow plug.
Revised Oct. 95
-1-37­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
FUEL INJECTION PUMP
A
Checking the Injection Pump The injection pump contains parts which have a very close tolerance and its operation has a direct effect on the performance of the engine.
A WARNING
Diesel fuel or hydraulic fluid under pressure can penetrate skin or eyes causing serious injury. Fluid leaks under pressure may not be visible. Use a piece of cardboard or wood to find leaks. Do not use your bare hand. Wear safety goggles. If fluid enters skin or eyes, get Immediate medical attention. W-2074-1285
The tools listed will be needed to do the following procedure: MEL 1237 - Adapter Fuel Line MEL1173-1 - Pressure Gauge To check the discharge pressure at the fuel injection pump, use the following procedure: Disconnect a high pressure fuel line from the injection pump. Loosen the other end of the same fuel line so it can be turned av,ay from the fitting. Connect the adapter fuel line (Item 1) [A] to the fitting and connect the pressure gauge (Item 2) [A]. Turn the flywheel to increase the pressure. If the pressure can notreachtheallowablelimitof2133 PSI (14707kPa), replace the injection pump assembly. Fuel lightness of Pump Element Allowable Limit ....... 2133 PSI (14707 kPa) Measure the time needed to decrease the pressure from 2133-1990 PSI (14707-13721 kPa).lfthemeasurement is less than the allowable limit, replace the delivery valve.
IB
Fuel lightness of Delivery Valve Allowable Limit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 seconds 0.050' (1,27 mm)
Adjusting Shut-otf Linkage Adjust shut-off linkage for maximum distance of 0.05' (1,27 mm) between the lever and stop when solenoid plunger is seated [8].
,-?J, >
'>'
<
8-13704
Revised Oct. 95
-7-38­
750 Series Loader Service Man,) ~~:
FUEL INJECTION PUMP (Cont'd) Removal and Installation
Clean around the injection pump. Disconnect the high pressure fuel lines from the injection pump [A].
Disconnect the high pressure fuel lines from the fuel injectors [8].
Remove the high pressure fuel lines [C].
Revised Oct. 95
-7-39-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
FUEL INJECTION PUMP (Cont'd)
Removal and Installation (Cont'd)
IMPORTANT
00 not bend the high pressure fuel injection tubes when removing or installing them. 1-202~289
Disconnect the fuel shut-off linkage [A]. Disconnect the fuel inlet hose (Item 1) [81 and fuel return hose (Item 2) [8).
Remove the mounting nuts & bolts [C].
Installation: llghten the nuts & bolts to 17-20 ft.-Ibs. (23-27 Nm) torque. Remove the side cover. Put the pin in the control rack (Item 1) [01 in alignment with the slot in the engine block (Item 2) [01. Remove the injection pump [0].
NOTE: Make sure the same number of shims are installed under the injection pump. The shims are used for engine timing.
o
IMPORTANT
00 not attempt to maintain or adjust unless you are trained and have the correct equipment.
1-2028-0289
Installation: When the injection pump is installed, make sure the pin (Item 1) [0] on the control rack is correctly installed on the fork lever. If the slot is not installed correctly, the engine will run over maximum speed and serious damage can result.
750 Series Loader Revised Oct. 95
-7-4~
Service Manual
FUEL INJECTION PUMP (Cont'd) Timing the Injection Pump Timing the injection pump is done by changing the number of shims between the injection pump and engine block. Remove the number one cylinder high pressure line from the injection pump. Disconnect the fuel shut-off linkage from the injection pump [A).
Turn the fuel supply lever to the ON position. Install a short plastic tube in the fitting of the number one cylinder port. Point the tube up (vertical) [B1.
Rotate the engine in a clockwise direction (Viewed from crankshaft pulley). Fuel must flow from the pipe when the timing mark (19 degrees) on the flywheel shows in the flywheel housing window (Item 1) [C].
The correct engine timing is 19° B.T.D.C. Add or subtract shim(s) (Item 1) [01 as needed to adjust the delivery time of the fuel.
ID
NOTE: Adding or removing one shim varies the timing by approximately 1.5°.
Revised Oct. 95
-7-41­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
FUEL INJECTION NOZZLES
A WARNING
Diesel fuel or hydraulic fluid under pressure can penetrate skin or eyes causing serious injury. Fluid leaks under pressure may not be visible. Use a piece of cardboard or wood to find leaks. Do not use your bare hand. Wear safety goggles. If fluid enters skin or eyes, get immediate medical attention. W-2074-1285
Some problems caused by faulty injector nozzles: * The engine is hard to start or will not start. ' Rough engine operation and idle. * The en~ine will not have full power. * ExceSSive exhaust smoke.
Removal and Installation
IMPORTANT
Do not bend the high pressure fuel injection tubes when removing or installing them. 1-2029-0289
Disconnect the high pressure fuel lines from the fuel injectors [A]. Disconnect the high pressure fuel lines form the fuel injection pump [8). Remove the high pressure fuel lines [C).
Disconnect the fuel return hose from the fuel injector and bleed screw (0).
Revised Oct. 95
-7-42­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
FUEL INJECTOR NOZZLES (Cont'd) Removal and Installation (Cont'd)
Remove the retainer nut from the top of the fuel injectors [A].
Remove the fuel retum pipe from the fuel injectors [B].
Use a socket and rachet and loosen the fuel injector nozzle [C]. Installation: Tighten the fuel injector nozzle to 36-51 ft.-Ibs. (46-69 Nm) torque.
Remove the injector nozzle from the cylinder head [0]. Installation: Make sure the copper washer and the nozzle cap are in the correct position in the cylinder head.
NOTE: Make sure to replace the copper washer and nozzle cap anytime new or used injectors are installed.
Revised Oct. 95
-7-43-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
FUEL INJECTOR NOZZLE (Cont'd)
A
Checking the Injector Nozzle
®
IMPORTANT
Do not disassemble or test the fuel injector nozzles unless you have the correct service and testing tools.
1-2027-0284
(1) Nozzle Holder (2) Adjusting Washer (3) Nozzle Spring (4) Push Rod (5) Distance Piece (6) Nozzle Piece (7) Nozzle Retaining Nut
The tool listed will be needed to do the following procedure: MEL 10018 - Injector Nozzle Tester
I
Disassemble and clean the injector nozzle.
PI-9981
The nozzle release pressure can be adjusted by adding 'f removing spacer(s) (Item 2) [A] from the top of the iozzle spring (Item 3) [A]. Each spacer will change the release pressure by about 142 PSI (980 kPa). Fuel Injection Pressure ....... 1991-2133 PSI (13728-14707 kPa)
IB
Assemble the injector nozzle. Connect the nozzle to the tester with the nozzle down [B]. Operate the hand lever at a slow rate and record the opening pressure. If the pressure is not correct, disassemble the nozzle and add or remove spacers (Item 2) [A] as needed. When the injector nozzle is assembled, tighten the nozzle body to 43-58 ft.-Ibs. (59-79 Nm) torque. Check for inside leakage. Operate the hand lever until the pressure is 1850 PSI (12755 kPa). Keep the nozzle under this pressure for 10 seconds, check to see if fuel leaks from the nozzle. If fuel leaks, replace the nozzle.
A-2513
c
Check that the spray pattern is correct [C]: 1. Fuel does not come out the side of the nozzle.
PI PI
CORRECT WRONG
2. Drops of fuel are not present at the nozzle. 3. The injector has an even flow coming from the
nozzle.
A-2621
Revised Oct. 95
750 Series Loader -7-44­
Service Manual
CYLINDER HEAD
A
Removal and Installation Remove the nuts from the valve cover, remove the valve cover and gasket [A].
~
~ PI-9982
Remove the fuel injector nozzles. (See Page 7-42.)
Remove the glow plugs. (See Page 7-37.)
Remove the belt shield. (See Page 7-34.)
Remove the alternator. (See Page 6-1.)
Remove the rocker arm and shaft assembly (Item 1) [8].
Remove the push rods (Item 2) [8].
Remove the intake and exhaust manifolds.
Remove the water return hose (C].
Remove the cylinder head bolts in order of #18 to #1 [D].
ID
Installation: Put oil on the bolt threads. lighten the bolts in the correct sequence to 67-72 ft.-Ibs. (91-98 Nm) torque.
) 18 . '
NOTE: Retighten the cylinder head bolts in the correct sequence after the engine has been run for 30 minutes.
14 0
O ;,'
':
20 '·0
/,.,
11
3
7 0 .. ·
o
15l o
I 0' 17
FRONT Revised Oct. 95
10 '. 0 .
6 0
-7-45-
0 13
0 9
0' 5
.···0 1
0 4
0 8
0 0 16 12,/
I PI-9985 750 Series Loader Service Manual
CYLINDER HEAD (Cont'd)
A
Removal and Installation (Cont'd)
Remove the cylinder head from the engine block.
Installation: Always use new head gasket and new
O-ring. Make sure the O-ring is seated over the dowel
[AJ.
Disassembly and Assembly Use a valve spring compressor to compress the valve spring [8].
Remove the valve cap (Item 1) and valve spring collet (Item 2) [8] & [C].
IC
Remove the valve spring retainer (Item 3) and the spring (Item 4) [8] & [C]. Remove the seal (Item 6) and the valve (Item 5) [8] & [C].
g 88
@
~
@
Spring
val,ve Seal
s
~1t~ ~ ~~ Cap Collets Retaienr
8-4122
Remove the thermostat housing. Remove the thermostat from the cylinder head [D].
Revised Oct. 95
-7-46­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
CYLINDER HEAD (COnt'd) Servicing the Cylinder Head Clean the surface of the cylinder head. Put a straight edge (Item 1) on the cylinder head [A].
NOTE: Do not put the straight edge across combustion chambers. Put a feeler gauge (Item 2) [A] between the straight edge and the surface of the cylinder head.
Put the straight edge on the cylinder head's four sides and two diagonal as shown in figure [B].
B
The maximum distortion of the head surface is + 0.002 inch (± 0,05 mm). If the measurement exceeds the specification, replace the cylinder head.
...
N----;
--,¥ A . / F,.
I E'X: CI. /' /' B_.:±±:­ ' I :I:z1=~.0
l PI-9988
Top Clearance Install the cylinder head gasket. Put the piston (Item 1) [C] being checked at T.O.C.
IC
Put 3 pieces of 0.06 inch (1,5 mm) diameter solder (Item 2) [C] on the top of the piston. Use grease to hold them in position.
NOTE: Position the solder in position so they do not touch the valves.
'0
Turn the piston to bottom dead center. Install the cylinder head and tighten to the correct torque in the correct sequence. (See Page 7-45.)
PI-9989
Turn the crankshaft until the piston exceeds T.O.C. Remove the cylinder head. Remove the solder wire (Item 3) [C] and measure it. If the measurement exceeds the specifications, check the oil clearance of the crank pin joumal or the piston pin. Top Clearance .... 0.022-0.028 inch (0,55-0,7 mm)
Revised Oct. 95
-7-47-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
VALVE, VALVE SEAT AND GUIDE
A
Checking the Valve Guide Remove the valve and spring from the cylinder head. (See Page 7-20.) Clean the valve seat and combustion chamber. Install the valve into the guide. Measure the valve recessing or protrusion with a depth gauge [AJ.
'
o
C>
O~
~
0
°0°0 ~
(
8-3634
If the measurement exceeds the allowable limit, replace the valve or cylinder head [8].
C(
B
Protrusion ............ 0.002' (0,05mm)
ReceSSing ............ 0.006' (0,15 mm)
Allowable Limit (Recessing) ..... 0.016' (0,4 mm)
05
B
1. Cylinder Head Surface 2. Recessing 3. Protrusion
PI-9990
Remove the carbon from the valve guide. Measure the valve stem 0.0. [C). Measure the valve guide 1.0. [C]. Calculate the clearance. If the clearance exceeds the allowable limit, replace the valve and/or valve guide. Valve Guide 1.0... 0.3156-0.3161' (8,015-8,03 Valve Stem 0.0... 0.3134-03142' (7,96-7,98 Clearance Between Valve Stem and Guide ..... 0.0016-0.0028' (0,04-0,07 Allowable Limit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.004' (0,1
mm) mm) mm) mm)
To remove and replace the valve guide, make the driver tool as shown in figure [0].
~ ,~ r. .t3 _T r~[~1·
D1
__ -,!!!7~ (~IJIIJIL
0.787' (20
mR 0.51-0.511'.03.15' (80 m ~-~
r O.2W
(5,Omm)
-r=
1i
-L~~
t---r 0.59'
0.31' (8,0 mm)
Revised Oct. 95
-7-48-
CJ
(15,0 mm)
('r' 1.57'
0.295-0.303'
(7,S-7,7 mm)
0.393' (10,0 mm)1
r
O.71w
(18,0 mm)
-LFl~
tld---r 051' (13,Omm)
I.:----11 MC-1364
750 Series Loader Service Manual
VALVE, VALVE SEAT AND GUIDE (Cont'd)
A
Checking the Valve Guide (Cont'd)
D
,0
Press the used valve guide out of the cylinder head using the special driver tool [A].
t:
Put oil on the outside diameter of the new valve guide. Press the new valve guide into the cylinder head from the top side. Use the special driver tools (Item 1 & 2) [A], press the new guide until the tool contacts the cylinder head.
~
Ream the valve guide to the correct specifications.
PI-9992
Reconditioning the Valve and Valve Seat Grind the valve face to the correct angle using a valve refacer [8].
Grind the valve seat surface in the cylinder head to the correct angle [C].
IC
15°

t:::-et1I~L
45° (30°)
PI-9994
01
Check the seat surface and valve face (Item 1) [D].
=.J
If the seat surface is too wide, use a 15 degree cutter (Item 2) [D] to get the correct width (Item 3) [D].
~.:.>.:.. . . .
15°
L
~.
:i.ft.i
Valve Seat Width Intake ............. 0.084' (2,12 mm) Exhaust ............ 0.084' (2,12 mm)
2
1
~ '~
.
3
Valve Seat & Face Angle Intake ................... 60° Exhaust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45°
PI-9995
Revised Oct. 95
-7-49-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
VALVE, VALVE SEAT AND GUIDE (Cont'd)
A
Valve Spring Measure the length of the valve spring. If the measurement is less than the allowable limit, replace the spring [A]. Free Length ..... 1.642-1.661' (41,7-42,2 mm) Allowable Limit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.622' (41,2 mm) Put the spring on a flat surface, place a square on the side of the spring [A]. Rotate the spring and measure the maximum tilt. If the measurement exceeds the allowable limit, replace the spring. Tilt .............. 0.04 inch (1,0 mm)
B Put the spring on a tester and compress to specified length [8]. Read the compressed load on the gauge. If the measurement exceeds allowable limit, replace the spring. Setting Length ........ 1.378 inch (35,0 mm)
Setting Load .......... 26.4 Ibs. (117,6 N)
Allowable Limit ......... 22.5Ibs. (100,0 N)
A-2759
Revised Oct. 95
-7-50-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
ROCKER ARM AND SHAFT
A
Checking Measure the rocker arm 1.0. (Item 1) [A] with an inside micrometer. Measure the rocker arm shaft 0.0. (Item 2) [A] with an outside micrometer. If the clearance exceeds the allowable limit, replace the bushing. If the clearance still exceeds the allowable limit after the bushing is replace; replace the rocker arm shaft.
Oil Clearance Between Rocker Arm & Shaft .... ' 0.006-0.0015' (0,016-0,038 mm) Allowable Limit .......... 0.006' (0,15 mm) Rocker Arm Shaft 0.0......... 0.550-0551 '
(13.97-13.98 mm)
Rocker Arm 1.0... 0.5512-0.5516' (14,0-14,1 mm)
Revised Oct. 95
-7-51-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
TIMING GEARCASE COVER
~'
Removal and Installation
e-----U­
':!
Remove the fuel injection pump. (See Page 7-39.) Remove the cylinder head, rocker arms and push rods. (See Page 7-45.)
I
Disconnect the two governor springs (Item 1 & 2) [A] from the fork lever (Item 3) [A].
I.
,7
Remove the speed control plate with the governor springs [B].
Remove the start spring (Item 1) [C] from the fork lever (Item 2) [C].
Installation: Be careful; do not drop the spring into the gearcase.
g

I! I
Remove the crankshaft pulley nut.
Installation: Tighten the (137-157 Nm) torque.
nut to 101-116 ft.-Ibs.
Use a puller and remove the crankshaft pulley [0].
Revised Oct. 95
-7-52­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
TIMING GEARCASE COVER (Cont'd)
A~
Removal and Installation (Cont'd)
l~
_
Remove the crankshaft pulley (Item 1) [A] and key (Item
2) [A]. Remove the bolts from the timing gearcase cover.
Installation: Tighten the bolts to 13-15 ft.-Ibs. (18-20 Nm) torque.
8-14339
Remove the timing gearcase cover [B].
Remove the crankshaft oil slinger (Item 1) [C], O-ring (Item 2) [C] and collar (Item 3) [Cl
Installation: Install new O-rings and oil seal into the timing gearcase cover [0].
NOTE: When a new timing gearcase cover is installed, to establish the 'correct position' of the injection pump fuel rack stop before removing it from the old timing gearcase cover, the distance from the machined surface of the gearcase (gasket surface) to the end of the stop should be measured. The stop should then be installed in the new gearcase and set to the same distance that was previously measured. Do not try to test operate the engine to establish if it has enough power. The adjustment must be set by a qualified service personnel for the injection pump. Revised Oct. 95
I
0
r--­
Oil Seal
~1iIiJo.
8-3617
-7-53­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
IDLER GEAR AND CAMSHAFT
A
Removal and Installation Remove the timing gearcase cover. (See Page 7-52.) Remove the snap ring (Item 3) [A] from the idler gear shaft (Item 1) [AJ.
Installation: Make sure the timing marks are in correct
alignment when installing the timing gears [A].
(1)ldle Gear (2) Idle Collar (3) External Snap Ring (4)Cam Gear (5) Camshaft
Remove the idler gear (Item 1) [8].
Remove the idler gear collar (Item 2) [8].
Remove the idler gear shaft mounting bolts.
Installation:Tighten the mounting bolts to 17-20 ft.-Ibs.
(23-27 Nm) torque. Align the holes on the camshaft gear with the camshaft
retainer plate bolts.
Remove the bolts.
Installation: Tighten the camshaft retainer bolts to
17-20 ft.-Ibs. (23-27 Nm) torque.
c
Remove the camshaft from the engine block [C].
® 8-3655
Installation: Check the camshaft end play, if the clearance exceeds the allowable limit, replace the camshaft retainer plate [0].
ID
Camshaft End Play .. 0.003-0.009' (0.07-0,22 mm) Allowable Limit .......... 0.012' (0,3 mm)
0.003-0.009' (0,07-0,22 mm) P1-1Q002
Revised Oct. 95
-7-54-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
IDLER GEAR AND CAMSHAFT (Cont'd)
A
Servicing the Camshaft
Measure the camshaft bearing in the engine block [A).
o
8-3620
Measure the camshaft journal [8J.
B
Calculate the oil clearance. If the clearance exceeds the allowable limit, replace the camshaft. Bearing 1.0. . .... 1.575-1.576' (40,0-40,03 mm) Journal 0.0..... 1.572-1.573' (39,93-39,95 mm) Oil Clearance of Camshaft Journal ....... 0.002-0.004' (0,05-0,09 mm)
Allowable Limit .......... 0.006' (0,15 mm)
A-2761
Measure the cam lobes at their highest point [C).
c
If the measurement is less than the allowable limit, replace the camshaft. Cam Lob Height ......... 1.318' (33,47 mm)
Allowable Limit ......... 1.316' (33,42 mm)
8-5001
Put the camshaft in V-blocks. Install a dial indicator [D). Turn the camshaft at a slow rate. If the misalignment exceeds the allowable limit, replace the camshaft. Camshaft Alignment Allowable Limit ..... 0.003' (0,08 mm)
Added Oct. 95
-7-55­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
IDLER GEAR AND CAMSHAFT (Cont'd)
A
Servicing the Idler Gear and Shaft Measure the 0.0. of the idler gear shaft [A].
~
Measure the 1.0. of the idler gear bushing [AJ. If the clearance exceeds the allowable limit, replace the bushing. Idler Gear Shaft 0.0. 1.258-1.259' (31,96-31,97 Idler Gear Bushing 1.0. 1.259-1.261' (32,(}-32,03 Clearance between Idler Shaft & Gear Busing .... 0.001-0.003' (0,025-0,07 Allowable limit .......... 0.004' (0,1
mm) mm) mm)
mm)
To replace the idler gear bushing, make a driver tool as shown in figure [8].
PI-10003
B 1.575' (40 mil
r-
1.378' (35 mm)
m£-i1l
6.3S' (162 1 575' (40 mm)
[c= 1.413-1.415' (35,9-35,95 mm)
~
I I [] J
I 1.258-1.259' . (31,96-31,97 mm)
IMC-1366
Use a press and special driver tool, to remove the old bushing and install the new bushing [C].
C
I
PI_1fV'1l'lii.
750 Series Loader Added Oct. 95
-7-56-
Service Manual
TIMING GEARS
A
Checking Backlash When the gears are installed, check the backlash of the gears. Install a dial indicator [OJ. Hold one gear while turning the other gear [0]. If the backlash exceeds the allowable limit, check the oil clearance of the shaft and gear. If the oil clearance is correct, replace the gear. Crank Gear & Idler Gear . 0.002-0.004' (0,042-0,112) Allowable Limit .......... -.006' (0,15 mm) Cam Gear & Idler GearO.002-o.005' (0,042-0,115 mm) Allowable Limit .......... 0.006' (0,15 mm) Injection Pump Gear & Idler Gear .... 0.002-0.005'
(0,042-0,115 mm)
Allowable Limit .......... 0.006' (0,15 mm)
Oil Pump Gear & Idler 0.002-0.004' (0,042-0,109 mm) Allowable Limit .......... 0.006' (0,15 mm)
Added Oct. 95
-7-57-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
FUEL CAMSHAFT
e
A
Removal and Installation
((J
Remove the timing gearcase cover. (See Page 7-52.) Remove the idler gear. (See Page 7-54.)
«0
Remove the bolt (Item 1) [A] from the retainer plate (Item 2) [A].
rr
Installation: lighten the bolt to 60-72 ft.-Ibs. (6,8-8,1 Nm) torque.
d I
Remove the fuel camshaft retainer plate (Item 2) [A].
8-14342
Remove the fuel camshaft and fork lever assembly (Item 1) [B] at the same time.
Governor The governor serves to keep the engine speed constant by automatically adjusting the amount of fuel supplied to the engine according to changes in the load. Disassemble and assemble the governor and fuel camshaft as shown in figure [C]. Check all the parts for wear or damage and replace as needed.
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. 13.
Start Spring Governor Spring Governor Spring Fork Lever Fork Lever Fork Lever Shaft Fork Lever Holder Governor Lever Fuel Camshaft Governor Ball Case Steel Balls Governor Sleeve Steel Ball PI-100OS
Added Oct_ 95
-7-58-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
CRANKSHAFT GEAR
Removal and Installation Remove the timing gearcase cover. (See Page 7-52.)
Remove the idler gear. (See Page 7-5.).
Remove the crankshaft gear with a puller [A].
Remove the crankshaft key.
Installation: Install the crankshaft key. Heat the
crankshaft gear to 176°F (80°C) and fit it on the crankshaft. 8-3686
OIL PUMP Removal and Installation Remove the timing gearcase cover. (See Page 7-52.) Remove the crankshaft gear. Remove the nut from the oil pump shaft. Use a puller to remove the oil pump gear (Item 1) [8]. Remove the oil pump mounting bolts. Remove the oil pump (Item 2) [8).
Installation: Tighten the oil pump mounting bolts to 60-72 in.-Ibs. (6,9-8,1 Nm) torque.
Oil Pump Service Measure the clearance between the lobes of the inner rotor and outer rotor [C]. .
Measure the clearance between the outer rotor and pump body [0]. If the clearance exceeds the allowable limit, replace the oil pump. Clearance Between Inner & Outer Rotor .... 0.004-0.006' (0,10-0,16 mm) Allowable Limit .......... 0.008' (0,2 mm) Clearance Between Outer Rotor & Body ....... 0.004-0.008' (0,11-0,19 mm) Allowable Limit .......... 0.010' (0,25 mm)
Added Oct. 95
-7-59­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
OIL PUMP (Cont'd)
A
Oil Pump Service (Cont'd)
Put a piece of press gauge on the rotor face [A].
Install the cover and tighten the bolts.
Remove the cover carefully. Measure the width of the
press gauge [A]. If the clearance exceeds the allowable limit replace the oil
pump.
End Clearance .... 0.004-0.006' (0,11-0,15 mm)
Allowable Limit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.008' (0,2 mm)
Checking Engine Oil Pressure
Remove the oil pressure sensor.
Install a pressure gauge [8].
Start the engine and run until it is at operating
temperature. If the oil pressure is less than the allowable limit, check the following items:
--.. .I
,. Engine Oil Level Low * Oil Pump Defective * Oil Galley Plugged * Oil Strainer Plugged ,. Excessive Clearance at the Rod & Main Bearings * Relief Valve Stuck
P1-10010
At Idle Speed Allowable Limit .... 7 PSI (49 kPa)
c
At Rated Speed ...... 43-65 PSI (294-441 kPa)
Allowable Limit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36 PSI (245 kPa)
Relief Valve The relief valve prevents damage of the lubricating system due to high pressure. This relief valve is a ball type. Remove the valve seat (Item 2) [C], ball (Item 3) [C] and spring (Item 1.) [C]. Check the parts for wear or damage and replace as needed.
Added Oct. 95
-7-60-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
PISTON AND CONNECTING ROD
Removal and Installation
Remove the cylinder head. (See Page 7-44.)
Remove the top edge from the cylinder bore with a ridge
reamer.
Remove the oil pan.
Remove the oil pump strainer (Item 1) [A].
Turn the flywheel and put a pair of connecting rods at
bottom dead center.
Remove the connecting rod bolts.
IB
Installation:llghten the connecting rod bolts to the following torque:
W/O Flange Bolt ..... 27-30 ft.-1bs. (37-41 Nm)
W/Flange Bolt ...... 33-36 ft.-Ibs. (45-49 Nm)
Remove the rod cap and bearing [B].
Use a hammer handle and push the piston/connecting rod assembly out of the cylinder bore [B].
NOTE: Make sure the pistons are marked so they will be returned to the same cylinder bore.
Installation: Make sure the marks on the connecting rod and bearing are aligned when installing the bearing cap
IC
[C1· Repeat the procedure to remove the other piston/connecting rod assemblies from the engine block.
A-2903
Remove the piston rings [0].
[email protected]~
Remove the snap rings (Item 3) [0] and piston pin (Item 1) [0].
~~~o
Separate the piston (Item 2) [01 from the connecting rod (Item 4) [0].
G)---.O
~O
~ Added Oct. 95
0
-7-61­
~
Inl
0 8-3621
750 Series Loader Service Manual
PISTON AND CONNECTING ROD (Cont'd)
A
Removal and Installation (Cont'd)
Installation: When installing new rings, assemble the ring so the mark (Item 1) [A] near the gap faces the top of the piston. When installing the oil ring, place the expander jOint (Item 2) [A] on the opposite side of the oil ring gap (Item 3) [AJ.
P
~O ~
Installation: When reassembling, align the marks (Item 1) [8] on the connecting rod and piston (Item 2). Heatthe piston to 176-212°F. (80-100°C.) and tap the piston pin into position. Place the piston rings so that there are gaps every 120 degrees (Item 3, 4 & 5) [8] with no gap facing the piston pin in the cylinder.
riP (/
V
IPI-10015
IB
PHOO14
Servicing the Piston and Connecting Rod
Measure the 1.0. of the piston pin bore in both horizontal and vertical directions [C]. If the measurement exceeds the allowable limit, replace the piston. Piston Pin Bore 1.0.. 0.984-0.985' (25,0-25,013 mm) Allowable Limit ......... 0.986' (25,05 mm)
Measure the 0.0. of the piston pin (Item 1) [OJ.
D
Measure the 1.0. of the connecting rod small end (Item 2)
[0]. Calculate the oil clearance. If the clearance exceeds the allowable limit, replace the bushing. If it still exceeds the specifications, replace the piston pin. Piston Pin 0.0. , .. 0.984-0.985' (25,0-25,011 Bushing 1.0. . .... 0.985-0.986' (25,03--25,04 Oil Clearance between Piston Pin & Bushing .... 0.000S-O.0015' (0,014-0,038 Allowable Limit .......... 0.006' (0,15
mm) mm) mm) mm)
Service Replacement Part . . . . . . . . . . 0.0006-0.003' (0,015-0.07 mm) 8-3633
Added Oct. 95
-7-62-
750 Series Loader Service Manua'
PISTON AND CONNECTING ROD (Cont'd)
A
Servicing the Piston and Connecting Rod (Cont'd)
r
To replace the connecting rod small end bushing, make a driver tool as shown in figure [AJ.
Use a press and special driver tool to remove the small end bushing [B].
B
Installation: Clean the small end bushing and bore. Put oil on the bushing and press into the connecting rod until it is flush [B].
J. II
6.38 Inches {162 m~ 1.063 Inc~ (27m
.
.
r---­
'.
Itt:
r
r
I
PI-10016
IC
Install a new piston ring into the lower part of the cylinder bore. Measure the ring gap with a feeler gauge [C].
,
If the gap exceeds the allowable limit, replace the cylinder liner. Compression Ring Gap . 0.012-0.019' (0,3-0,5 mm) Oil Ring Gap ...... 0.010-0.016' (0,25-0,4 mm) Allowable Limit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.05' (1,25 mm)
a
o I
Remove the carbon from the ring grooves. Measure the clearance between the ring and groove with a feeler gauge [0].
n
o
o 8-3622
D
If the clearance exceeds the allowable limit, replace the piston. Compression Ring ......... 0.008' (0,2 mm)
Oil Ring ............. 0.006' (0,15 mm)
Added Oct. 95
-7-63­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
PISTON AND CONNECTING ROD (Cont'd)
A
Connecting Rod Alignment
NOTE: The small end bushing is the basis of this check, check the bushing for wear before doing this check. Install the piston pin into the connecting rod.
Install the connecting rod on an alignment tool.
Put the gauge over the piston pin and move it against the
face plate.
If the gauge does not fit squarely against the face plate, measure the space between the gauge and face plate
[A]. If the measurement exceeds the allowable limit, replace the connecting rod. Rod Alignment .......... 0.002' (0,05 mm)
·'~H~;
- n.1
Added Oct. 95
-7-64-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
CRANKSHAFT ANO BEARINGS Removal and Installation Remove the piston and connecting rod assemblies. (See Page 7-60.) Remove the engine flywheel. (See Page 7-33.) Remove the bolts which fasten the bearing case cover to the block.
Installation: lighten the bearing case cover bolts to 13-15 ft.-Ibs. (18-21 Nm) torque. Install two bolts into the bearing case cover and pull the cover out [A].
Installation: When installing the cover (Item 1) [B), make sure the casting mark (Item 2) [B] is in the down position.
Before removing the crankshaft/main bearings, check the end play. Install a dial indicator. Measure the end play by moving the crankshaft back and forth [C]. If the measurement exceeds the allowable limit, replace the thrust washers. End Play ....... 0.006-0.012' (0,15-0,31 mm)
Allowable Limit .......... 0.020' (0,5 mm)
Remove the main bearing case bolt (Item 1) [0].
Installation: Align the bearing case hole (Item 2) [0] with the hole in the block. Put oil on the bolt threads and tighten to 51-54 ft.-Ibs. (69-73 Nm) torque.
Added Oct. 95
-7~5-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
CRANKSHAFT AND BEARINGS (Cont'd)
Removal and Installation (Cont'd)
Remove the crankshafVmain bearing assembly from the
engine block [A].
Mark the bearing case halves for correct installation.
P1-10020
Remove the two bearing case bolts [BJ.
Remove the bearing case and bearing.
Installation: Tighten the bearing case bolts to 34-38
ft.-Ibs. (46-52 Nm) torque.
IC
Installation: When installing the main bearing case assemblies, face the mark FLYWHEEL to the flywheel side of the engine block [C]. Be sure the thrust washers with its oil grooves face outward.
P1-10021
Servicing the Crankshaft and Bearings
D
Put the crankshaft on V-blocks. Install a dial indicator on the center journal [0]. Turn the crankshaft at a slow rate.
If the misalignment exceeds the allowable limit, replace
the crankshaft.
Alignment ............ 0.003' (0,08 mm)
Added Oct. 95
-7-66­
750 Series Loader ServIce Manual
CRANKSHAFT AND BEARINGS (Cont'd)
A
Servicing the Crankshaft and Bearings (Cont'd)
Tighten the connecting rod cap bolts as follOWS:
W/O Flange Bolt ..... 27-30 ft.-Ibs. (37-41 Nm)
W/Flange Bolt ...... 33-36 ft. Ibs. (45-49 Nm) Measure the crankpin bearing I.D. [A].
A-2727
Measure the crankpin O.D. [B].
B
Calculate the oil clearance. Crankpin Bearing I.D. 1.850-1.852' (47,0-47,05 mm) Crankpin O.D. . ... 1.849-1.850' (49,96-46,98 mm) Oil Clearance ... 0.0009-0.003' (0,025-0,087 mm)
o ~ IL.
JI
A-2716
Check the wear on the crankshaft sleeve [C].
c
If the wear exceeds the allowable limit or the seal leaks
oil, replace the sleeve.
Wear of Sleeve .......... 0.004' (0,1 mm)
PI-10022
The special tool set will be needed to replace the crankshaft sleeve. The tool is available through Kubota, PIN 07916-32091.
ID
Remove the sleeve.
Install the sleeve guide (Item 1) [0] and stop (Item 2) [0].
Heat the sleeve to about 300°F (150°C). Install the sleeve
on the crankshaft using the special driver tool (Item 3) [0].
PH 0023
Added Oct. 95
-7-67-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
CRANKSHAFT AND BEARINGS (Cont'd)
A
Servicing the Crankshaft and Bearings (Cont'd) Measure the 1.0. of the No.1 crankshaft bearing [A].
8-3631
Measure the 0.0. of the crankshaft journal [B).
B
Calculate the oil clearance. If the clearance exceeds the allowable limit, replace the crankshaft bearing. Bearing 1.0. . .... 2.046-0.049' (51,98-52,04 Journal 0.0..... 2.044-2.045' (51,92-51,94 Oil Clearance ..... 0.002-0.005' (0,04-0,12 Allowable Limit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.008' (0,2
mm) mm) mm) mm)
To remove the front bearing make the tool as shown in figure [C].
c
il
8-3618
REMOVAL TOOL 5.31'(135mm)
l
A'
0.8' (20mm)
2.0413-2.0433' (51 ,85-51 ,90mm) ---.-
I
~
1­ 0.8'(20mm)
I
Jl
2.2382-2.2402' (56,85-56,90mm)
1.57'R (40mm)
MC-1367
o
To install the front bearing make the tool as shown in figure [0].
INSTALLATION TOO 0.35' (9mm)
0.8' (20mm) 2.2382-2.2402' (56,85-56,90mm)
j
0.8'(20mm)
1.57'R (40mm)
Added Oct. 95
-7-68-
0.4'j (10mm)
750 Series Loader Service Manual
CRANKSHAFT AND BEARINGS (Cont'd)
A
Servicing the Crankshaft and Bearings (Cont'd)
0.165-0.177 inch (4,2-4,5 mm)
Remove the front bearing (Item 1) [A] with the special removal tool.
Installation: Clean the new bearing and bore, put oil on them. Install the new bearing with the installation driver tool [A].
PI-10024
Clean the crankshaft journal and bearing. Put a strip of press gauge on the center journal. Install the main bearing case halves and tighten the bolts. Remove the bearing case halves. Measure the flattened press gauge [B]. If the clearance exceeds the allowable limit, replace the crankshaft bearing. Crankshaft Journal O.D........ 2.044-2.045'
(51,92-51,94 mm) Bearing I.D. . .... 2.046-2.048' (51,98-52,03 mm) Oil Clearance ..... 0.002-0.004' (0,04-0,10 mm) Allowable Limit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.008' (0,2 mm)
Added Oct. 95
-7-69-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
CYLINDER BORE
A
Checking the Cylinder Bore
Use a gauge to check the inside measurement of the cylinder bore [A].
8-4066
Mea:;ure the six points as shown in figure [B] to find the maximum wear.
IB
The specifications is 3.425-3.426' (87,0-87,02 mm). The wear limit is +0.006' (+0,15 mm). If the cylinder bore is not within specifications, re-bore the cylinder for oversized piston.
A-2717
Added Oct. 95
-7-70-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
WATER PUMP
A
Disassembly and Assembly Remove the water pump from the timing gearcase cover
[A].
Put the water pump in a vise and remove the nut [B].
B
Remove the pulley using a puller. Remove the key and snap ring.
@
~!) 8-5324
Drive the shaft out of the impeller side of the water pump housing [C].
IC
1
4J 6-5325
Install the new seals [0]. Install the shaft.
D
Installation: Put the water pump in a vise and tighten the nut to 50-57 ft.-Ibs. (68-77 Nm) torque. Always use a new gasket when installing the water pump on the timing gearcase cover.
A-2783
Added Oct. 95
-7-71­
750 Series Loader Service Manual
lenuew
a~!IJas
J8pe01 S8!J8S OSlo
SPECIFICATIONS
Page Number DECIMAL & MILLIMETER EQUIVALENTS
Chart ............................ 8-15
ENGINE SPECIFICATIONS Camshaft .......................... Connecting Rod . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Crankshaft .......................... Crankshaft Re-Grind Data ................... Cylinders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cylinder Head ........................ Fuel Injector Nozzle ...................... Fuel Injection Pump ...................... Oil Pump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Pistons ........................... Piston Rings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Rocker Arms ......................... Tappet ............................ Thermostat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Timing Gear ......................... Torque for General Metric Bolts ................. Valves ............................ Valve Spring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Valve Timing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
8-8
8-9
8-8
8-10
8-8
8-7
8-7
8-7
8-8 ' 8-8
8-8
8-7
8-8
8-9
8-9
8-11
8-7
8-7
8-7
HYDRAULIC/HYDROSTATIC FLUID SPECIFICATIONS
Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-13
LOADER SPECIFICATIONS-753
Capacities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Drive System ......................... Electrical . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Hydraulic System ....................... Loader Dimensions ..................... ' Operation & Performance ................... Tires. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
8--4 8--4
8--4 8-3
8--4
8-3
8-3
8--4
LOADER SPECIFICATIONS-753H
Capacities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Drive System ......................... Electrical . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Engine ............................ Hydraulic System ....................... Loader Dimensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Operation & Performance ................... Tires. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
8-6 8-6 8-6 8-5 8-6 8-5 8-5 8-6
SPECIFICATION
U.S. TO METRIC CONVERSION
Chart ............................ 8-15
STANDARD TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS FOR BOLTS
Chart ............................ 8-14
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS FOR LOADER
Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-12
-8-1-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
,enuew 8l)!'Jes J8pe01 S8!J8S
OSL
'1
LOADER SPECIFICATIONS
• Dimensions are given for loader equipped with standard tires and dirt bucket. Dimensions may vary with other types. All dimensions are shown in inches. Respective metric dimensions are given in millimeters enclosed by parentheses.
LOADER DIMENSIONS
• Where applicable, specifications conform to SAE standards and are subject to change without notice.
/l1~
//


//
->~ip; r: Ii'
'r
~
I
I I
;:! ,1« /-'/
.
f
97°
1(1400)1 ~I
.-' .'1'. I
,II A /1 ' '1 40'1 •....
55.12
139.95 (3555)
109.4
I
69.70 (1770'-1-1_ _ _ _ _ _-1
(2779)
1
86.30
f
(2192)
76.08 (1932)
I
I·•
96.02
(2439~
-I
(~J
_ _ _ _ 121.0$ (3075)
MC-1113
This loader was designed without counterweights or ballasts. Changes of structure or weight distribution of the loader can cause changes in control and steering response and can cause failure of the loader parts. OPERATIONS & PERFORMANCE
Weights Operating Weight ......... . Rated Operating Capcity ...... . Tipping Load ........... .
4732Ibs. (2148 kg) 1300 Ibs. (590 kg) 2600lbs. (1180 kg)
Travel Speed ............ .
Infinitely variable 0-6.0 MPH (9.7 kmlhr.)
Controls Vehicle .............. . Loader Function .......... . Engine Main Drive ............ . Parking Brake ........... .
Direction & speed controlled by two hand levers. Lift, tilt function controlled by separate foot pedals. Auxiliary functions controlled by electrical push buttons on steering levers Hand lever throttle; key-type starter switch; Hydrostatic Mechanical disc, foot Qperated pedal
ENGINE Make ............... . Model .............. . Fuel ............... . Horsepower ............ . Maximum Governed RPM ...... . Torque .............. . Number of Cylinders ........ . Bore/Stroke ............ . Displacement ........... . Cooling System .......... . Lubrication ............ . Crankcase Ventilation ........ . Air Cleaner ............ . Ignition .............. . Low Idle ............. . Idle ............. .
Kubota V2203-TV-8-Melroe-1 Diesel 40 HP (30 kw) 2400 RPM 102.5 ft.-Ibs. (139Nm) @ 1600 RPM Four 3.43/3.64(87/92.5) 134.0 cu.in. (2197 cu. cm.) Liquid Pressure System W/Filter External Dry replaceable cartridge. dual safety element Diesel-Compression 1150RPM 2460-2600 RPM
-8-3-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
LOADER SPECIFICATIONS (Cont'd) HYDRAULIC SYSTEM Pump ............... . Pump Capacity .......... . System Main Relief ......... . Filter ............... .
Engine driven gear type 13.0 GPM (49,2 Umin.) @ 2480 RPM @ 1150 PSI (7929 kPa) 2550-2600PSI (17582-17927 kPa) @ Quick Couplers Full flow replaceable #3 micron synthetic medial element
Hydraulic Cylinders
Doubleacting
Bore Diameter: Lift Cylinder (2) lilt Cylinder (1) Rod Diameter: Lift Cylinder (2) Tilt Cylinder (1) Stroke: Lift Cylinder (2) lilt Cylinder (1) Control Valve ........... . Fluid Lines ............ .
2.00(50,8) 3.25(82,6) 1.25(31,8) 1.50(38,1) 26.32(669) 14.50(368) 3-spool, open center, series type Wlfloat detent on lift & electrical controlled auxiliary SAE standard tubes, hoses & fittings
Hydraulic Function Time: Raise Lift Arms to Maximum Height .. Lower Lift Arms from Maximum Height . Move Empty Bucket to Dump Position . Move Bucket to Retracted Position .. Fluid Type ............. .
3.5 Seconds 2.8 Seconds 2.8 Seconds 2.0 Seconds Bobcat Fluid (PIN 6563328) If fluid is not available, use 1OW-30/1 OW-40 Class SE Motor Oil for temperatures above O°F. (-18°C) & 5W-30 Motor Oil for temoeratures below O°F
ELECTRICAL Alternator ............. . Battery .............. . Starter .............. .
Belt drive, 55 amps. Open 12 volt, 625 cold crank amps. @ O°F (-18°C) 160 min. reserve capacity 12 volt, 2.75 HP (2,8 kW)
DRIVE SYSTEM Transmission ........... . Final Drive ............ . Total Engine to Wheel Reduction
Tandem hydro. pumps infinitely variable, driving 2 fully reversing hydrostatic motors #80 HS roller chain & sprockets in sealed chaincase with oil lubrication 42:09:1
CAPACITIES Cooling System .......... . Fuel ............... . Engine Oil W/Filter ......... . Hydraulic Reservoir ......... . Hydraulic/Hydrostatic System .... . Chaincase Reservoir ........ .
13qts. (12,3L) 14 gals. (53 L) 7.5 qts. (7,1 L) 14 qts. (13,2 L) 6 gals. (22,7 L) 8 gals. (30,3 L)
TIRES Standard ............. . Pressure ............. . Flotation ............. . Pressure ............. . Flotation ............. . Pressure ............. .
7:00-15,6 Ply Rating, Nylon W/Bar Lug Tread 45-50 PSI (310-345 kPa) 10:00-16.5,6 Ply Rating, Nylon W/SureGrip Lug 45 PSI (310 kPa) 10:00-16.5,8 Ply Rating, Nylon W/Sure Grip Lug 55 PSI (379 kPa)
-8-4-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
LOADER SPECIFICATIONS
• Dimensions are given for loader equipped with standard tires and dirt bucket. Dimensions may vary with other types. All dimensions are shown in inches. Respective metric dimensions are given in millimeters enclosed by parentheses.
LOADER DIMENSIONS
• Where applicable, specifications conform to SAE standards and are subject to change without notice.
F~
,' J.
,ll,' 'i '., i~

k:/
.
.'
f
139.95 (3555)
'il'r
~I
'(.-
f, .
I
i
i'
'
40'
109.4 (2779)
I :
.' .I
.
: f
21.80 554
~1', ,lJh' '0/ ,I
f
(1' ~
76.08 (1932)
.
.J --I---r
''--'~
45° 35.2 (894)
~....~
~
I-
59.74 (1517)
I
'~
-
86.30 (2192)

'',
96.02 (2439',
69.70 (1770hll-l_ _ _ _ _ _-,
'<:.~
1-',1
1•
r-(~~~)I
•.,>,-< v·1t
32.5 (826)
J
(159) 6.25
-I 121.05 (3075)
MC-1113
This loader was designed without counterweights or ballasts. Changes of structure or weight distribution of the loader can cause changes in control and steering response and can cause failure of the loader parts. 753H
OPERATIONS & PERFORMANCE
Weights Operating Weight ......... . Rated Operating Capacity ...... .
Tipping Load ........... .
47321bs. (2148 kg)
1300 Ibs. (590 kg)
2600lbs. (1180kg)
Travel Speed ............ .
Infinitely variable 0-6.0 MPH (9,7 kmlhr.)
Controls Vehicle .............. . Loader Function .......... .
Engine .............. . Main Drive ............ .
Parking Brake ........... .
Direction & speed controlled by two hand levers.
Lift. tilt function controlled by separate fool pedals. Auxiliary functions controlled by electlical push buttons on steering levers Hand lever throttle; key-type starter switch
Hydrostatic
Mechanical disc, foot operated pedal
ENGINE Make ............... . Model .............. .
Fuel ............... .
Horsepower ............ .
Maximum Governed RPM ...... .
Torque .............. .
Number of Cylinders ........ .
Bore/Stroke ............ .
Displacement ........... .
Cooling System .......... .
Lubrication ............ .
Crankcase Ventilation ........ .
Air Cleaner ............ .
Ignition .............. .
Low Idle ............. .
High Idle ............. .
Kubota
V2202-TV-8-Melroe-1
Diesel
40HP (30kW)
2400 RPM
102.5ft.-lbs. (139 Nm) @ 1600 RPM
Four
3.4313.64 (87/92.5) 134.0 cu. in. (2197 cu. cm.)
Liquid
Pressure System W/Filter
Extemal
Dry replaceable cartridge. dual safety element
Diese~ompression
1150RPM
2460-2600 RPM
-8-5-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
753H
LOADER SPECIFICATIONS (Cont'd) HYDRAULIC SYSTEM Pump ............... . Pump Capacity .......... . Hi Flow Pump Capacity ....... . System Main Relief ......... . Hi Flow Main Relief ......... . Filter ............... .
Engine driven gear type 13.0 GPM (49,2 Umin.) @ 2480 RPM @ 1150 PSI (7929 kPa) 21.7GPM (82,1 Umin.) @ 2480 RPM @ 1150PSI (7929kPa) 2550-2600PSI (17582-17927 kPa) @ Quick Couplers 3550-3600PSI (24477-24822 kPa) @ Quick Couplers Full flow replaceable #3 micron synthetic medial element
Hydraulic Cylinders ......... .
Doubleacting
Bore Diameter: Lift Cylinder (2) Tilt Cylinder (1) Rod Diameter: Lift Cylinder (2) Tilt Cylinder (1) Stroke: Lift Cylinder (2) Tilt Cylinder (1) Control Valve ........... . Fluid Lines ............ .
2.00(50,8) 3.25(82,6) 1.25(31,8) 1.50(38,1) 26.32(669) 14.50(368) 3-spool, open center, series type W/float detent on lift &electrical controlled auxiliary SAE standard tubes, hoses &fittings
Hydraulic Function Time: Raise Lift Arms to Maximum Height .. Lower Lift Arms from Maximum Height . Move Empty Bucket to Dump Position . Move Bucket to Retracted Position .. Fluid Type ............. .
3.5 Seconds 2.8 Seconds 2.8 Seconds 2.0 Seconds Bobcat Fluid (PIN 6563328) Iffluid is not available, use 1OW-30/1 OW-40 Class SE Motor Oil for temperatures above O°F. (-18°C) & 5W-30 Motor Oil for temperatures below O°F (-18°C).
ELEC''!CAL Alter ............. . Battt •••••••••••••••••••••• , •••• 3tan, ............. .
Belt drive, 55 amps. Open 12 volt, 625 cold crank amps. @ O°F (-18°C) 160 min. reserve capacity 12 volt, 2.75 HP (2,8 kW)
DRIVE SYSTEM Transmission ........... . Final Drive ............ . Total Engine to Wheel Reduction ... . Filters .............. .
Tandem hydro. pumps infinitely variable, driving 2 fully reversing hydrostatic motors #80 HS roller chain & sprockets in sealed chaincase with oil lubrication 42:09:1 Case Drain 90 Micron
CAPACITIES Cooling System .......... . Fuel ............... . Engine Oil W/Filter ......... . Hydraulic Reservoir ......... . HydrauliclHydrostatic System .... . Chaincase Reservoir ........ .
13qts. (12,3 L) 14 gals. (53 L) 7.5 qts. (7,1 L) 14qts. (13,2 L) 6 gals. (22,7 L) 8 gals. (30,3 L)
TIRES Standard ............. . Pressure ............. . Flotation ............. . Pressure ............. . Flotation ............. . Pressure ............. .
7:00-15, 6 Ply Rating, Nylon W/Bar Lug Tread 45--50 PSI (310-345 kPa) 10:00-16.5,6 Ply Rating, Nylon W/Sure Grip Lug 45 PSI (310 kPa) 10:00-16.5, 8 Ply Rating, Nylon W/Sure Grip Lug 55 PSI (379 kPa)
750 Series Loader -8-6-
Service Manual
ENGINE SPECIFICATIONS All dimensions are given in inches. Respective metric dimensions are given in millimeters enclosed by parentheses.
Fuel Injection Nozzles Opening Pressure ............................ 1990-2133 PSI (13721-14707 kPa)
Fuel Tightness Nozzle Seat ...................... , . Dry Nozzle at 1849 PSI (12749 kPa)
Fuel Injection Pump Fuel Tightness Plunger ...... ' ......... 10 sec: initial pressure 2133-1990 PSI (14707-13721 kPa)
Limit Permitted. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 seconds Injection Timing .................................. 17-19 degrees B.T.D.C.
High Idle ........................................ 2460-2600 RPM
Low Idle ........................................ 850-1000 RPM
Cylinder Bore 1.0. of Bore ................................. 3.4252-3.4261 (87,0-87,022)
Allowable Limit ......... , ............................. +0.006 (+0,15)
Cylinder Head Cylinder Head Surface Distortion ............................. 0.002 (0,05) Max.
Thickness of Gasket (Used) ........................... 0.0453-0.0492 (1,15-1,25)
(New) ............................. 0.0512-0.0551 (1,3-1,4)
Top Clearance (Piston to Head) .......................... 0.0217-0.0276 (0,55-0,70)
Compression ................................ 421-469 PSI (2903-3234 kPa)
Allowable Limit .................................... 327 PSI (2255 kPa)
Difference Between Cylinders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10% Valves Valve Seat Width . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.0835 (2,12) Valve Seat Angle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 degrees 0.0. of Valve Stems ............................... 0.3134-0.3142 (7,96-7,98)
1.0. of Valve Guides .............................. 0.3156-0.3161 (8,016-8,03) Clearance Between Valve Stem & Guide ...................... 0.0016-0.0026 (0,04-0,07) Allowable Limit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.0039 (0,1) . Valve Clearance (Cold) ...................... ; ........ 0.007-0.0087 (0,18-0,22) Valve Recessing (Protrusion) ................................. 0.002 (0,05)
(Recess) ................................... 0.06 (0,15)
Valve Springs Free Length .................................... 1.64-1.66 (41,7-42,2)
Allowabre Limit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.62 (41,2)
Fitted Length ........................................ 1.378 (35,0)
Compress to Fitted Length ................................ 26.4Ibs. (117,6 N)
Allowable Limit ..................................... 22.5 Ibs. (100,0 N)
Inclination Allowable Limit ................................... 0.006 (0,15)
Valve Timing Intake Valve (Open) .................................. (Close) .................................. Exhaust Valve (Open) ................................. (Close) .................................
12 degrees 36 degrees 60 degrees 12 degrees
B.T.D.C.
A.T.D.C.
B.T.D.C.
A.T.D.C.
Rocker Arms
0.0. of Rocker Arm Shaft ........................... 0.5501-0.5506 (13,97-13,99)
1.0. of Rocker Arm Bushings ........................... 0.5513-0.5529 (14,0-14,04)
Clearance Between Rocker Arm & Bushing ..................... 0.0007-0.0026 (0,02-0,06)
Allowable Limit ........................................ 0.006(0,15)
-8-7-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
ENGINE SPECIFICATIONS (Cont'd) All dimensions are given in inches. Respective metric dimensions are given in millimeters enclosed by parentheses.
Camshaft Journal 0.0................................. 1.5722-1.5728 (39.934-39,95) Bearing 1.0. . ................................. 1.5748-1.5758 (40,Q-40,025) Oil Clearance .................................. 0.002-0.0036 (0,05-0,091) Allowable Limit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.006 (0,15) Alignment Allowable Limit ................................... 0.003 (0,08) Cam Lobe Height. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.318 (33,47) Allowable Limit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.316 (33,42) End Clearance ................................. 0.0028-0.0087 (0,07-0,22) Allowable Limit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.012 (0,3) Tappet Clearance Between Tappet & Guide ....................... 0.0008-0.0024 (0,02-0,061)
Tappet 0.0................................. 0.9433-0.9441 (23,959-23,98)
Tappet Guide 1.0............................... 0.9449-0.9457 (24,0-24,021)
Cylinders Cylinder Bore 1.0. . ............................... 3.425-3.426 (87,00-87,022)
Allowable Limit ...................................... +0.006 (+0,15)
Piston Rings Ring Gap (Top & 2nd Ring) ............ : ................. 0.012-0.018 (0,3-0,45) Limit Permitted. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.05 (1,25) Ring Gap (Oil Ring) ................................. 0.010-0.016 (0,25-0,4) Limit Permitted. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.05 (1,25) Side Clearance of Ring Groove: Top Ring ........................................ Zero Clearance
Second Ring ................................. 0.0037-0.0047 (0,094-0,12)
Oil Ring .................................... 0.0008-0.002 (0,02-0,051)
Pistons Piston Pin Bore ................................ 0.9843-0.9848 (25,0-25.014) Limit Permitted. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.9862 (25,05) Connecting Rod Piston Pin 0.0................................ 0.9843-0.9847 (25,0-25,011)
Small End Bushing 1.0............................. 0.9852-0.9858 (25,025-25,04)
Clearance Between Piston Pin & Small End Bushing ................ 0.0006-0.0015 (0,015-0,038)
Service Replacement Part .......................... 0.0006-0.003 (0,015-0,07 mm)
Connecting Rod Alignment Limit Permitted ............................ 0.002 (0,05)
Oil Pump Oil Pressure Rated RPM ............................. 43-64 PSI (294-441 kPa)
Limited Permitted .................................... 36 PSI (248 kPa)
Idle Speed ........................................ 14 PSI (98 kPa)
Limit Permitted ...................................... 7 PSI (49 kPa) Clearance Between Inner Rotor & Outer Rotor .................... 0.0039-0.0063 (0,1-0,16) Limit Permitted. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.008 (0,2) Outer Rotor & Pump Bocy ............................ 0.0043-0.0075 (0,11-0,19)
Limited Permitted ...................................... 0.001 (0,25) End Clearance Between Inner Rotor & Cover ................... 0.0041-0.0059 (0,103-0,15) Limit Permitted. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.008 (0,2) -8-8-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
ENGINE SPECIFICATIONS (Cont'd) All dimensions are given in inches. Respective metric dimensions are given in millimeters enclosed by parentheses.
Crankshaft Crankshaft Alignment Limit Permitted ............................. 0.0031 (0,08) Oil Clearance Between Journal & Bearing #1 .................... 0.0016-0.0046 (0,04-0,117) Limit Permitted. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.008 (0,2) Journal 0.0. #1 ............................... 2.0441-2.0449 (51,921[51,94) Bearing 1.0. #1 ................................ 2.0465-2.0488 (51,98-52,04) Oil Clearance Between Journal & Bearing #2 .................... 0.0016-0.0041 (0,04--0,104) Limit Permitted. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.008 (0,2) Journal 0.0. #2 ................................ 2.0441-2.0449 (51,92-51,94) Bearing 1.0. #2 ................................ 2.0465-2.0482 (51,98-52,02) Oil Clearance Between Crank Pin & Bearing ................... 0.0009--0.0034 (0,023-0,086) Limit Permitted. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.008 (0,2) Crank Pin 0.0................................. 1.8488-1.8492 (46,96-46,97) Crank Pin Bearing 1.0. . ............................ 1.8504-1.8522 (47,0-47,046) Crankshaft Side Clearance ............................ 0.0059--0.0122 (0,15-0,31) Limit Permitted. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.020 (0,5)
Timing Gear Timing Gear Backlash
Crank Gear-Idle Gear ............................ 0.0016-0.0044 (0,041-0,112) Idle Gear-Cam Gear ............................ 0.0016-0.0045 (0,041-0,114) Idle Gear-Injection Pump Gear ........................ 0.0016-0.0046 (0,041-0,117) Idle Gear- Oil Pump Gear .......................... 0.0016-0.0043 (0,041-0,109) Limit Permitted ...................................... 0.006 (0,15) Clearance Between Idle Gear Shaft & Idle Gear Bushing .............. 0.001-0.0026 (0,025-0,066) Limit Permitted. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.004 (0,10) Idler Gear Side Clearance Idler Gear. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.008-0.020 (0,2-0,51)
Thermostat Valve Opening Temperature .............................. 157-163°F (7Q-73°C)
Valve Fully Open .......................... ~ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185°F (85°C)
750 Series Loader
-8-9-
Service Manual
ENGINE SPECIFICATIONS (Cont'd) Crankshaft Re-Grind Data
if the standard size bearing cannot be employed due to excessive wear of the crankpin and crank journal use undersize or oversize bearings. For undersize or oversize bearing use, follow the precautions noted below. Grind the crankpin and journal with a wheel which has specified round corner and width without shoulder [A]. 1. 0.1299-0.1457' (3,3-3,7 mm) 2. 0.1102-0.1260' (2,8-3,2 mm) 3. Be sure to chamfer the oil hole circumference to 0.04-0.06' (1,0-1,5 mm) radius with and oil stone. 4. The crankpin must be fine finished to higher than (0,4-5). 5. The crank journal must be fine-finished to higher than (0,4-5). 6. The crank journal side surface must be fine-finished to higher than (1,6-5).
SIZE -0.008' (0,2 mm)
CODE NO.
NAME OF BEARING
BEARING MARK CRANKSHAFT PROCESSING DIM.
17331-2391-1
Crankshaft Bearing 1 0.008' minus (0,2 minus)
-0.008' (0,2 mm)
17331-2393-1
Crankshaft Bearing 2 0.008' minus (0,2 minus)
020 US
-0.016' (0,4 mm)
17331-2392-1
Crankshaft Bearing 1 0.016' minus (0,4 minus)
040 US
-0.016' (0,4 mm)
17331-2394-1
Crankshaft Bearing 2 0.016' minus (0,4 minus)
040 US
-0.008' (0,2 mm)
17331-2297-1
Crank Pin Bearing 0.008' minus (0,2 minus)
020 US
17331-2298-1
Crank Pin Bearing 0.016' minus (0,4 minus)
040 US
15221-2395-1
Thrust Bearing 1 - 0.008' plus (0,2 mm plus)
020 US
19202-2397-1
Thrust Bearing 2 - 0.008' plus (0,2 mm plus)
15221-2396-1
Thrust Bearing 1 - 0.016' plus (0,4 mm plus)
19202-2398-1
Thrust Bearing 2 - 0.016' plus (0,4 mm plus)
020 US 2.0363-2.037' (51,721-51,74 mm)
A 2.0284-2.0291 ' (51,521-51.54 mm) 1 .8409-1.8415' (46,759-46,775 mm)
B -0.016' (0,4 mm) +0.008' (+0,2 mm)
1 .8330-1 .8337' (46,559-46,575 mm)
1 .8330-1 .8337' (46,559-46,575 mm)
C +0.016' (+0,4 mm)
-8-10-
040 US
1.0315-1.0335' (26,20-25,25 mm)
750 Series Loader Service Manual
ENGINE SPECIFICATIONS (Cont'd) Torque For General Metric Bolts Material Thread Size (Dia. x Pitch)
Head Mark 4
Head Mark 7
Head Mark 10
M 5 x 0.8
3-4 ft.-Ibs. (4-5 Nm)
M 6 x 1.0
6-7 ft.-Ibs. (8-9 Nm)
6-9 ft.-Ibs.
I
i
(8-12 Nm)
M 8 x 1.25
6-9 ft.-Ibs. (8-12 Nm)
11-16 ft.-Ibs. (15-22 Nm)
18-25 ft.-Ibs. (24-34 Nm)
M 10 x 1.25
13-18 ft.-Ibs. (18-24 Nm)
22-30 ft.-Ibs. (30--41 Nm)
36-50 ft.-Ibs. (49-68 Nm)
M 12 x 1.25
22-30 ft.-Ibs. (30--41 Nm)
40-54 ft.-Ibs. (54-73 Nm)
69-87 ft.-Ibs. (94-118 Nm)
M 14 x 1.25
36-50 ft.-Ibs. (49-68 Nm)
58-80 ft.-Ibs. (79-108 Nm)
116-137 ft.-Ibs. (157-186 Nm)
-
--8-11-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS FOR LOADER
Specifications Item
Ft.-Lbs.
Air Cleaner Mounting Bolts .......................... .
Alternator Pulley Nut ............................. .
Axle Hub Mounting Bolt ............................ .
Axle Sprocket Bolt .............................. .
25-28 50 575-625 220-245
34-38
68
780-848
298-332
Bob-Tach Pivot Pin Bolts ........................... .
Bob-Tach Lever Pivot Bolt ........................... .
Brake Block Mounting Bolts .......................... .
Brake Lever Bolt ............................... .
Brake Pad Mounting Bolts ........................... .
135-140 25-28 65-70 65-70 65-70
183-190
34-38
88-95
88-95
88-95
Camshaft Retainer Plate Bolts ......................... . Centering Spring Bolt ............................. . Chaincase to Main Frame Bolts & Nuts ..................... . Connecting Rod Bolts: W/O Flange ................................ .
W/Flange ................................. .
Control Pedal Linkage Bolts .......................... .
Control Valve Mounting Bolts & Nuts ...................... .
Crankshaft Pulley Nut ............................. .
Cylinder Head Bolts ............................. .
17-20 25-28 90-100
23-27
34-38
122-136
27..30 33-36 21..25 15-16 101-116 67-72
37-41
45-49
28-34
20-22
137-157
91-98
Flywheel Bolts ................................ .
Front Panel Bolts ............................... .
Fuel Camshaft Retainer Plate Bolts ....................... .
83-90 16-20 5-6
113-122
22-27
6,8-8,1
Glow Plug .................................. .
15-18
20-24
Hydraulic Reservoir Strap Bolts ........................ .
Hydraulic Filter Housing Mounting Bolts ..................... .
Hydrostatic Motor Mounting Bolts ........................ .
Hydrostatic Pump Mounting Bolts ........................ .
Hydrostatic Pump Pulley Bolt ......................... .
16-20 25 65-70 65-70 175-200
22-27
34
88-95
88-95
237-271
Idler Gear Shaft Bolts ............................. .
Injection Pump Mounting Bolts & Nuts ...................... .
Injection Nozzles ............................... .
Injector Nozzle Body ............................. .
17-20 17-20 36-51 43-58
23-27
23-27
46-69
59-79
Main Bearing Case Bolt ............................ .
Main Bearing Case Half Bolts ......................... .
Main Relief Valve ............................... .
Motor Carrier Mounting Bolts .......................... .
51-54 34-38 35-40 125-140
69-73
46-52
47-54
170-190
Operator Cab Fastening Nuts (Front) ...................... .
Operator Cab Pivot Bolts & Nuts ........................ .
40-50 25-35
54-68
34-47
Pedal Lock Linkage to Main Frame Bolts .................... .
Pedal Lock Linkage Tab Bolt .......................... .
Pintle Arm Bolt ................................ .
Pintle Arm Lobe Bolt ............................. .
Pintle Bar Bolts ............................... .
Pivot Pins Lock Bolt & Nut ........................... .
7-8 25 40-50 25-28 28 18-20
9,5-10,8 34
54-68
34-38
38
24-27
Rear Bearing Case Cover Bolts ........................ .
13-15
18-20
Seat Belt Fastening Bolts ........................... .
Seat Mounting Bolts ............................. .
Seat Bar Pivot Bolts ............................. .
Steering Linkage Bolts ............................ .
Steering Linkage Lock Nuts .......................... .
40-45 9-11 25-28 23 23
54-61
12,2..15
34-38
31
31
liming Gearcase Cover Bolts ......................... .
13-17
18-23
Wheel Nuts ................................. .
105-115
142-156
~12-
Nm
750 Series Loader Service Manual
HYDRAULIC/HYDROSTATIC FLUID SPECIFICATIONS Specifications Use Melroe hydraulic/hydrostatic transmission fluid (PIN 6563328). If this fluid is not available, use 10W-30 or 10W-40 SAE Motor Oil (5W-30 for OaF [-18°C] and Below). DO NOT use automatic transmission fluids in the loader or permanent damage to the transmission will result.
Diesel fuel or hydraulic fluid under pressure can penetrate skin or eyes causing serious injury. Fluid leaks under pressure may not be visible. Use a piece of cardboard or wood to find leaks. Do not use your bare hand. Wear safety goggles. If fluid enters skin or eyes, get immediate medical attention.
W-2074-1285
When temperatures below zero degree F (-18°C) are common, the loader must be kept in a warm building. Extra warm-up time must be used each time the loader is started during cold temperature conditions. Cold fluid will not flow easily and it makes action of the hydraulic function slower. Loss of fluid flow to the hydrostatiC transmission pump (indicated by 'TRANS' light 'ON') can cause transmission damage in less than 60 seconds.
During cold weather 32°F (O°C) and below, do not operate machine until the engine has run for at least five (5) minutes at less than half throttle. This warm-up period is necessary for foot pedal operation and safe stopping. Do not operate controls during warm-up period. When temperatures are below -20°F (30°C), the hydrostatic oil must be or kept warm. The heated hydrostatic system will not get enough oil at low temperatures. Park the machine in an area where the temperature will be above OaF (-18°C), if possible.
W-2027-1285
-8-13-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
STANDARD TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS FOR BOLTS The following table shows standard torque specifications for bolts with zinc phosphate coating. Bolts purchased from Melroe that have zinc phosphate coating are specified by the letter 'H' following the part number.
THREAD SIZE INCH. LBS. (Nm)
FOOT LBS. (Nm)
SAE GRADE 5
SAE GRADE 8
.250
80-90 (9,0-10,2)
110-120 (12,4-13,6)
.3125
180-200 (20,3-22,6)
215-240 24,2-27,1)
.375
25-28 (34-38)
35-40 (47-54)
.4375
40-45 (54-61)
60-65 (81-88)
.500
65-70 (88-95)
90-100 (122-136)
.5625
90-100 (122-136)
125-140 (170-190)
.625
125-140 (170-190)
175-190 (240-260)
.750
220-245 (300-330)
300-330 (410-450)
.875
330-360 (450-490)
475-525 (645-710)
1.000
475-525 (645-710)
725-800 (985-1085)
1.125
650-720 (880-975)
1050-1175 (1425-1600)
1.250
900-1000 (1200-1360)
1475-1625 (2000-2200)
1.375
1200-1350 (1630-1830)
2000-2200 (2720-2980)
1.500
1500-1650 (2040-2240)
2600-2850 (3530-3870)
1.625
2000-2800 (2720-2980)
3450-3800 (4680-5150)
1.750
2500-2750 (3390-3730)
4300-4800 (5830-6500)
1.875
3150-3500 (4270-4750)
5500-6100 (7450-8300)
2.000
3800-4200 (5150-5700)
6500-7200 (8800-9800)
-
-8-14-
750 Series Loader Service Manual
DECIMAL AND MILLIMETER EQUIVALENTS FRACTIONS
1/32 1/16 3/32 1/8 5/32
3/16 7/32 1/4
9/32 5/16 11/32 3/8
13132 7/16 15/32 112
DECIMALS
1/64- 0.015625 0.03125 3/64- 0.046875 0.0625 5/64- 0.078125 0.09375 7/64- 0.109375 0.1250 9/64- 0.140625 0.15625 11/64- 0.171875 0.1876 13/64- 0.203125 0.21875 15/64- 0.234375 0.2500 17/64- 0.265625 0.28125 19/64- 0.296875 0.3125 21/64- 0.328125 0.34375 23/64- 0.359375 0.3750 25/64- 0.390625 0.40625 27/64- 0.421875 0.4375 29/64- 0.453125 0.46875 31/64- 0.484375 0.5000
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
--
-
MM
FRACTIONS
0.397 0.794 1.191 1.588 1.984 2.381 2.778 3.175 3.572 3.969 4.366 4.762 5.159 5.556 5.953 6.350 6.747 7.144 7.541 7.938 8.334 8.731 9.128 9.525 9.922 10.319 10.716 11.112 11.509 11.906 12.303 12.700
17/32 9/16 19/32 5/8 21/32
11/16 23132 3/4
25/32 13116
27/32 7/8 29/32
15/16 31/32 1
1 mm = 0.03937'
DECIMALS
33/64- 0.515625 0.53125 35/64- 0.546875 0.5625 37/64- 0.578125 0.59375 39/64- 0.609375 0.6250 41/64- 0.640625 0.65625 43/64- 0.671875 0.6875 45/64- 0.703125 0.71875 47/64- 0.734375 0.7500 49/64- 0.765625 0.78125 51/64- 0.796875 0.8125 53/64- 0.828125 0.84375 55164- 0.859375 0.8750 57/64- 0.890625 0.90625 59/64- 0.921875 0.9375 61/64- 0.953125 0.96875 63/64- 0.984375 1.000
0.001'
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
MM
13.097 13.494 13.891 14.288 14.684 15.081 15.478 15.875 16.272 16.669 17.066 17.462 17.859 18.256 18.653 19.050 19.447 19.844 20.241 20.638 21.034 21.431 21.828 22.225 22.622 23.019 23.416 23.812 24.209 24.606 25.003 25.400
=0.0254 mm
U.S. TO METRIC CONVERSION TO CONVERT
INTO
LINEAR MEASUREMENT
Miles Yards Feet Feet Inches Inches Inches
Kilometers Meters Meters Centimeters Meters Centimeters Millimeters
AREA
Square Miles Square Feet Square Inches Acre
Square Kilometers Square Meters Square Centimeters Hectare
Cubic Yards Cubic Feet Cubic Inches
Cubic Meters Cubic Meters Cubic Centimeters
0.7646 0.02832 16.39
WEIGHT
Tons ~Short) Poun s Ounces (Avdp.)
MetriC Tons Kilograms Grams
0.9078 0.4536 28.3495
PRESSURE
Pounds/Sq. In.
Kilopascal
6.895
WORK
Foot-Pounds
Newton-Metre
1.356
LIQUID VOLUME
Quarts Gallons
Liters Liters
0.9463 3.785
LIQUID FLOW
Gallons/Minute
Liters/Minute
TEMPERATURE
Fahrenheit
Celsius
. VOLUME
MULTIPLY BY
-8-15-
1.609 0.9144 0.3048 30.48 0.0254 2.54 25.4 2.59 0.0929 6.452 0.4047
3.785 1 .Subtract 32° 2. Multiply by 5/9 750 Series Loader Service Manual
S81J8S
J8peO,
~II.Ias
lunuuw
OS.!
M'E.&ROEctJMPANT
Ji(bobcat
--'*-­
750-001
Revision Number
22 March 1991 Date
SERVICE MANUAL
REVISION
ROUTE TO
ATTENTION
AFFECTING: Product
BOBCAT LOADER
Model
753
Manual No.
6720326,
PARTS MANAGER SERVICE MANAGER SALES MANAGER
D 0' D D
--.
The attached pages are a revision to the 753 Service Manual (PIN 6720326). Take out and put in the pages as listed below: TAKE OUT
PUT IN
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE - TAB PAGE
1 3, 1-4
1 9, 1-10
1-11. 1-12
1-17, 1 18
1-21, 1-22
1-25, 1-26
1-27, 1-28
1-29
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE - TAB PAGE (Revised Mar. 91) 1 3 (Revised Mar. 91), 1-4 1-9 (Revised Mar. 91), 1 10 1-11. 1 12 (Revised Mar. 91) 1-17 (Revised Mar. 91), 1-18 21 (Revised Mar. 91), 1 22 (Revised Mar. 91) 1-25, 1-26 (Revised Mar. 91) 1-27 (Revised Mar. 91), 1-28 (Revised Mar. 91) 1-29 (Revised Mar. 91)
HYD./HYDRO. SYSTEM OPERATION
For Model 753
Chart #6720316 (Printed May 1990)
CHART LEGEND
2-7,2-8
HYD./HYDRO. SYSTEM OPERATION
For Model 753
Chart #6720316 (Printed May 1990)
CHART LEGEND (Revised Mar. 91)
2-7 (Revised Mar. 91), 2-8
HYDROSTATIC SYSTEM - TAB PAGE
3 7,3-8
3-9,3-10
3-11, 3-12
3-15, 3-16
HYDROSTATIC SYSTEM - TAB PAGE (Revised Mar. 91)
3-7 (Revised Mar. 91), 3-8 (Revised Mar. 91)
3-9 (Revised Mar. 91); 3-10 (Revised Mar. 91)
3-11 (Revised Mar. 91), 3-12
3-15 (Revised Mar. 911, 3-16
4-1,4-2
4-5,4-6
4-7,4-8
4-11. 4-12
4-13,4-14
4-15.4-16
4-19.4-20
4-1 (Revised Mar. 91), 4-2
4-5 (Revised Mar. 91), 4-6
4-7 (Revised Mar. 91), 4-8 (Revised Mar. 91)
4-11,4-12 (Revised Mar. 91)
4-13 (Revised Mar. 91),4-14 (Revised Mar. 91)
4-15 (Revised Mar. 91), 4-16
4-19, 4-20 (Revised Mar. 91)
Auxiliary Hydraulic Wiring Diagram
Model 753 (SIN 11079 & Above)
(Printed August 1990) 3 of 3 Pages
Auxiliary Hydraulic Wiring Diagram
Model 753 (SIN 11079 & Above)
(Printed March 1991) 3 of 3 Pages
7 5, 7-6 7-13,7 14 7-19,7-20 7-45,7-46
7-5 (Revised Mar. 91), 7-6
7-13, 7-14 (Revised Mar. 91)
7-19 (Revised Mar. 91), 7-20
7-45 (Revised Mar. 91), 7-46
8-1,8-2 8-3,8-4
8-1 (Revised Mar. 91). 8-2 (Revised Mar. 91)
8-3 (Revised Mar. 91), 8-4 (Revised Mar. 91)
' IUSlHES$ UNIT Of !Mill! eoUIPMENT COMPANY
Printed in U.S.A.
__m
'bel
M'ELROE
ctIMI'AIT
.
750-002
IXCIt
Revision Number
30 April 1991 Date
SERVICE MANUAL
REVISION
ROUTE TO
ATTENTION
AFFECTING: BOBCAT LOADER
Product Model
__7~5~3~_________________________________
Manual No.
PARTS MANAGER SERVICE MANAGER SALES MANAGER
D
fj D
6720326 (8-90)
Revise your Service Manual with the enclosed pages as shown below.
TAKE OUT
PUT IN
1-11. 1 12 (Revised Mar. 91) 8-1.8-2 (Revised Mar. 91)
III BUSINESS UNIT Of _
1-11, 1-12 (Revised Apr. 91) 8-1,8-2 (Revised Apr. 91)
EQUlPIII£ItT COIII''NY
Printed in U.S.A.
~bobcat
M'E.LROEctlMPANT
~~.~.--
750-003 Revision Number
10 June 1991 Date
SERVICE MANUAL
REVISION
ROUTE TO ATTENTION
AFFECTING:
Product Model
753
Manual No.
~
PARTS MANAGER
SERVICE MANAGER SALES MANAGER
BOBCAT LOADER
8
6720326 (8-90)
Revise your Service Manual with the enclosed pages as shown below. TAKE OUT
PUT IN
1-19, 1-20 1-25, 1-26 (Revised Mar. 91)
1-19, 1- 20 (Revised June 91) 1 25, 1- 26 (Revised June 91)
7-23,7-24 7-29,7-30 7-45 (Revised Mar. 91), 7-46 7-53,7-54
7 - 23, 7 24 (Revised June 91) 7 - 29 (Revised June 91), 7 - 30 (Revised June 91) 7 -45 (Revised June 91), 7 -46 (Revised June 91) 7-53 (Revised June 91), 7-54
8-3 (Revised Mar. 91), 8-4 (Revised Mar. 911 8-5,8-6
8-3 (Revised June 91). 8-4 (Revised Mar. 91) 8-5 (Revised June 911. 8-6
A IIUSlNEIIi UNIT 01' a.II EQUIPMENT COMPANY
Printed in U.S.A.
~bobcat
M'ELROE
ctJMPANT
!!!!~,~.--
750-004
Revision Number
10 September 1991
Date
SERVICE MANUAL
REVISION
ROUTE TO ATTENTION
AFFECTING: Product
BOBCAT LOADER
Model
753
Manual No.
6720326 (8-90)
PARTS MANAGER SERVICE MANAGER SALES MANAGER
o
[B'
B
Revise your Service Manual with the enclosed pages as shown below. TAKE OUT
PUT IN
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE· TAB PAGE
(Revised Mar. 1991)
1 5, 1-6
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE TAB PAGE
(Revised September 91)
1-5, 1-5a (Added Sept. 91)
1-5b (Added Sept. 91), 1-6
1 25. 1- 26 (Revised Sept. 91)
1- 25, 1- 26 (Revised Mar. 91)
3
7 (Revised Mar. 91), 3-8 (Revised Mar. 911
WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6720582) Model 753 (SIN 11079 & Above) (Printed Aug. 1990) 3 of 3 Pages.
2-21 Thru 2-27 (Added Sept. 91)
3-7 Revised Sept. 91), 3-8 (Revised Mar. 91)
WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6720582)
Model 753 (SIN 11079 Thru 13487)
(Printed Sept. 1991) 3 of 3 Pages.
WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6720959)
Model 753 (SIN 13488 & Above)
(Printed Sept. 91) 3 of 3 Pages.
A 8USlNESS UfoItT OF CIIIRII EQUIPMENT COMPANY
Printed in U.S.A.
w
M'ELROE
COMAINY
750-005
. bobcat
Revision Number
7 January 1992 Date
SERVICE MANUAL
REVISION
ROUTE TO ATTENTION
AFFECTING: Product Model
750 SERIES
Manual No.
D
PARTS MANAGER SERVICE MANAGER SALES MANAGER
BOBCAT LOADER
~
D
6720326 (8-90)
Revise your Service Manual with the enclosed pages as shown below. TAKE OUT
PUT IN
MAINTENANCE SAFETY, MAINTENANCE SAFETY (Cont'd)
MAINTENANCE SAFETY (Revised Jan. 92) MAINTENANCE SAFETY (Cont'd)
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE - TAB PAGE (Revised Sept. 91)
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE - TAB PAGE (Revised Jan. 92)
1-1, 1-2 1-3 (Revised Mar. 91), 1-4 1-5, 1-5a (Added Sept. 91) 1 5b (Added Sept. 91), 1-6 1-11, 1-12 (Revised Apr. 911 1-21 (Revised Mar. 91). 1--22 (Revised Mar. 91) 1-25, 1-26 (Revised Sept. 91)
1-1 (Revised Jan. 92). 1-2 1-3 (Revised Mar. 91), 1-4 (Revised Jan. 921 1-5 (Revised Jan. 92). 1-5a (Revised Jan. 921 1-5b (Added Sept. 91), 1-6 (Revised Jan. 92) 1-11 (Revised Jan. 92), 1-12 (Revised Apr. 91) 1 21 (Revised Jan. 92), 1- 22 (Revised Jan. 921 1-25, 1-26 (Revised Jan. 92)
HYDRAULIC SYSTEM - TAB PAGE 2-19, 2-20
HYDRAULIC SYSTEM - TAB PAGE (Revised Jan. 92) 2-19 (Revised Jan. 921. 2-20
ENGINE SERVICE· TAB PAGE 7-21. 7-22
ENGINE SERVICE - TAB PAGE (Revised Jan. 92) 7 - 21 (Revised Jan. 921, 7 - 22
8-1 (Revised Mar. 91). 8-2 (Revised Apr. 91)
8-1 (Revised Jan. 92), 8-2 (Revised Apr. 91)
' BUSINESS UNIT Of . . . EQUIPMENT COIiPilNY
Printed in U.S.A.
-.,.•
~bobcat
MELROE
COMPANY
~;::
750-006 Revision Number
9 April 1992 Date
SERVICE MANUAL
REVISION
ROUTE TO ATTENTION
AFFECTING: Product Model
750 SERIES
Manual No.
o~
PARTS MANAGER SERVICE MANAGER SALES MANAGER
BOBCAT LOADER
6720326 (8·90)
Revise your Service Manual with the enclosed pages as shown below. TAKE OUT
PUT IN
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE· TAB PAGE (Revised Jan. 92)
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE - TAB PAGE (Revised Apr. 92)
1-29 (Revised Mar. 91)
1-29 (Revised Mar. 91), 1-30 (Added Apr. 92)
HYDROSTATIC SYSTEM - TAB PAGE (Revised Mar. 91)
HYDROSTATIC SYSTEM - TAB PAGE (Revised Apr. 92)
3-15 (Revised Mar. 91), 3-16
3-15 (Revised Mar. 91), 3-16 (Revised Apr. 92) 3-19 Thru 3-26 (Added Apr. 92)
3
19
* WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6722195)
BUCKET POSITION VALVE LOCKOUT (OPTIONAL)
Model 753, 7753, 843, 843B & 853)
(Printed April 92)
7-19 (Revised Mar. 91), 7-20 (Revised Apr. 92) 7-25 (Revised Apr. 92), 7-26 (Revised Apr. 92)
7-19 (Revised Mar. 91), 7-20 7-25, 7-26
* NOTE:
Put the WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6722195) at the beginning of Section 6.
A BUSINESS UNIT OF _
EOUIPMENT COMPANY
Printed in U.S.'/>
--'·M_-
-bobcat
IfIELROE
COMPANY
750-007
Revision Number
6 August 1992 Date
SERVICE MANUAL
REVISION
ROUTE TO
ATTENTION
AFFECTING: Product Model
750 SERIES
Manual No.
~
PARTS MANAGER SERVICE MANAGER SALES MANAGER
BOBCAT LOADER
6720326 (8-90)
Revise your Service Manual with the enclosed pages as shown below. TAKE OUT
PUT IN
1- 21 (Revised Jan. 92), 1- 22 (Revised Jan. 92)
1-21 (Revised Aug. 92), 1-22 (Revised Aug. 92)
OPERATOR CAB WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6720959)
Model 753 (SIN 13488 & Above)
(Printed September 1991) 1 Of 3 Pages
OPERATOR CAB WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6720959)
Model 753 (SIN 13488 Thru 17641)
(Printed August 1992) 1 Of 3 Pages
ENGINE WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6720959)
Model 753 (SIN 13488 & Above)
(Printed September 1991) 2 Of 3 Pages
ENGINE WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6720959)
Model 753 (SIN 13489 Thru 17641)
(Printed August 1992) 2 Of 3 Pages
AUXILIARY HYDRAULIC WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6720959)
Model 753 (SIN 13488 & Above)
(Printed September 1991) 3 Of 3 Pages
AUXILIARY HYDRAULIC WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6720959)
Model 753 (SIN 13489 Thru 17641)
(Printed August 1992) 3 Of 3 Pages
OPERATOR CAB WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6722301)
Model 753 (Starting With SIN 17642)
(Printed August 1992) 1 Of 3 Pages
ENGINE WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6722301)
Model 753 (Starting With SIN 17642)
(Printed August 1992) 2 Of 3 Pages
AUXILIARY HYDRAULIC WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6722301)
Model 753 (Starting With SIN 17642)
(Printed August 1992) 3 Of 3 Pages
7 -7, 7 -8
7-15,7-16
7 -7 (Revised Aug. 92), 7-8
7-15,7-16 (Revised Aug. 92)
A BUSINESS UNIT OF _
EQUIPMENT COMPANY
Printed in U.S.A.
111£,&80£ct1MPANT
~bobcat
750-008 Revision Number
December 1992 Date
SERVICE MANUAL
REVISION
ROUTE TO ATTENTION
AFFECTING:
Product
BOBCAT LOADER
Model
753
Manual No.
6720326 (B-90)
PARTS MANAGER SERVICE MANAGER SALES MANAGER
[
Revise your Service Manual with the enclosed pages as shown below. TAKE OUT
PUT IN
FOREWARD iii
FOREWORD(Rev. Dec. 92)
iii (Rev. Dec. 92)
1-1 (Rev. Jan. 92), 1- 2 2-7 (Rev. Mar. 91), 2-8
1-1 (Rev. Dec. 92), 1-2
2-7 (Rev. Dec. 92), 2-8
HYDRAULIC/HYDROSTATIC FLOW CHART
Model 753 (S/N 19227 & Above)
PIN 6722407 IPrinted Dec. 92)
A IIUSlNESS UNIT OF _
EQUIPMENT COMPANY
Printed in U.S.A.
IIIELROE
COMI'ANT
--'*-­
~bobcat'
750-009 Revision Number
30 September 1993 Date
SERVICE MANUAL REVISION
ROUTE TO ATTENTION
AFFECTING:
PARTS MANAGER SERVICE MANAGER SALES MANAGER
Product
BOBCAT LOADER
ModeJ
753
Manual No.
6720326 (8-90) _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _~.
[
o
The following is a revision to the 753 Service Manual PIN 6720326 (8-90). Take out the pages shown and put in the revised pages shown below:
TAKE OUT
PUT IN
MAINTENANCE SAFETY
MAINTENANCE SAFETY (Revised Sept. 93) 1-5b, 1-6 (Revised Sept. 93) 1-15 (Revised Sept. 93). 1-16
1-5b, 1-6 1-15, 1-16 2-9, 2-10 2-11 thru 2-27
Section 2, Content Page (Revised Sept. 93) 2 - 9 (Revised Sept. 93). 2 -10 (Revised Sept. 93) 2-11 thru 2-25 (Revised Sept. 93)
3-3,3-4 3-7,3-8
3-3 (Revised Sept. 93)' 3-4 3-7 (Revised Sept. 931, 3-8 (Revised Sept. 93)
Section 4, Content Page Section 4
Section 4, Content Page (Revised Sept. 931 Section 4 (Revised Sept. 93)
Section 5, Content Page
5-1, 5-2 5-3,5-4 5-11, 5-12
Section 5, Content Page (Revised Sept. 93) 5 1 (Revised Sept. 931, 5-2 (Revised Sept. 931 5-3 (Revised Sept. 93). 5-4 (Revised Sept. 93) 5-11 (Revised Sept. 93). 5-12.
Section 6, Content Page Section 6
Section 6, Content Page (Revised Sept. 93) Section 6 (Revised Sept. 93)
Section 2, Content Page
Section 7. Content Page
7 5.7-6 7-11. 7-12 7-13. 7-14 7-15. 7-16 7-17. 7-18 7-19, 7-20
Section 7, Content Page (Revised Sept. 931 (Revised Sept. 931. 7 - 6 (Revised Sept. 93) (Revised Sept. 93). 7-12 (Revised Sept. 93) (Revised Sept. 93). 7 -14 (Revised Sept. 93) (Revised Sept. 93). 7 -16 (Revised Sept. 93) (Revised Sept. 931. 7-18 (Revised Sept. 93) (Revised Sept. 93), 7 - 20 (Revised Sept. 931
7- 5 7-11 7 -13 7 -15 7-17 7 -19
A BUSINESS UNIT OF aMIII EQUII'fiIENT COMPANY
Printed in U.S.A.
~bobcat·
JIIELROEt:WII'ANT
750-010
Revision Number
29 November 1993
Date
SERVICE MANUAL
REVISION
ROUTE TO ATTENTION
AFFECTING: Product
BOBCAT LOADER
Model
7538r. 753H
Manual No.
6720326 (8·90)
PARTS MANAGER SERVICE MANAGER SALES MANAGER
o ur
B
Revise your Service Manual with the enclosed pages as shown below. PUT IN
TAKE OUT
HYDRAULlC/HYDROSTATIC FLOW CHART
Model 753 (SIN 19227 & Above)
PIN 6722407 (Printed Dec. 92)
HYDRAULlC/HYDROSTATIC FLOW CHART
Model 753 (SIN 19227 & Above)
PIN 6722407 (Printed Nov. 93)
HYDRAULlC/HYDROSTATIC FLOW CHART
Model 753H (SIN 511011001 & Above)
PIN 6722833 (Printed Nov. 93)
OPERATOR CAB WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6722827)
Model 753 (SIN 511525001 Thru 511525540)
Model 753H (SIN 511011001 Thru 511011006)
(Printed November 1993) 1 of 4 Pages
ENGINE WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6722827)
Model 753 (SIN 511525001 Thru 511525540)
Model 753H (SIN 511011001 Thru 511011006)
(Printed November 1993) 2 of 4 Pages
AUXILIARY HYDRAULIC WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6722827)
Model 753 (SIN 511350001 Thru 511350882)
Model 753 (SIN 511525001 Thru 511525540)
Model 753H (SIN 511011001 Thru 511011006)
(Printed November 1993) 3 of 4 Pages
HIGH FLOW WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6722827)
Model 753H (SIN 511011001 Thru 511011006)
!Printed November 1993) 4 of 4 Pages
OPERATOR CA8 WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 67228311
Model 753 (SIN 511350001 Thru 511350882)
(Printed November 1993) 1 of 2 Pages
ENGINE WIRING DIAGRAM (PIN 6722831)
Model 753 (SIN 511350001 Thru 511350882)
(Printed November 1993) 2 of 2 Pages
A BUSINESS UNIT OF aIIIIII EQUIPMENT COIIMIIY
Printed in U.S.A.
~bobcat·
M'ELROECDIIMNT
~~,-.--
ROUTE TO ATTENTION
AFFECTING: BOBCAT LOADER
Model
753 & 753H
Manual No.
28 January 1994
Date
SERVICE MANUAL
REVISION Product
750-011
Revision Number
PARTS MANAGER SERVICE MANAGER SALES MANAGER
o
[
6720326 (8-90)
NOTICE
Insert This Sheet With The Appropriate Manual For Future Reference.
The following pages are a revision to the 750 Series Service Manual PIN 6720326 (8-90). Take out the pages shown and put in the revised pages as follows; TAKE OUT
PUT IN
Section 2, Content Page (Revised Sept. 93)
Section 2, Content Page (Revised Jan. 94) 2-8A thru 2-8F (Added Jan. 94) 2-10A (Added Jan. 94)
Section 8, Content Page
Section 8, Content Page (Revised Jan. 94)
8-3 (Revised June 91). 8-4 (Revised Mar. 91) 8-5 (Revised June 91). 8-6 8- 7 thru 8-10
8-3 (Revised Jan. 941. 8-4 (Revised Jan. 94) 8-5 (Revised Jan. 94), 8-6 (Revised Jan. 94) 8-7 thru 8-10 (Revised Jan 94) 8-11 (Added Jan. 94). 8-12 (Added Jan. 94)
II BUSINess UNIT OF CUlIil EOUII'IIENT COMPANY
Printed in U.S.A.
~bObOlr
JIIELROE
ctIMAfNT
SERVICE MANUAL
REVISION AFFECTING: Product
BOBCAT LOADER
Model
753 & 753H
Manual No.
750-12
Revision Number
1 February 1995
Date
ROUTE TO ATTENTION PARTS MANAGER SERVICE MANAGER SALES MANAGER
~ o
6720326 (8-90'
NOTICE
Insert This Sheet With The Appropriate Manual For Future Reference.
The following pages are a revision to the 750 Series Service Manual PIN 6720326
{S-901. Insert the following pages in the Electrical Section of your Service Manual. These electrical charts will update your Service Manual for all 753 & 753H loaders up to the introduction of BICS™.
A BUSINESS UNIT OF CUlIII EOUIPMENT COMPANY
IIIEJ;,ROE
IIt1IIPdIW
~bobcat®
750-13 Revision Number
20 October 1995
SERVICE MANUAL
REVISION
AFFECTING: Product BOBCAT LOADER Model
750 Series
Date
ROUTE TO ATTENTION PARTS MANAGER SERVICE MANAGER SALES MANAGER
0 00 0
Manual No. 6720326 (8-90)
NOTICE
Insert This Sheet With The Appropriate Manual For Future Reference.
The following pages are a revision to the 750 Series Service Manual PIN 6720326 (8-90). Take out the pages shown and put in the revised pages as follows:
TAKEOUT
PUT IN
Section 3
Section 3 (Revised Oct. 95)
Section 4
Section 4 (Revised Oct. 95)
Section 5
Section 5 (Revised Oct. 95)
Section 7
Section 7 (Revised Oct. 95)
Printed in U.S.A.

<>
<><>



<><>
<>